You are on page 1of 322

Comau Robotics

Instruction Handbook
C4G SW Manuals
C4G
MOTION PROGRAMMING
System Software Rel. 3.2x
Robot movements in programming mode, motion control, optional features (synchronous
motion, cooperative motion, sensor tracking, conveyor tracking, weaving, path governor,
smartmove4, kinematic compensation, collision detection), moving through singularities,
positioners and portals, TO_SET program.
CR00757558_en-00/0708
The information contained in this manual is the property of COMAU S.p.A.
Reproduction of text and illustrations is not permitted without prior written approval by COMAU S.p.A.
COMAU S.p.A. reserves the right to alter product specifications at any time without notice or obligation.
Copyright 2003 by COMAU - Date of publication 07/2008
Summary
I
lb-rc-c4e-motionTOC.fm
SUMMARY
PREFACE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .IX
Symbols used in the manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .IX
Reference documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . X
Modification History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .XI
1. GENERAL SAFETY PRECAUTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..1.1
Responsibilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.1
Safety Precautions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2
Purpose . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2
Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2
Applicability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.3
Operating Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.4
2. SYSTEM OPERATING MODES AND STATES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..2.1
Foreword . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.1
System operating modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.1
System states . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.3
HOLD status. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.4
AUTO status. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.4
PROGR status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.5
AUTO-T status (optional) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.5
ALARM status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.5
Stand-by function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.6
3. TURN-SET AND CALIBRATION - BASIC CONCEPTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..3.1
Foreword . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.1
Terminology. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.1
Turn-set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2
Turn-set on system calibration position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2
Turn-set on user calibration position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3
Turn-set for robot axes with multi-turn stroke. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.3
Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.4
System calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5
User calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.5
4. ROBOT MOTION IN PROGRAMMING MODE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..4.1
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1
Summary
II
lb-rc-c4e-motionTOC.fm
Reference frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1
System reference frames. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2
Manual motion. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3
Manual motion in WRIST_J NT mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4
Manual motion of a single arm system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4
Manual motion of auxiliary axes, slides and rotating columns. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4
Manual motion with Controller multi-arm configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.5
Motion instruction in programming status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.5
5. MOTION CONTROL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5.1
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.1
Frames of Reference. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.1
System Frame of Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2
Base System of Reference definition. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.3
Flange Tooling definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.3
TCP Offset definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4
Calculating the Rotation Angles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.5
FIRST METHOD. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.6
SECOND METHOD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.8
User System of Reference definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.8
Trajectory. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.9
J oint Interpolation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.9
Linear Interpolation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.9
Circular Interpolation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.9
Orientation Evolution during Linear or Circular movements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.10
Attitude Flags During Linear and Circular Movements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.10
Turn Flag and minimum path. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.11
Position Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.12
On Trajectory Function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.12
On Position (ON POS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.13
Example of On Pos and On Trajectory. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.14
Speed Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.14
Speed Overrides . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.15
Cartesian Speed Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.16
Cartesian Speed Control Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.17
Run-Time modifying the Linear Speed Override . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.18
J oint Speed Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.19
Manual Motion Speed Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.19
Acceleration and Deceleration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.20
Acceleration/Deceleration Overrides . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.21
J oint Interpolation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.22
Cartesian Interpolation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.22
Manual Motions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.23
Motion termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.23
COARSE and FINE Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.23
Summary
III
lb-rc-c4e-motionTOC.fm
J NT_COARSE and J NT_FINE Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.24
NOSETTLE Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.24
Trajectory Recovery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.24
Recovery Strategy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.24
Pending Motion Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.25
Recovery Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.25
Execution Environment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.25
Process Resume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.26
Automatic Process Resume. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.28
Continuous Motion. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.29
Trajectory Shape During Continuous Motion. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.30
Continuous Motion Modes (FLY) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.30
FLY_NORM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.30
FLY_CART (Controller Aided Resolved Trajectory). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.31
Dynamic Machine Stress Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.31
Constant Speed Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.32
Control of Trajectory During FLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.32
Debug of Fly Motions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.34
Variables used with FLY Motion. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.36
Remote Tool System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.36
Integrated Movement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.37
Integrated Axis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.38
J ogging. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.39
Reference Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.39
Restrictions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.40
6. SYNCHRONOUS MOTION (OPTIONAL FEATURE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..6.1
Synchronization with Auxiliary Axes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.1
Synchronized Arms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.1
Motion limitation of the two Arms. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.2
J ogging Synchronized Arms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.3
Teaching and Modifying Positions (REC/MOD) with Synchronized Arms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.3
Loss of Synchronization. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.4
Run-time modifying the Linear Speed Override. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.4
7. COOPERATIVE MOTION (OPTIONAL FEATURE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..7.1
Cooperative Motion with Auxiliary Axes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.1
Cooperative Arms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.3
J ogging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.3
8. SENSOR TRACKING (OPTIONAL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..8.1
Principle of operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.1
Summary
IV
lb-rc-c4e-motionTOC.fm
Configuration on several arms. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.3
Sensor interface. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.3
Integrated Sensors ( MCP-ST board (Seam Track)) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.4
External sensors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.4
Sensor reference system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.5
Sensor integral with the tool (TOOL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.5
Sensor integral with the user reference system (USER) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.6
Sensor integral with the world reference system (WORLD). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.7
Sensor integral with the weaving reference system (WEAVE). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.7
Type of information acquired by the sensor. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.7
Correction actuation criteria. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.8
Relative and absolute deviations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.8
Actuation of deviation in time. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.9
Overall deviations control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.12
Sensor tracking enable mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.12
Sensor malfunctioning. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.14
Robot stop in the case of sensor malfunctioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.14
Redefinition of overall deviations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.14
Accumulative overall deviations management. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.16
Interrupted sensor tracking session. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.16
Suspended sensor tracking session. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.17
Resetting in spread condition. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.17
Limitations in parameter changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.18
Programming example. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.19
9. CONVEYOR TRACKING
(OPTIONAL FEATURE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9.1
Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.2
Working Principle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.3
Process Monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.5
Tracking Window. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.5
Motion Statements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.5
Teaching Positions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.6
Tracking Interruption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.7
Limitations during Conveyor Tracking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.7
Use of the Roto-translating Conveyor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.8
Configuration parameters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.9
10. INTEGRATED CONVEYOR TRACKING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10.1
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.1
Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.1
Summary
V
lb-rc-c4e-motionTOC.fm
Programming. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.1
Example. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.2
Conveyor configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.2
Motion programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.2
11. MOTION WITH WEAVING (OPTIONAL FEATURE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..11.1
Weaving Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.1
Weaving Activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.1
Weaving Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.2
Wave Shape. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.3
Weave Plane . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.6
Weave Amplification. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.8
Stopping Motions with Weaving. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.10
Programming Weaving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.11
Weaving without Arm motion. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.12
Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.12
Activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.13
Parameters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.13
Example - Using the weaving without Arm motion. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.13
12. PATH GOVERNOR (OPTIONAL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..12.1
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.1
Enable Path Governor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.1
Disable Path Governor. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12.3
13. SMARTMOVE4 (OPTIONAL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..13.1
Description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.1
J erk Limitation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.2
Cartesian Motions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.2
14. FLOW MODULATE
ALGORITHM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..14.1
15. PRESUPPOSITIONS FOR SMART ROBOT PROGRAMMING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..15.1
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.1
Glossary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.2
Offset algorithm with Dynamic Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.3
Kinematic offset algorithm (optional feature) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.3
Moving through axis 5 singularities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.3
Summary
VI
lb-rc-c4e-motionTOC.fm
Using WRIST_J NT modality to go through singularities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.3
J ogging through wrist singularities. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.5
Robots without compensation (effect of the inverse kinematics). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.6
Inverse conversion of SMART NH4 (non-spherical wrist) model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.6
Approximation in the orientation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.6
Move to a taught POSITION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.6
Fly between MOVE LINEAR/CIRCULAR and MOVE J OINT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.7
Axis 5 singularity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.7
Cartesian position out of range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.9
TCP in the back of the robot. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.10
TCP behind axis 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.12
WCP close to axis 1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.13
Inverse conversion of SMART NH, NS and NM (spherical wrist models only) . . . . . . . . . 15.15
Axis 5 singularity. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.15
TCP close to axis 1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.16
Programming rules for non-spherical wrist robots (SMART NH4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.17
How to stay away from a singularity zone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.18
Changing the orientation of the points along the path . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.18
Properly designing the work-cell layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.20
Modifying tool inserting a small angle between robot flange and tool flange . . . . . . . . . 15.23
Using WRIST_J NT modality to go through singularities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.25
Conclusions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.27
Appendix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.28
Exact working range for SMART NH4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.28
16. COLLISION DETECTION
(OPTIONAL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16.1
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.1
Basic concepts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.1
Activation/deactivation of Collision Detection function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.2
Collision Detection sensitivity type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.3
$COLL_TYPE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.3
$ARM_SENSITIVITY (sensitivity threshold of the axes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.4
$COLL_SOFT_PER (axes compliance thresholds) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.6
Reliability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.6
Notes about the collision detection use procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.6
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.6
CollMngr Program to activate/deactivate the sensitivity thresholds calculation. . . . . . . . . . . 16.11
CollisionStart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.11
CollisionEnd. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.12
How to use the Collision Manager . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.12
Sample Programs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.13
Enabling the Collision Detection functionality for a single MOVE statement . . . . . . . . . . . 16.13
Enabling Collision Detection again from within a Program. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.14
Automatic calculation of the sensitivity thresholds. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.15
Updating of thresholds in cold robot/warmed robot mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.16
Managing "collision detected" event. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16.28
Summary
VII
lb-rc-c4e-motionTOC.fm
17. USE OF POSITIONERS MANAGED BY C4G. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..17.1
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.1
Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.2
General Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.2
Axis rotation directions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.2
Convention for the mechanical positioning of points P1, P2 and P3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.3
Programming override value calculation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.4
Positioners with 1 rotating axis type MP, PTDO, PTDV, TR3000/6000. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.4
Definition of the reference system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.4
Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.5
Kinematic description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.5
PTORB - Positioner with 2 perpendicular axes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.6
Positioner with two tilting-rotating axes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.6
Definition of the reference system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.6
Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.7
Kinematic description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.8
Positioner with two axes in "L" arrangement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.9
Definition of the reference system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.9
Calibration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.9
Kinematic description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.10
Positioners with 2 non perpendicular axes, type PTORB-alfa. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.12
Definition of the reference system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.12
Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.13
Kinematic description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.13
Integrated robot positioning axes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.15
Integrated slide. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.15
Definition of the reference system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.16
Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.16
Kinematic description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.17
Integrated rotating column. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.18
Definition of the reference system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.18
Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.19
Kinematic description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.19
Three linear axes portal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.21
Definition of the reference system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.21
Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.22
Kinematic description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.22
Two linear axes Portal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.24
Definition of the reference system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.24
Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.25
Kinematic description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.25
Integrated trans-rotational Column. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.26
Definition of the reference system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.26
Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.27
Kinematic description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.27
18. TO_SET PROGRAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..18.1
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.1
Summary
VIII
lb-rc-c4e-motionTOC.fm
Activation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.2
From TP4i/WiTP Teach Pendant. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.2
From WinC4G on Personal Computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.3
First screen page of TO_SET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.4
TOOL automatic calculation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.5
Tools needed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.5
Calibrated tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.5
Reference point (or master cube). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.6
General characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.6
Tool orientation calculation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.6
How to identify the "dummy reference system" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.7
Procedure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.7
Tool calculation with standard method- Complete procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.10
Tool verification with standard method - Partial procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.11
Tool Calculation with "4 points method" - Complete procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.17
Local Tool verification with "4 points method". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.20
Payload identification (optional function) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.21
Basic concepts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.22
Procedure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.23
Requirements to modify Payload identification programs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.23
Activation and execution of the Payload identification procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.24
Software to validate the payload . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.33
REMOTE TOOL Automatic Calculation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.34
Tools needed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.34
Tool with known dimensions mounted on Robot Flange . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.34
General characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.34
UFRAME automatic calculation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.35
Tools needed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.35
Tool with known dimensions mounted on Robot Flange . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.35
3 Reference Points (ORIGIN, Xpos and XYpos) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.35
General characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.35
Procedure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.36
REMOTE UFRAME automatic calculation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.41
Tools needed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.41
Tool with known dimensions mounted on the Robot Flange . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.41
3 reference points (ORIGIN, Xpos and XYpos). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.41
General characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.42
Procedure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.42
BASE automatic calculation for POSITIONERS (optional) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.47
Tools required . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.47
Tool of known dimensions mounted on the robot flange . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.47
3 reference points (P1, P2, P3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.47
General characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.48
CONVEYOR TRACKING installation and configuration (optional service) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.57
Tools required . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.57
Tool of known dimensions mounted on the robot flange . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.57
3 Reference points (P1, P2, P3). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.57
Preface
IX
HS-0-0-0-mot_01.fm
00/0000
PREFACE
Symbols used in the manual
Reference documents
Modification History.
Symbols used in the manual
The symbols for WARNING, CAUTION and NOTES are indicated below together with
their significance.
This symbol indicates operating procedures, technical information and
precautions that if ignored and/or are not performed correctly could cause
injuries.
This symbol indicates operating procedures, technical information and
precautions that if ignored and/or are not performed correctly could cause
damage to the equipment.
This symbol indicates operating procedures, technical information and
precautions that it are important to highlight.
Preface
X
HS-0-0-0-mot_01.fm
00/0000
Reference documents
This document refers to the C4G Control Unit.
The complete set of manuals for the C4G consists of:
These manuals are to be integrated with the following documents:
Comau C4G Control Unit Technical Specifications
Transport and installation
Guide to integration, safeties, I/O and
communications
C4G Control Unit Use.
Comau Robot Technical Specifications
Transport and installation
Maintenance
Programming PDL2 Programming Language Manual
VP2 - Visual PDL2
Motion programming
Applications According to the required type of
application.
Altersys PLC programming ISaGRAF Workbench
Preface
XI
HS-0-0-0-mot_01.fm
00/0000
Modification History
System Software version 3.01 - the description of how to Use of the
Roto-translating Conveyor has been added
System Software version 3.1x - the following paragraphs have been added:
Weaving without Arm motion,
Manual motion of auxiliary axes, slides and rotating columns,
Run-Time modifying the Linear Speed Override for Single Arms Systems,
Run-time modifying the Linear Speed Override for multiarm Systems.
System Software version 3.12 - the following paragraph has been added: CollMngr
Program to activate/deactivate the sensitivity thresholds calculation.
System Software version 3.2x -
in par. 17.8 Integrated robot positioning axes on page 17-15, the following
sections have been added:
par. 17.8.3 Three linear axes portal on page 17-21,
par. 17.8.4 Two linear axes Portal on page 17-24,
par. 17.8.5 Integrated trans-rotational Column on page 17-26.
several modifications in par. 5.5.2.1 Cartesian Speed Control Options on
page 5-17.
Preface
XII
HS-0-0-0-mot_01.fm
00/0000
General Safety Precautions
1-1
ge-0-0-0_01.FM
07/1007
1. GENERAL SAFETY
PRECAUTIONS
1.1 Responsibilities
The system integrator is responsible for ensuring that the Robot and Control
System are installed and handled in accordance with the Safety Standards in force
in the country where the installation takes place. The application and use of the
protection and safety devices necessary, the issuing of declarations of conformity
and any CE markings of the system are the responsibility of the Integrator.
COMAU Robotics & Service shall in no way be held liable for any accidents caused
by incorrect or improper use of the Robot and Control System, by tampering with
circuits, components or software, or the use of spare parts that are not originals or
that have not been defined as equivalent by COMAU Robotics & Service
The application of these Safety Precautions is the responsibility of the
persons assigned to direct / supervise the activities indicated in the Applicability
section,They are to make sure that the Authorised Personnel is aware of and
scrupulously follow the precautions contained in this document as well as the
Safety Standards in addition to the Safety Standards in force in the country in which
it is installed.
The non-observance of the Safety Standards could cause injuries to the operators
and damage the Robot and Control System.
The installation shall be made by qualified installation Personnel and should
conform to all national and local codes.
General Safety Precautions
1-2
ge-0-0-0_01.FM
07/1007
1.2 Safety Precautions
1.2.1 Purpose
These safety precautions are aimed to define the behaviour and rules to be observed
when performing the activities listed in the Applicability section.
1.2.2 Definitions
Robot and Control System
The Robot and Control System consists of all the functions that cover: Control Unit,
robot, hand held programming unit and any options.
Protected Area
The protected area is the zone confined by the safety barriers and to be used for the
installation and operation of the robot
Authorised Personnel
Authorised personnel defines the group of persons who have been trained and assigned
to carry out the activities listed in the Applicability section.
Assigned Personnel
The persons assigned to direct or supervise the activities of the workers referred to in
the paragraph above.
Installation and Putting into Service
The installation is intended as the mechanical, electrical and software integration of the
Robot and Control System in any environment that requires controlled movement of
robot axes, in compliance with the safety requirements of the country where the system
is installed.
Programming Mode
Operating mode under the control of the operator, that excludes automatic operation
and allows the following activities: manual handling of robot axes and programming of
work cycles at low speed, programmed cycle testing at low speed and, when allowed,
at the working speed.
Auto / Remote Automatic Mode
Operating mode in which the robot autonomously executes the programmed cycle at the
work speed, with the operators outside the protected area, with the safety barriers
closed and the safety circuit activated, with local (located outside the protected area) or
remote start/stop.
Maintenance and Repairs
Maintenance and repairs are activities that involve periodical checking and / or
replacement (mechanical, electrical, software) of Robot and Control System parts or
components, and trouble shooting, that terminates when the Robot and Control System
has been reset to its original project functional condition.
General Safety Precautions
1-3
ge-0-0-0_01.FM
07/1007
Putting Out of Service and Dismantling
Putting out of service defines the activities involved in the mechanical and electrical
removal of the Robot and Control System from a production unit or from an environment
in which it was under study.
Dismantling consists of the demolition and dismantling of the components that make up
the Robot and Control System.
Integrator
The integrator is the professional expert responsible for the installation and putting into
service of the Robot and Control System.
Incorrect Use
Incorrect use is when the system is used in a manner other than that specified in the
Technical Documentation.
Range of Action
The robot range of action is the enveloping volume of the area occupied by the robot
and its fixtures during movement in space.
1.2.3 Applicability
These Specifications are to be applied when executing the following activities:
Installation and Putting into Service;
Programming Mode;
Auto / Remote Automatic Mode;
Robot axes release;
Stop distances (threshold values)
Maintenance and Repairs;
Putting Out of Service and Dismantling
General Safety Precautions
1-4
ge-0-0-0_01.FM
07/1007
1.2.4 Operating Modes
Installation and Putting into Service
Putting into service is only possible when the Robot and Control System has been
correctly and completely installed.
The system installation and putting into service is exclusively the task of the
authorised personnel.
The system installation and putting into service is only permitted inside a protected
area of an adequate size to house the robot and the fixtures it is outfitted with,
without passing beyond the safety barriers. It is also necessary to check that under
normal robot movement conditions there is no collision with parts inside the
protected area (structural columns, power supply lines, etc.) or with the barriers. If
necessary, limit the robot working areas with mechanical hard stop (see optional
assemblies).
Any fixed robot control protections are to be located outside the protected area and
in a point where there is a full view of the robot movements.
The robot installation area is to be as free as possible from materials that could
impede or limit visibility.
During installation the robot and the Control Unit are to be handled as described in
the product Technical Documentation; if lifting is necessary, check that the eye-
bolts are fixed securely and use only adequate slings and equipment.
Secure the robot to the support, with all the bolts and pins foreseen, tightened to
the torque indicated in the product Technical Documentation.
If present, remove the fastening brackets from the axes and check that the fixing
of the robot fixture is secured correctly.
Check that the robot guards are correctly secured and that there are no moving or
loose parts. Check that the Control Unit components are intact.
If applicable, connect the robot pneumatic system to the air distribution line paying
attention to set the system to the specified pressure value: a wrong setting of the
pressure system influences correct robot movement.
Install filters on the pneumatic system to collect any condensation.
Install the Control Unit outside the protected area: the Control Unit is not to be used
to form part of the fencing.
Check that the voltage value of the mains is consistent with that indicated on the
plate of the Control Unit.
Before electrically connecting the Control Unit, check that the circuit breaker on the
mains is locked in open position.
Connection between the Control Unit and the three-phase supply mains at the
works, is to be with a four-pole (3 phases +earth) armoured cable dimensioned
appropriately for the power installed on the Control Unit. See the product
Technical Documentation.
The power supply cable is to enter the Control Unit through the specific fairlead and
be properly clamped.
Connect the earth conductor (PE) then connect the power conductors to the main
switch.
General Safety Precautions
1-5
ge-0-0-0_01.FM
07/1007
Connect the power supply cable, first connecting the earth conductor to the circuit
breaker on the mains line, after checking with a tester that the circuit breaker
terminals are not powered. Connect the cable armouring to the earth.
Connect the signals and power cables between the Control Unit and the robot.
Connect the robot to earth or to the Control Unit or to a nearby earth socket.
Check that the Control Unit door (or doors) is/are locked with the key.
A wrong connection of the connectors could cause permanent damage to the
Control Unit components.
The C4G Control Unit manages internally the main safety interlocks (gates,
enabling pushbuttons, etc.). Connect the C4G Control Unit safety interlocks to the
line safety circuits, taking care to connect them as required by the Safety
standards. The safety of the interlock signals coming from the transfer line
(emrgency stop, gates safey devices etc) i.e. the realisation of correct and safe
circuits, is the responsibility of the Robot and Control System integrator.
The safety of the system cannot be guaranteed if these interlocks are wrongly
executed, incomplete or missing.
The safety circuit executes a controlled stop (IEC 60204-1 , class 1 stop) for the
safety inputs Auto Stop/ General Stop and Emergency Stop. The controlled stop is
only active in Automatic states; in Programming the power is cut out (power
contactors open) immediately. The procedure for the selection of the controlled
stop time (that can be set on ESK board) is contained in the Installation manual .
When preparing protection barriers, especially light barriers and access doors,
bear in mind that the robot stop times and distances are according to the stop
category (0 or 1) and the weight of the robot..
Check that the environment and working conditions are within the range specified
in the specific product Technical Documentation.
The calibration operations are to be carried out with great care, as indicated in the
Technical Documentation of the specific product, and are to be concluded
checking the correct position of the machine.
To load or update the system software (for example after replacing boards), use
only the original software handed over by COMAU Robotics & Service.
Scrupulously follow the system software uploading procedure described in the
Technical Documentation supplied with the specific product. After uploading,
always make some tests moving the robot at slow speed and remaining outside the
protected area.
Check that the barriers of the protected area are correctly positioned.
In the cell/line emergency stop circuit the contacts must be included of the control
unit emergency stop buttons, which are on X30. The push buttons are not
interlocked in the emergency stop circuit of the Control Unit.
Check that the controlled stop time is consistent with the type of Robot connected
to the Control Unit. The stop time is selected using selector switches SW1 and
SW2 on the ESK board.
General Safety Precautions
1-6
ge-0-0-0_01.FM
07/1007
Programming Mode
The robot is only to be programmed by the authorised personnel.
Before starting to program, the operator must check the Robot and Control System
to make sure that there are no potentially hazardous irregular conditions, and that
there is nobody inside the protected area.
When possible the programming should be controlled from outside the protected
area.
Before operating inside the Protected Area, the operator must make sure from
outside that all the necessary protections and safety devices are present and in
working order, and especially that the hand-held programming unit functions
correctly (slow speed, emergency stop, enabling device, etc.).
During the programming session, only the operator with the hand-held terminal is
allowed inside the Protected Area.
If the presence of a second operator in the working area is necessary when
checking the program, this person must have an enabling device interlocked with
the safety devices.
Activation of the motors (Drive On) is always to be controlled from a position
outside the range of the robot, after checking that there is nobody in the area
involved. The Drive On operation is concluded when the relevant machine status
indication is shown.
When programming, the operator is to keep at a distance from the robot to be able
to avoid any irregular machine movements, and in any case in a position to avoid
the risk of being trapped between the robot and structural parts (columns, barriers,
etc.), or between movable parts of the actual robot.
When programming, the operator is to avoid remaining in a position where parts of
the robot, pulled by gravity, could execute downward movements, or move
upwards or sideways (when installed on a sloped plane).
Testing a programmed cycle at working speed with the operator inside the
protected area, in some situations where a close visual check is necessary, is only
to be carried out after a complete test cycle at slow speed has been executed. The
test is to be controlled from a safe distance.
Special attention is to be paid when programming using the hand-held terminal: in
this situation, although all the hardware and software safety devices are active, the
robot movement depends on the operator.
During the first running of a new program, the robot may move along a path that is
not the one expected.
The modification of program steps (such as moving by a step from one point to
another of the flow, wrong recording of a step, modification of the robot position out
of the path that links two steps of the program), could give rise to movements not
envisaged by the operator when testing the program.
In both cases operate cautiously, always remaining out of the robots range of
action and test the cycle at slow speed.
General Safety Precautions
1-7
ge-0-0-0_01.FM
07/1007
Auto / Remote Automatic Mode
The activation of the automatic operation (AUTO and REMOTE states) is only to
be executed with the Robot and Control System integrated inside an area with
safety barriers properly interlocked, as specified by Safety Standards currently in
force in the Country where the installation takes place.
Before starting the automatic mode the operator is to check the Robot and Control
System and the protected area to make sure there are no potentially hazardous
irregular conditions.
The operator can only activate automatic operation after having checked:
that the Robot and Control System is not in maintenance or being repaired;
the safety barriers are correctly positioned;
that there is nobody inside the protected area;
that the Control Unit doors are closed and locked;
that the safety devices (emergency stop, safety barrier devices) are
functioning;
Special attention is to be paid when selecting the automatic-remote mode, where
the line PLC can perform automatic operations to switch on motors and start the
program.
Robot axes release
In the absence of motive power, the robot axes movement is possible by means of
optional release devices and suitable lifting devices. Such devices only enable the
brake deactivation of each axis. In this case, all the system safety devices
(including the emergency stop and the enable button) are cut out; also the robot
axes can move upwards or downwards because of the force generated by the
balancing system, or the force of gravity.
Stop distances (threshold values)
As for the stop distance threshold values for each robot type, please turn to the
COMAU Robotics & Service Dept.
Example: Considering the robot in automatic mode, in conditions of maximum
extension, maximum load and maximum speed, when the stop pushbutton is
pressed (red mushroom head pushbutton on WiTP) an NJ 370-2.7 Robot will stop
completely in approx. 85 of motion, equivalent to approx. 3000 mm displacement
measured on the TCP flange. Under these conditions indicated, the stoppage time
of the NJ 370-2.7 Robot is 1.5 seconds.
Considering the robot in programming mode (T1), when the stop pushbutton is
pressed (red mushroom head pushbutton on WiTP) an NJ 370-2.7 Robot will stop
completely in approx. 0.5 seconds.
Maintenance and Repairs
When assembled in COMAU Robotics & Service, the robot is supplied with
lubricant that does not contain substances harmful to health, however, in some
cases, repeated and prolonged exposure to the product could cause skin irritation,
or if swallowed, indisposition.
First Aid. Contact with the eyes or the skin: wash the contaminated zones with
abundant water; if the irritation persists, consult a doctor.
Before using the manual release devices, it is strongly recommended to sling the
robot, or hook to an overhead travelling crane.
General Safety Precautions
1-8
ge-0-0-0_01.FM
07/1007
If swallowed, do not provoke vomiting or take anything by mouth, see a doctor as
soon as possible.
Maintenance, trouble-shooting and repairs are only to be carried out by authorised
personnel.
When carrying out maintenance and repairs, the specific warning sign is to be
placed on the control panel of the Control Unit, stating that maintenance is in
progress and it is only to be removed after the operation has been completely
finished - even if it should be temporarily suspended.
Maintenance operations and replacement of components or the Control Unit are to
be carried out with the main switch in open position and locked with a padlock.
Even if the Control Unit is not powered (main switch open), there may be
interconnected voltages coming from connections to peripheral units or external
power sources (e.g. 24 Vdc inputs/outputs). Cut out external sources when
operating on parts of the system that are involved.
Removal of panels, protection shields, grids, etc. is only allowed with the main
switch open and padlocked.
Faulty components are to be replaced with others having the same code, or
equivalent components defined by COMAU Robotics & Service.
Trouble-shooting and maintenance activities are to be executed, when possible,
outside the protected area.
Trouble-shooting executed on the control is to be carried out, when possible
without power supply.
Should it be necessary, during trouble-shooting, to intervene with the Control Unit
powered, all the precautions specified by Safety Standards are to be observed
when operating with hazardous voltages present.
Trouble-shooting on the robot is to be carried out with the power supply cut out
(Drive off).
At the end of the maintenance and trouble-shooting operations, all deactivated
safety devices are to be reset (panels, protection shields, interlocks, etc.).
Maintenance, repairs and trouble-shooting operations are to be concluded
checking the correct operation of the Robot and Control System and all the safety
devices, executed from outside the protected area.
When loading the software (for example after replacing electronic boards) the
original software handed over by COMAU Robotics & Service is to be used.
Scrupulously follow the system software loading procedure described in the
specific product Technical Documentation; after loading always run a test cycle to
make sure, remaining outside the protected area
Disassembly of robot components (motors, balancing cylinders, etc.) may cause
uncontrolled movements of the axes in any direction: before starting a disassembly
procedure, consult the warning plates applied to the robot and the Technical
Documentation supplied.
It is strictly forbidden to remove the protective covering of the robot springs.
After replacement of the ESK module, check on the new module that the setting
of the stop time on selector switches SW1 and SW2 is consistent with the type of
Robot connected to the Control Unit.
General Safety Precautions
1-9
ge-0-0-0_01.FM
07/1007
Putting Out of Service and Dismantling
Putting out of service and dismantling the Robot and Control System is only to be
carried out by Authorised Personnel.
Bring the robot to transport position and fit the axis clamping brackets (where
applicable) consulting the plate applied on the robot and the robot Technical
Documentation.
Before stating to put out of service, the mains voltage to the Control Unit must be
cut out (switch off the circuit breaker on the mains distribution line and lock it in
open position).
After using the specific instrument to check there is no voltage on the terminals,
disconnect the power supply cable from the circuit breaker on the distribution line,
first disconnecting the power conductors, then the earth. Disconnect the power
supply cable from the Control Unit and remove it.
First disconnect the connection cables between the robot and the Control Unit,
then the earth cable.
If present, disconnect the robot pneumatic system from the air distribution line.
Check that the robot is properly balanced and if necessary sling it correctly, then
remove the robot securing bolts from the support.
Remove the robot and the Control Unit from the work area, applying the rules
indicated in the products Technical Documentation; if lifting is necessary, check the
correct fastening of the eye-bolts and use appropriate slings and equipment only.
Before starting dismantling operations (disassembly, demolition and disposal) of
the Robot and Control System components, contact COMAU Robotics & Service,
or one of its branches, who will indicate, according to the type of robot and Control
Unit, the operating methods in accordance with safety principles and safeguarding
the environment.
The waste disposal operations are to be carried out complying with the legislation
of the country where the Robot and Control System is installed.
General Safety Precautions
1-10
ge-0-0-0_01.FM
07/1007
General Safety Precautions
1-11
ge-0-0-0_01.FM
07/1007
System operating modes and states
2-1
HS-0-C4E-USO_32.fm
01/0208
2. SYSTEM OPERATING MODES
AND STATES
2.1 Foreword
This chapter describes the following:
System operating modes
System states
Stand-by function
2.2 System operating modes
The C4G Robot Control Unit can operate in four different modes that can be selected
through the status selector switch on the Robot Controller Cabinet (RCC):
Auto T (status selector switch in position T2 - optional feature)
programming (T1),
local automatic (AUTO) and
remote automatic (REMOTE).
AUTO mode is used to execute production programs; as they contain instructions for the
robot movement, to be able to start it is necessary to press the START key on the Teach
System operating modes and states
2-2
HS-0-C4E-USO_32.fm
01/0208
Pendant. The status selector switch must be set on AUTO.
Active TOOL, BASE and FRAME, cannot be changed when working in AUTO mode.
The Automatic remote mode (REMOTE) is the same as Automatic local mode
(LOCAL), but the commands (for example the start) are sent from a remote device (for
example a PLC).
The state selector switch must be set to the REMOTE position. Active TOOL, BASE and
FRAME, cannot be changed when working in AUTO mode.
The Programming mode (T1) is used to create and verify programs The robot moves,
for safety reasons, are run at a lower speed than in automatic mode (maximum robot
speed allowed in programming is 250 mm/s on the flange centre).
In Auto T mode (T2 - optional feature) the system runs as in Programming mode (T1),
except that the program testing can be executed at working speed.
If, in T2, the jog keys are used, the system will automatically reduce the speed to less
than 250 mm/s.
When the status selector switch is set to T1 or T2 (optional feature), programs can be
developed using editor environment and positions can be learnt by the Teach Pendant,
jogging the robot by means of the motion keyst; the programs can be set up using the
debug tools of the system. In programming mode, the execution of a move instruction
requires that the operator presses the START key and the enable device on the Teach
Pendant.
When the status selector switch has been set on T1, or T2 or AUTO, the system is under
the control of the operator. When the selector is set on REMOTE, the system is under
remote control (for example from PLC).
Active TOOL, BASE and FRAME, cannot be changed when working in REMOTE mode.
Before any operation can be executed that requires movement, the drives must be
powered:
if the state selector switch is in either T1 or T2 (optional) position, press in the
intermediate position the Teach Pendant Enabling Device, to power ON the drives;
tho switch them OFF and activate brakes on all axes controlled by the Control Unit,
just release the Teach Pendant Enabling Device,
if the state selector switch is in AUTO position, press the R5 softkey (Teach
Pendant right menu - it means DRIVE ON when in AUTO state), to power ON the
drives; to switch them OFF and activate brakes on all axes controlled by the
Control Unit, press the R5 softkey again (Teach Pendant right menu - now it means
DRIVE OFF).
Note
When the status selector switch is set to T2, the system generates a latched alarm
that prevents the entry to the actual T2 status, even if allowing to switch the drives
on. No movements are allowed (nor the manual one) until the latched alarm is not
acknowledged.
To enable this optional mode, the user has then to confirm the message.
The latched alarm described above is automatically reset if the selector switch is
moved to another state, but it resumes as soon as there is a return to T2.
T2 status is only enabled when the user confirms the latched alarm.
At this point the user is free to run motion programs keeping either the START key
or the enabling device pressed. The speed can be increased at will up to 100%,
hence bringing the robot to its maximum speed (the same speed that can be
reached in automatic mode).
System operating modes and states
2-3
HS-0-C4E-USO_32.fm
01/0208
Active TOOL, BASE and FRAME, cannot be changed when working in AUTO
mode.
if the state selector switch is in REMOTE position, DRIVEs ON and OFF are
remote controlled.
A detailed description follows of all the possible system states.
2.3 System states
The system status depends mainly on:
the status selector switch on the Robot Controller Cabinet (RCC)
the DRIVE ON, DRIVE OFF and HOLD keys on the Teach Pendant
system alarm
The transition from one system status to another is also influenced by the enabling
device on the Teach Pendant.
The Control Unit may be in one of these four states:
HOLD status: the robot is gradually decelerated until the stopping point is reached;
movement is suspended and also the execution of the movement program
(holdable). When there are all the necessary conditions to exit from the HOLD
status, the system returns to the previous state (programming or automatic), but to
continue to execute the movement program it is necessary to press START.
AUTO status: this is usually used to execute production programs that control the
robot movements (status selector switch positioned on AUTO or REMOTE or T2).
Active TOOL, BASE and FRAME, cannot be changed when working either in
AUTO or REMOTE mode.
PROGR status: the robot can be moved manually using the jog keys or executing
program instructions (from editor environment or by EXECUTE). In the latter case,
in order that the movement be executed, the START key and the enabling button
have to be kept pressed.
A special sub-status is AUTO-T status (optional) that, besides having all the
characteristics of the PROGR status, allows the program to be run at working
speed. This is an OPTIONAL status.
If the controlled stop function class 1 (EN 60204-1) is active, the power cut-out (opening
of the power contactor) may take place with a delay that ranges from a minimum of 1
second to a maximum of 2 seconds.
With the status selector switch positioned on T1 or T2, the power cut-out is immediate
(EN 60204-1, class 0 stop).
ALARM status: this status is entered when there is a system alarm. According to
how serious the error is, the system takes different actions, such as suspending the
program execution, deactivation of the drives, etc. A situation may occur where the
alarm cannot be reset, therefore the drives cannot be switched on.
The current system status is displayed on the first status line of the Teach Pendant (or
in the Terminal window of tool WINC4G on PC).
The figure shows a simplified diagram of the actions that determine the system
change-over from one state to another.
System operating modes and states
2-4
HS-0-C4E-USO_32.fm
01/0208
Fig. 2.1 - Simplified diagram of the system states
1. Status selector switch on T1 +HOLD released
2. HOLD or DRIVES OFF or selector switch change
3. HOLD or DRIVES OFF or selector switch change
4. Status selector switch on AUTO or REMOTE or T2 +HOLD released
Note: To perform transient 4 also the enabling device key has to be pressed
2.3.1 HOLD status
The safety rules to be complied to when operating with the Control Unit have been
studied so that the system enters the HOLD status every time a change is made in the
operating mode, passing for instance from LOCAL to PROGR mode.
To exit from the HOLD status to enable a certain operating mode, there must be all the
required safety conditions. A typical example is when the operator brings the status
selector switch to PROGR to work near the robot, holding the Teach Pendant to carry
out learning operations for the points.
In PROGR or AUTO-T, exiting from HOLD can be obtained by pressing START, this is
controlled by the system and therefore is active when an instruction or a movement
program is executed. When the START key is released again the system returns to
HOLD status.
When entering the HOLD status, the corresponding HOLD key on the Teach Pendant
is considered as pressed. Further pressure on the key causes the system to exit from
HOLD status.
If the HOLD status has been caused by pressing the DRIVE OFF key on the Teach
Pendant, the DRIVE OFF and HOLD keys must be pressed again to exit from HOLD
status. and then the DRIVE ON key to re-power the drives.
2.3.2 AUTO status
To have the system in AUTO status, the status selector switch on the Robot Control
Cabinet must be set on AUTO or REMOTE. Active TOOL, BASE and FRAME, cannot
be changed when working either in AUTO or REMOTE mode.
System operating modes and states
2-5
HS-0-C4E-USO_32.fm
01/0208
In AUTO status, to start programs ready for execution, press the START key on the
Teach Pendant or activate the START input from remote device.
Conditions that change the system status from AUTO to HOLD are:
status selector switch changed to another position;
DRIVE OFF or HOLD pressed;
system alarm.
To return to AUTO, bring the selector switch back to the required position, and press
again the previous buttons (DRIVE OFF and/or HOLD). To continue the movement
program execution, press START after making sure that the drives are powered (DRIVE
2.3.3 PROGR status
PROGR status is active when:
the status selector switch is set to T1.
In this state the robot can be moved manually, using the jog keys on the Teach Pendant.
It is also possible to run programs from IDE environment (see IDE Page in Use of C4G
Control Unit manual) to check that they are correct and if necessary make
changes. Movements are at slow speed.
2.3.4 AUTO-T status (optional)
This status is active when:
status selector switch is set to (T2) and latched alarm confirmed
(see Note).
In this status the movements can be run, at full speed, from the Teach Pendant,
requiring that the START key, together with the enabling device, is kept pressed by the
operator to execute the move.
The system passes from AUTO_T status to HOLD status when:
the Enabling Device is released by the operator. This also causes the stop of the
move, that can be resumed by pressing the Enabling Device again. The second
line of the status window will ask for this pushbutton to be pressed.
the status selector switch is changed to any other position
the HOLD key is pressed, or the START key is released.
2.3.5 ALARM status
The system enters ALARM status when an alarm is generated. An error message is
displayed on the second status line of the system screen and the associated LED, next
to the ALARM key on the Teach Pendant, lights up.
There are different conditions that can generate an alarm and the action to be taken to
exit from ALARM status and bring the system back to the previous state vary according
to how serious the error is.
System operating modes and states
2-6
HS-0-C4E-USO_32.fm
01/0208
2.4 Stand-by function
The purpose of the Stand-by function is to cut down the current consumption when the
robot is stationary.
The function is automatically activated when the Control Unit is in local automatic or
remote automatic mode and after the robot has remained stationary for a time defined
by variable $TUNE [27];this function activates the motor brakes to keep the static
position of the robot. The value of variable $TUNE [27], set by COMAU, is 120 seconds;
if this variable is set to 0 the function is deactivated.
The Stand-by function is automatically deactivated at the first request to start movement
again (START, RESUME) from the system.
The system Stand-by status is displayed in the status bar of the Teach Pendant. To
display the state of a single arm, read this status on the Status sub-page, the Motion
page on TP4i/WiTP or send the DisplayArmStatus (DAS) command.
The safety precautions are to be scrupulously observed regarding this operating
condition of the Controller.
System operating modes and states
2-7
HS-0-C4E-USO_32.fm
01/0208
Turn-Set and Calibration - basic concepts
3-1
HS-0-C4E-USO_35.fm
01/0906
3. TURN-SET AND CALIBRATION -
BASIC CONCEPTS
3.1 Foreword
The purpose of this chapter is to describe the basic concepts and the terminology for the
management of robot axes position information. The description of the operating
procedures is contained in the chapter TURN-SET AND CALIBRATION -
OPERATING PROCEDURES, that specifically regards the robot used.
This chapter contains the basic information on the following topics:
Terminology used
Turn-set
Calibration
3.2 Terminology
TRANSDUCER: There are two types of position transducers: encoder and
resolver.
NUMBER OF TRANSDUCER TURNS: during the robot axis movement, the
transducer may make several turns; the number of turns is initialised through the
calibration or the turn-set.
AXIS VALUE: the value of an axis contains all the information needed to determine
the exact position of an axis in space;
VALUE RECONSTRUCTION: when the Control Unit is powered on, the system
software, among the various initialisations, reconstructs the value of the robot
axes.
The system software checks this value; in fact, it checks that the difference
between the reconstructed position and the position before shut-down is below a
certain threshold. If the threshold is exceeded, the Control Unit displays the error
59411 SAX: movement after shut-down and leaves it to the operator to check
that the physical position of the robot corresponds to the new value.
CALIBRATION POSITION: a pre-set position that has been checked using
specific equipment (dial gauges, supports, calibration fixtures). The calibration
position is a reference position in the robot working space that serves to initialise
the value of each axis.
CALIBRATION CONSTANTS: the calibration constant is the difference between
the datum read by the transducer and the nominal position of the robot axis that
the transducer should assume in that particular position of the robot axis. In fact,
since the positioning of the transducer as to the robot joint is casual, (because it
depends on how the transducer has been mounted), it is necessary to correct the
Turn-Set and Calibration - basic concepts
3-2
HS-0-C4E-USO_35.fm
01/0906
actual position of the transducer according to the nominal position required by the
robot axis.
The calibration constant is defined inside a transducer turn and is stored in variable
$CAL_DATA. It is represented in motor turns and is a value between -0.5
(excluded) and +0.5 (included). The calibration constant described in variable
$CAL_DATA can be read through the CAV (Configure, Arm, View_cal) instruction.
CALIBRATION ASCII FILE: the calibration file
UD:\SYS\<$SYS_ID>_CAL<num_arm>.PDL (where $SYS_ID indicates the
system identification, for example NH4_001) is an ASCII file with syntax of a PDL2
file, where the calibration constants ($CAL_DATA[n]) and other typical data of the
robot are stored.
NVRAM - MCP: the memory used to save the characteristic information of the robot
associated to the Control Unit, the calibration constants and the length of the
levers. If the SMP+, NVRAM-MCP board is installed, it is the partition, on the actual
board, for the motion process (Motion Control Process); if the MCP board is
installed, it refers to the MCP board memory.
3.3 Turn-set
The purpose of the turn-set is to update the number of transducer turns only,
should it occur that the when switched on again, the Control Unit has lost this
value.
The operation consists in bringing the axis involved to the calibration position, using the
locating notches, and giving the required command. No special equipment is needed,
because the only value initialised is the number of turns of the transducer.
The turn-set operation is required when
there has been axis movement with the control off (for example when the error
59411 SAX - movement after shut-down) is displayed.
events take place that cause the loss of the number of turns only, and therefore do
not require the execution of the calibration procedure. On the Teach Pendant
status window or on the PV video the text Ar:TURN is displayed.
According to whether the turn-set is executed with the robot in system calibration
position or in user calibration position, we shall have:
Turn-set on system calibration position
Turn-set on user calibration position
Turn-set for robot axes with multi-turn stroke
3.3.1 Turn-set on system calibration position
Enables the initialising of the number of transducer turns of the individual robot axes, in
the system calibration position (calibration position pre-defined by COMAU
Robotics).
For further information see System calibration ($CAL_SYS).
Turn-Set and Calibration - basic concepts
3-3
HS-0-C4E-USO_35.fm
01/0906
3.3.2 Turn-set on user calibration position
Enables the initialising of the number of transducer turns of the individual robot axes, in
the user calibration position (out of range position defined by the user).
For further information see User calibration ($CAL_USER).
3.3.3 Turn-set for robot axes with multi-turn stroke
With robot axes that are able to execute the multi-turn stroke, it may happen that when
carrying out the TURN SET procedure, the mechanical calibration notches are
misaligned (this condition can occur when the robot axis, having made one or more
complete rotations, positions in a mechanical turn that is different to that of the original
calibration).
Fig. 3.1 - Axis Positioning Error in TURN SET
If the conditions described above occur, do not send the TURN SET command (the axis
would be calibrated in a wrong position), but restore the correct position by performing
one of these procedures:
1. Turn the axis and make attempts to find the axis turn position where the original
calibration was executed. Align the notches and run the TURN SET command.
When the correct position has been resumed, the message Command Completed
will appear on the terminal
otherwise, as an alternative
In the condition indicated above, when moving the axis to align the notches, a
positioning error message is shown on the terminal.
Fig. 3.2 - Axis Positioning Correction and Error Message
Turn-Set and Calibration - basic concepts
3-4
HS-0-C4E-USO_35.fm
01/0906
2. Make the complete axis calibration (see the Chapter - Turn-set and Calibration -
Operating Procedures)
Fig. 3.3 - Correct Axis Positioning Message
3.4 Calibration
The purpose of the calibration procedure is to establish the position of a robot axis
referring it to an ideal robot. This makes it possible to initialise the values of the robot
axes and to make the position variables used in the robot programs universal.
During the calibration procedure, when the desired axis is in the calibration position, two
values are stored:
the deviation, inside a transducer turn, between the value of the actual position and
that of the axis nominal position,
the number of transducer turns.
The notches on the individual axes make it possible to execute future turn-set operations
on a robot that has already been installed.
The recovery of the calibration (executed by COMAU), if necessary, is to be executed
when first putting the robot into operation.
The basic concepts are described below for:
System calibration
User calibration
Remember that executing the calibration operation (Configure Arm Calibrate -
CAC) having simply positioned the robot axes on the locating notches without
using the opportune equipment, is an operation that does not guarantee the
necessary robot positioning precision.
Subsequently, the calibration does not need to be executed again, unless there is
a mechanical failure that involves the replacement of a component of the
kinematic chain, or in the case of impacts that damage the robot structure.
Turn-Set and Calibration - basic concepts
3-5
HS-0-C4E-USO_35.fm
01/0906
3.4.1 System calibration
To initialise the robot axis values in the system calibration position (calibration
position predefined by COMAU Robotics - $CAL_SYS).
3.4.2 User calibration
User calibration defines a new calibration position that is different to that of the
system.
This type of calibration (commonly called out-of-range calibration) can be used when
the system position is difficult to reach once the robot is inserted in the final application,
and therefore it becomes necessary to define a different calibration position, called user
calibration position ($CAL_USER).
To determine the correct calibration position, special equipment has to be used
(dial gauges, supports, etc.) to determine with the necessary precision the
position of each individual axis.
It is the responsibility of the user to provide the appropriate instruments and to
check the correct positioning of the robot in any user re-calibrations, especially
regarding the arrangement of the locating notches.
Turn-Set and Calibration - basic concepts
3-6
HS-0-C4E-USO_35.fm
01/0906
Fig. 3.4 - Summary of Calibration and Turn-Set Operations
1. TURN-SET command
2. CALIBRATION command
Saving the calibration constants
3. NVRAM MCP
4. UD:\SYS in file.C4G
5. UD:\SYSin ASCII calibration file ($SYS_ID_CAL.PDL)
6. Hard copy
Robot motion in Programming mode
4-1
HS-0-C4E-USO_33.fm
00/0607
4. ROBOT MOTION IN
PROGRAMMING MODE
4.1 Introduction
In this chapter, reference will be made to the TP4i/WiTP Teach Pendant as the device
to control the robot motion in programming status (status selector switch in position T1).
A detailed description follows about :
Reference frames
System reference frames
Manual motion
Manual motion in WRIST_J NT mode
Manual motion of a single arm system
Manual motion of auxiliary axes, slides and rotating columns
Manual motion with Controller multi-arm configuration
Motion instruction in programming status
4.2 Reference frames
A Cartesian reference system, or reference set of three, is a geometrical concept to
enable the representation of an object in space. For example, the corner of a table may
be chosen as a reference system to represent the table. The same method can be
applied for a book lying on a table, as for a weld gun mounted on the flange of a robot.
A co-ordinates conversion describes the position of one reference system in relation to
another. This is described as a POSITION variable. For example, if a table is located in
a room, its position in relation to the room is indicated by POSITION p_table, that
describes the co-ordinates conversion between the two reference systems. The
co-ordinates conversion can also be used to calculate the position of an object in relation
to different reference systems. For example, a book with a position in relation to the
corner of the table is p_book and will have the position (p_table:p_book) in relation to
the corner of the room. The sign (:) indicates the relevant position operation, and makes
it possible to compose the effect of various co-ordinate conversions. For further
information, see the PDL2 Programming Language Manual.
For any further information and/or explanations, see the relevant chapter Use of
the TP4i/WiTP Teach Pendant, in the Use of C4G Control Unit manual.
Robot motion in Programming mode
4-2
HS-0-C4E-USO_33.fm
00/0607
4.3 System reference frames
The Controller has three system variables ($BASE, $TOOL and $UFRAME) that permit
the description of the main co-ordinate conversions. Before starting to explain these
conversions, it is necessary to define some reference sets-of-three.
The $TOOL variable describes the position of the TCP frame in relation to the flange;
the $BASE variable describes the position of the base frame in relation to the world
frame; finally, the $UFRAME variable describes the position of the workpiece in relation
to the world frame.
The POS conversion indicates the recorded point P where the TCP will position when
executing the program. It must be remembered that all the POSITIONS recorded are
defined in relation to the user reference frame (defined by $UFRAME, with certain
$BASE and $TOOL values).
Fig. 4.1 - System reference frame and movement of the
co-ordinates
1. Flange frame
2. Tool frame
3. Recorded position
4. User frame
5. Base frame
6. World frame
Lets now imagine a pen fitted on the flange of the robot that has to write the word
COMAU on the table. The $BASE conversion defines the point where the robot base is
World frame Workshop reference frame in relation to where the
machines are positioned
Base frame frame that indicates the robot base
User frame frame that indicates the workpiece
Flange frame frame that indicates the robot flange
TCP frame frame that indicates the tool tip
Remember that, changing $TOOL or $BASE or $UFRAME, the same position
(POS) corresponds to a different actual position of the robot!
Robot motion in Programming mode
4-3
HS-0-C4E-USO_33.fm
00/0607
located, the $TOOL movement indicates the pen and the $UFRAME movement
indicates the position of the table.
4.4 Manual motion
The manual movement of the arm is necessary in certain circumstances, among which
when learning (recording) the positions or during maintenance of the tool fitted on the
arm. The black keys on the TP4i/WiTP Teach Pendant are used for manual motion. To
be able to make the move it is necessary to have the system in programming status, i.e.
with the status selector switch in position T1, and the Enabling Device pressed.
Before starting to move, the movement mode and the speed should be selected.
From the Motion page of the Teach Pendant, Basic sub-page (COORD field), one of the
following modes can be selected to move the arm:
JOINT - joints mode. The +/- keys are associated to each of the axes of the
selected arm; the keys associated to any auxiliary axes present follow those of the
arm (typically they are keys 7 and 8 (+/-)). When one of the keys is pressed, the
corresponding axis moves in the positive or the negative direction, according to the
directions indicated on the plate on the arm.
BASE - linear movement mode according to the tool reference x,y,z frame (or TCP
frame). The first three '+/-' keys (on the left) are used for linear motion in the
direction of the three axes of the world reference system); the next three '+/-' keys
(on the right) are for the rotation of the tool around the same axes keeping the TCP
position unchanged.. It must be remembered that the world frame is not defined
directly by any system variable; in fact, it is the robot base that is represented in
relation to the world by means of the $BASE variable.
TOOL - linear movement mode according to the tool reference x,y,z frame (or TCP
frame). The first three +/- keys allow linear movement in the direction, of the three
axes of the tool reference system (defined by the $TOOL variable); the next three
+/- keys are for the tool rotation around the same axes keeping the TCP position
unchanged (tool working point).
UFRAME - linear movement mode according to the user reference x,y,z frame (for
example the frame that describes the workpiece). The first three +/- keys allow
linear movement in the direction of the three axes of the user reference system
(defined by the $UFRAME variable); the next three +/- keys are for the tool
rotation around the same axes keeping the TCP position unchanged.
The speed of the manual motion can be selected with the +% and -% keys that act on a
percentage value shown on the Teach Pendant status bar. This percentage value is
called general override and does not only act on the manual movement speed, but on
all types of movements, both in programming and in automatic mode.
The TCP movement speed, during manual movements, is always lower than the safety
speed of 250 mm/s also in joints mode. In the Cartesian modes (Tool, Uframe, Base)
the maximum speed that can be reached is limited by the system variable
$J OG_SPD_OVR that usually has values equal to 50% (i.e. half the safety speed). This
value can be changed to adapt the standard manual movement speed to the individual
programming requirements.
Robot motion in Programming mode
4-4
HS-0-C4E-USO_33.fm
00/0607
The procedure for arm manual movement of a robotic cell varies slightly according to
the cell controller configuration. The following paragraphs describe the main details for
each typical situation.
4.5 Manual motion in WRIST_JNT mode
In Cartesian mode movement (Tol, Usr, Bas) of certain types of arms, it is more
convenient to change the orientation of the tool to a mode that does not rotate around a
Cartesian axis, but moves the axes of the robot wrist directly (the wrist axes, for a 6-axis
robot are the last three). This is useful for machines with less than 6 axes since their
capacity to rotate the tool is limited and it is not possible to obtain exactly what is
required. It is also useful when passing through singularity point. For some types of robot
the WRIST_J NT mode may not exist.
The mode on the TP4i/WiTP Teach Pendant, can be selected from the Motion page,
Basic sub-page, COORD field. The WRIST_J OINT mode changes the behaviour of the
BASE, TOOL and UFRAME modes; the corresponding texts change to WR-BASE,
WR-TOOL and WR-UFRAME. The Joint mode remains unchanged.
The difference in the robot movements is most evident regarding the keys to change the
geometry, that is, keys 4+/-, 5+/- e 6+/-. In WR-BASE, WR-TOOL e WR-UFRAME
modes, these keys are associated directly to each wrist axis and when one of these keys
is pressed the corresponding axis is moved leaving the positions of the other wrist axes
unchanged. This operation, however holds the TCP position because the first three axes
move to offset the change in orientation. It is to be noted that if the robot has only 2 wrist
axes (for example 4 and 5), only keys 4+/- and 5+/-, can be enabled, whereas only key
4 will be enabled for a four-axis robot. For the 1X+/-, 2Y+/- and 3Z+/- keys the difference
is less obvious: the movement is linear in the direction required but the geometry of the
tool is not constant along the path since the wrist axes are not moved.
4.6 Manual motion of a single arm system
To execute the manual movement of a single arm it is sufficient to set the status selector
switch on T1, choose the most appropriate mode and press the +/- keys, keeping the
Enabling Device on the Teach Pendant pressed.
4.7 Manual motion of auxiliary axes, slides and
rotating columns
The auxiliary axes can be added to an Arm in order to move different types of
positioners. Another example of auxiliary axis is the motor driven spot welding gun.
Before moving in Cartesian mode (Tool, Uframe, Base) the correct definition
should be checked of the reference systems, especially the declaration of the tool
frame through the $TOOL variable. A wrong description of the tool causes errors
in learning the points and does not keep the TCP position unchanged during
orientation movements. A good method to check the correctness of $TOOL is to
check that the TCP remains fixed while changing the orientation of the tool.
Robot motion in Programming mode
4-5
HS-0-C4E-USO_33.fm
00/0607
An example of an integrated auxiliary axes group is a roto-translating column or a
gantry.
J ogging an auxiliary axis is usually only possible in joint mode (JOINT) using the
corresponding AUX A/AUX B +e - keys.
The manual movement of an auxiliary axis is usually only possible in joint mode (JOINT)
using the corresponding AUX A/AUX B +e - keys.
To associate the auxiliary axes to AUX A and AUX B keys, it is needed to open the
Motion Page - subpage COOP - section AUX Jog, on the Teach Pendant.
If the Teach Pendant is the wireless version (WiTP), the AUX hardkey is also available.
However, if the auxiliary axis moves a slide, a column or a built-in gripper, it can be
moved also in Cartesian modes (BASE, TOOL and UFRAME) using the same keys as
for JOINT mode.
J ogging in cartesian mode, allows to move the integrated axis without moving the TCP
(thus, the robot joints can move and follow the auxiliary axis/axes motion, in order not to
move the TCP from its initial position).
4.8 Manual motion with Controller multi-arm
configuration
In the case of Controller multi-arm configuration, it is necessary to select the arm to be
moved using the Motion page on the TP4i/WiTP Teach Pendant and checking the
current value on the status bar.
It is also possible to activate two arms at the same time that belong to two different
machines. To do this it is necessary to be in DRIVE OFF status and change the current
arm on the Motion page, Basic sub-page (Arm field).
For manual movement of integrated arms (a particular application of multi-arm system)
see the specific Cap. Motion Control.
4.9 Motion instruction in programming status
To program robot movements requires a certain knowledge of the C4G system and the
PDL2 programming language. However, before creating an actual program, some
For further information, please see C4G Control Unit Use - chp. Motion Page - par.
COOP (optional), AUX J OG section).
For further information, please see C4G Control Unit Use - chp. Use of the Teach
Pendant- par. WiTP).
Note that when teaching positions for auxiliary axes, it is recommended to use
XTNDPOS.
Robot motion in Programming mode
4-6
HS-0-C4E-USO_33.fm
00/0607
simple moves can be made with the immediate execution of an instruction. To do this,
the system has to be in programming state with the EXECUTE command called (from
Service page of the Teach Pendant) that allows the immediate execution of an
instruction.
In its most simple form, the instruction consists of the key words MOVE TO followed by
the destination position. The most useful move instruction in the first stages of use is:
MOVE TO $CAL_SYS
This produces a movement of each axis to its calibration position. In its more complete
form the arm to be moved, the type of path and the destination can be selected.
The arm is assigned by the key word ARM (num_arm) that is placed immediately after
the word MOVE. The definition can be omitted if the system has only one arm (for
example an NH4 robot (6 axes) is one arm only) or if the default arm predefined by the
system is to be moved.
The type of path may be joints, linear or circular and is described by the predefined
constants J OINT, LINEAR and CIRCULAR respectively (see the Cap. Motion Control
for further details). If the type of trajectory is not indicated, the value defined in the
$MOVE_TYPE system variable is valid, that is usually set at J OINT by the system.
The destination points are typically learnt inside a program, but they can also be
assigned directly in the instruction line of EXECUTE. Two ways to assign the destination
point that are most useful for installation and maintenance are given below. A Cartesian
point can be assigned by the built-in POS that allows, as parameters, the three
co-ordinates x, y and z where the TCP is to be taken, three angles for tool orientation
and a configuration string. All the positions of this type are called POSITION and are
always referred to the reference systems; the configuration string can usually be left
empty. The following is a valid position that defines a point at 100 mm from the user
reference in direction z: POS (0,0,100,0,0,0,). For further information see the
Cap. Motion Control and the PDL2 Programming Language manual. A destination
point can also define the position to be reached by each arm axis (including auxiliary
axes). To do so, write the values separated by a comma (in the correct order) and
enclose the complete declaration in a brace. A missing value leaves the position of the
corresponding axis unchanged. The following is a joint type position, that requires axis
1 to move 10 degrees from the zero position, leaves axis 2 stationary, takes axis 3 to
-30 degrees and leaves the wrist unchanged: {10, ,-30}.
Some examples follow for valid movement instructions (for further information see the
PDL2 Programming Language Manual).
MOVE LINEAR TO POS(100,200,300,0,0,0,) linear movement of pre-defined arm on a point of
Cartesian co-ordinates x=100, y=200 and z=300
and the frame of the tool with the same orientation
as the user frame
MOVE J OINT TO POS(0,0,0,0,180,0,) joints type movement of the predefined arm on a
point of Cartesian co-ordinates x=0, y=0 and z=0
and axis z of the tool frame facing the opposite
direction to the z of the user reference
MOVE J OINT TO {0,0,0,0,0,0} joints type movement of the first six axes of the
default arm on the zero positions
MOVE J OINT TO {, , , , ,90} movement of axis 6 only of the default arm on the
position of 90 degrees
Robot motion in Programming mode
4-7
HS-0-C4E-USO_33.fm
00/0607
MOVE LINEAR TO {45} linear movement that brings the arm to a position
that differs from the initial position for axis 1 only,
that is brought to 45 degrees. During the linear
movement of the TCP all the axes of the arm can
move
MOVE ARM[1] LINEAR TO POS(100,100,100,0,0,0,) linear movement of arm 1 that takes the TCP to a
certain Cartesian position in relation to the user
frame
MOVE ARM[2] J OINT TO POS(0,0,0,0,180,0,) joints movement of arm 2 that brings the TCP to a
certain Cartesian position in relation to the user
frame
MOVE ARM[1] LINEAR TO {0,0,0, , ,} linear movement that brings the first arm to a
Cartesian position where the first three axes have
no value, whereas the wrist axes return to the initial
position. During the TCP linear movement all the
axes of the arm can move
MOVE ARM[2] J OINT TO {-90} movement of second arm that moves only axis 1 to
the position of 90 degrees in negative direction
MOVE CIRCULAR TO POS(100,100,0,0,0,0,) VIA
POS(0,200,0,0,0,0,)
movement of pre-defined arm that joins the starting
point to POS (100,100,0,0,0,0,) with a
circumference that passes through
POS (0,200,0,0,0,0,)
Before executing a movement it is best to check the correct definition of the
reference systems, especially the declarations of the tool frame and the user
reference ($TOOL, $BASE and $UFRAME). These declarations can only be
ignored in the case of joint movements on joint points, for example MOVE JOINT
TO $CAL_SYS now MOVE TO {0,90,-100,20,20,200}, or MOVE TO JOINTPOS. In all
other cases the consequences could be dangerous with risks for the personnel
and for the equipment. In particular if the description of the tool is not correct
(wrong $TOOL) the TCP will not reach the required point, nor will it execute a
correct linear or circular path. Regarding the description of the user frame
($UFRAME) it is important to check that, at the moment the movement is
executed, this is identical to that which was active when the point was stored.
Otherwise the positioning will be different to that stored. However, the same paths
can be executed again with different $UFRAME values, since this performance is
necessary for some applications that require a specific shifting of the whole
program inside the work space (palletizing applications).
It is also necessary to always check the correct definition of the load used,
regarding the weight, centre of gravity and inertia. This data can be automatically
calculated by the Controller, given a Tool (also a Tool plus a part), applying the
Payload identification (optional function) included in the TO_SET application (that
can be activated from the TP4i/WiTP Teach Pendant, Setup page, ToolFrame
sub-page).
The verification checks that the recorded load data corresponds with the
$TOOL_MASS, $TOOL_CNTR and tool $TOOL_INERTIA[1..6] variables currently
in use.
Robot motion in Programming mode
4-8
HS-0-C4E-USO_33.fm
00/0607
Motion Control
5-1
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
5. MOTION CONTROL
5.1 Overview
This chapter contains the description of the C4G Robot Control Unit motion
environment, with the exception of manual handling (Teach Pendant jog keys) which is
described in the Cap. Robot motion in Programming mode, and for the optionals that are
dealt with further on in other chapters of this manual.
Information is supplied about the following topics:
Frames of Reference and coordinates transformation
Trajectory and Trajectory Recovery
Position Checking
Speed Control
Acceleration and Deceleration
Motion termination
Process Resume
Continuous Motion
Remote Tool System;
Integrated Movement;
Current chapter contains many references to predefined variables and instructions of
PDL2 language. For further information, refer to PDL2 Programming Language
Manual.
5.2 Frames of Reference
For our purposes, the following terminology should be defined.
Cartesian frame of reference is a geometrical concept that represents an object
positioned in space. For example, the corner of a table can be the frame of reference
that represents the table. The same can be done with a book, as well as with a welding
gun mounted on the robot flange.
A Coordinate transformation represents the position of one frame of reference with
respect to another. It is described by a POSITION variable. For example, if a table is
located in a room then the position of the table with respect to the room is expressed by
the POSITION p_table, which describes the coordinate transformation between the two
frames of reference. The coordinate transformation can be used to compute the position
of an object with respect to another coordinate frame. For example, a book whose
position with respect to the table corner is p_book, is located at the position
(p_table:p_book) with respect to the corner of the room. The (:) is the relative position
operator used to compose the effect of different coordinate transformations. See Data
Representation chapter of PDL2 Programming Language manual for further
Motion Control
5-2
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
information.
5.2.1 System Frame of Reference
C4G Controller Unit has got three system variables ($BASE, $TOOL and $UFRAME)
which allow to describe the coordinates tranformations. Before describing the meaning
of such transformations, it is necessary to define some frames of reference.
The $TOOL variable describes the position of the TCP frame with respect to the flange
frame; the $BASE coordinate transformation describes the position of the base frame
with respect to the world frame; the $UFRAME transformation describes the position of
the workpiece with respect to the world. The POS transformation represents the taught
point P that will be reached by the TCP during the execution of the program. Note that
all the taught POSITIONs are defined with respect to the user frame of reference
(defined by $UFRAME).
To better understand, suppose that the corner of the room is the world frame, and a
robot is located beside a table as shown in the following picture Fig. 5.1 - System
Frames of Reference and Coordinates Transformation.
Fig. 5.1 - System Frames of Reference and Coordinates
Transformation
1. Flange frame
2. Tool frame
3. Recorded position
4. User frame
5. Base frame
6. Boundary frame
Suppose further that the robot has a pen mounted on the flange and it has to write
COMAU on the table. $BASE defines where the robot is located, the $TOOL
transformation describes the pen, and the $UFRAME transformation defines the
World Frame The factory plant frame of reference with respect to which all
machines are positioned
Base Frame The frame located on the robot base
User Frame The frame located on the workpiece
Flange Frame The frame located on the robot flange
TCP Frame The frame located on the tool top
Motion Control
5-3
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
position of the table with respect to the room.
These system frames will simplify some operations. For example:
if the robot were picked up and placed at the opposite side of the table, it would be
enough to redefine $BASE and restart writing without modifying any point;
if the pen were replaced with a bigger one, it would be enough to redefine $TOOL
and restart writing without modifying any point;
if the table were moved inside the room, it would be enough to redefine $UFRAME.
Note that in some applications $BASE and $UFRAME can be left equal to zero: this
means that the world frame and the workpiece frame are located at the base of the robot
and all taught POSITIONs are referred to the base of the robot. On the contrary, the
$TOOL transformation must always be correctly defined to achieve the desired path of
the TCP (Tool Center Point) along the trajectory.
5.2.2 Base System of Reference definition
The $BASE predefined variable describes the position of the base of the robot in relation
to the external world.
It is useful to offset repositioning of the robot inside the cell or to repeat the same
program on the same part but with different robots. Also, a well-defined base reference
simplifies calculation of points (POSITION) during off-line programming.
To calculate $BASE correctly, the POS_FRAMEPOS_FRAME function can be used as
follows (the program must be run in the PROGRAM EDIT environment and with Step
mode set to Statement):
PROGRAM set base
VAR cor ner , x, xy : POSI TI ON
BEGI N
$UFRAME : = POS ( 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, " )
$TOOL : = . . . - - cor r et t ament e def i ni t o
- - Move the TCP to three points of the part using the jog keys
and store
- - t ast i di j og e memor i zzar e
- - the corner, x and xy POSITIONS pressing the MOD key of the
TP.
- - Then perform the following instruction.
$UFRAME : = POS_FRAME( cor ner , x, xy)
END set base
5.2.3 Flange Tooling definition
Cartesian motions (straight lines for example) are defined for the TCP (tool centre point)
only. For example, when a straight line motion of the TCP involves large changes in tool
orientation during the motion, the tool flange does not necessarily move in a straight line.
Therefore, in order for Cartesian motions to work properly, the position (both location
and orientation) of the TCP, with respect to the tool flange, must be properly defined.
Proper definition of the TCP orientation is also necessary for the approach vector used in
MOVE NEAR and MOVE AWAY statements to be properly defined.
The position of the TCP is defined by defining a transformation from the tool flange
frame of reference to the TCP frame of reference. The predefined variable, $TOOL,
Motion Control
5-4
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
defines this transformation. The position of flange frame of reference is fixed for each
model of robot and is documented in the hardware manual for the specific robot. It is the
operators responsibility to define $TOOL for the specific tooling to be mounted on the
flange.
Two sets of tool parameters define the $TOOL transformation:
Three tool dimensions define the location component of $TOOL. These values,
measured in millimeters, represent the tool center point (TCP) offset with respect
to the flange center;
Three tool rotations define the orientation component of $TOOL. These values,
measured in degrees, represent three rotation angles called Euler angles.
5.2.3.1 TCP Offset definition
The offset for tool dimensions can be measured on the arm itself or calculated
theoretically based on the tool design. The parameters can vary according to the tool
assembly position in that they must be defined according to the tool z axis (ref. z
Tool), commonly referred to as the approach vector.
To measure the tool dimensions, proceed as follows:
a. Begin with no tools on the robot. Assign zero values to all six tool parameters of
$TOOL.

$TOOL : = POS ( 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, )
b. Identify x, y, and z axes directions of the tool. (Note: For SMART robot, base axes
are parallel to tool axes when the robot is pointing upward and small axes are at
mid-travel as shown in Fig. 5.2 - Zero position).
c. Move the robot to a known position, for example, the zero position (Fig. 5.2 - Zero
position shows the zero position for SMART robots. Fig. 5.3 - Known position
shows a known position (calibration position) for SMART robots).
d. Check the direction of the three tool axes by jogging the robot using the TOOL jog
coordinate type.
e. Mount the tool and measure the tool centre offsets (positive or negative) with
respect to the flange centre along all three axes. Measurements should be in
millimetres.
f. Assign measured values to $TOOL using a PDL2 assignment statement:
$TOOL : = POS ( x, y, z, e1, e2, e3, )
Motion Control
5-5
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
Fig. 5.2 - Zero position
Fig. 5.3 - Known position
5.2.3.2 Calculating the Rotation Angles
Rotation values are independent from offset values and must be calculated after the
offset values have been assigned. Depending on the application, the rotation values can
be omitted. In this case, tool orientation will be along an axis parallel to the flange axis
Motion Control
5-6
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
that starts at the TCP. The rotation values are positive for counterclockwise rotation with
the rotation axis pointed toward the observer. These values can be calculated using one
of the two methods described below.
5.2.3.2.1 FIRST METHOD
Calculate three rotations that will align the flange z axis with the tool z axis. The
rotations, which correspond to Euler angles, are designated (e1) rotation around z, (e2)
rotation around y, and (e3) rotation around the new z.
Note that:
it is not possible to rotate axis x;
rotation around y must be between 0 and 180 degrees;
rotation around z must be between -180 and 180 degrees.
Assign the rotation values to $TOOL using the PDL2 assignment statement:
$TOOL : = POS ( x, y, z, e1, e2, e3, )
Some example calculations follow. In the following diagrams, u indicates the tool z axis.
Example A
Tool z axis (u) coincides with axis z of the flange.
In this case no rotation assignment is required:
(e1, e2, e3) =(0, 0, 0)
Example B
Tool z axis (u) coincides with axis y of the flange.
The following rotations should be performed:
a. Rotate 90 degrees around axis z
Motion Control
5-7
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
b. Rotate 90 degrees around axis y.
c. Rotate 180 degrees around the new axis z.
The tool z axis (u) now coincides with the flange z axis.
The rotation angles (e1, e2, e3) are (90, 90,180).
Example C
Tool z axis (u) is at 90 degrees with respect to the flange z
axis in the direction -y.
Rotation angles are (-90, 90, 180).
Example D
Tool z axis (u) is at 90 degrees with respect to the flange z
axis in the direction x.
Rotation angles are (0,90,180).
Motion Control
5-8
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
5.2.3.2.2 SECOND METHOD
Use the three rotation controls on the teach pendant to move:
the Tool z axis parallel and in accordance with the base z axis;
the axis which is to become Tool axis x parallel and in accordance with the base x
axis of the user frame.
After these two moves, the final Tool axis y is consequently parallel with the base y axis.
The angle parameters alpha, beta, epsilon can be read with the DISPLAY ARM
POSITION command (DAP).
Tool parameters will be given by:
rotation 1 =180 degrees - epsilon (-360 degrees);
rotation 2 =beta;
rotation 3 =180 degrees - alfa (-360 degrees).
(It is needed to add (-360 degrees) if the value of rotation exceeds 180 degrees).
The angle values to be assigned are obtained by rounding off those calculated (typically
rounding off is to 0, 90, or 180 degrees).
5.2.3.3 User System of Reference definition
The $UFRAME predefined variable can be used to describe the position of the
workpiece with respect to the world. It is useful to compensate the relocation of the
workpiece or to execute the same program on workpieces in different positions. Besides
a well defined user frame can simplify the computation of positions when doing an
off-line.
To compute the correct value of $UFRAME, the POS_FRAME built-in can be used as
follows (the program should be executed in the PROGRAM EDIT environment with the
Step modality set to Statement):
PROGRAM set f r ame
VAR cor ner , x, xy : POSI TI ON
Example E
Tool z axis (u) is at 90 degrees with respect to the flange
z axis in the direction -x.
Rotation angles are (180, 90, 180).
The TCP is calculated at the tool closing point. Any safety flange logically belongs
to the tool and therefore increases the z offset.
Motion Control
5-9
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
BEGI N
$UFRAME : = POS( 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, " )
$TOOL : = . . . - - correctly defined
- - Jog the TCP upon three point on the workpiece and teach the
POSITIONs
- - corner, x and xy pressing the MOD key on the TP.
- - Then execute the following statement.
$UFRAME : = POS_FRAME( cor ner , x, xy)
END set f r ame
5.3 Trajectory
It represents an Arm motion from an initial position to a final position.
The motion trajectory between two taught positions is generated by interpolating various
sets of variables from their initial values at the start position to their final values at the
destination position. The predefined variable $MOVE_TYPE indicates the type of
interpolation to be used. It is a program-specific variable (one for each active program).
The predefined constants J OINT, LINEAR, or CIRCULAR can be assigned to
$MOVE_TYPE. The trajectory can be also expressed in the move statements by
assigning the reserved words J OINT, LINEAR or CIRCULAR to the MOVE statement.
The trajectories can be classified as follows:
joint trajectory: JOINT
linear trajectory: LINEAR
circular trajectory: CIRCULAR.
5.3.1 Joint Interpolation
During joint interpolation ($MOVE_TYPE :=J OINT or MOVE J OINT TO), the joint
angles of the arm are linearly interpolated from their initial to final values. All axes start
moving at the same time and reach their destination at the same time. The path followed
by the tool centre point (TCP) is not predictable, although it is repeatable.
J oint interpolated movements between two positions are always possible.
5.3.2 Linear Interpolation
During linear interpolation ($MOVE_TYPE :=LINEAR or MOVE LINEAR TO), the TCP
moves in a straight line from the initial position to the final position. The orientation of the
tool also changes from the initial position to the final position according to the mode
defined by the $ORNT_TYPE variable. This specific program variable can have the
values of the following predefined constants: RS_WORLD, RS_TRAJ , EUL_WORLD,
WRIST_J NT.
For further information refer to the par. 5.3.4 Orientation Evolution during Linear or
Circular movements a pag. 5-10 section.
5.3.3 Circular Interpolation
During circular interpolation ($MOVE_TYPE :=CIRCULAR or MOVE CIRCULAR TO),
the TCP follows a circular arc from the initial position to the destination. An additional
Motion Control
5-10
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
position, called the VIA position, must be specified to define the arc. Only the location
component of the VIA position is used; its orientation does not affect the motion.
As for linear interpolation, the $ORNT_TYPE predefined variable indicates the type of
evolution of attitude must be performed.
5.3.4 Orientation Evolution during Linear or Circular
movements
The orientation of the tool during linear and circular movements evolves from the initial
position to the final position in the manner indicated by the $ORNT_TYPE variable.
Possible values of this specific variable of the program are as follows:
RS_WORLD (two-angles related to the world frame)
Orientation interpolation is done by linearly interpolating the values of two rotation
angles, tool rotation and tool spin. The tool rotation angle is the angle about the
common normal between the beginning tool approach vector and the destination
approach vector. The tool spin angle is the angle about the approach vector from
the beginning position to the destination position. The evolution is related to the
World frame independently from the trajectory.
RS_WORLD is the default value for $ORNT_TYPE.
RS_TRAJ (two angles related to the trajectory)
Orientation interpolation is done in the same way than RS_WORLD but the rotation
and spin angles are related to the trajectory. This is particularly useful during
circular trajectory having an angle grater than 180 degrees when the user wants to
maintain the tool orientation constant with respect to the trajectory. During linear
motions the orientation evolution is the same than RS_WORLD.
EUL_WORLD (three-angle)
Orientation interpolation is done by linearly interpolating the values of the three
Euler angles of rotation, E1, E2, and E3.
WRIST_J NT (wrist-joint)
Orientation interpolation is done by using a combination of joint and linear
interpolation. This permits the tool to move along a straight line while the wrist joints
are interpolated in joint coordinates. The starting and ending orientation will be
used as taught, but because of the joint interpolation, the orientation during the
movement is not predictable, although it is repeatable. For example, using either
EUL_WORLD or RS_WORLD, if the beginning and ending orientations are the
same, then the orientation of the tool will remain fixed during the motion. However,
with WRIS_J NT orientation interpolation this is not guaranteed. However,
WRIST_J NT orientation control allows for much smoother motion near wrist
singularities.
5.3.5 Attitude Flags During Linear and Circular Movements
During Cartesian trajectories (LINEAR and CIRCULAR) the attitude flags of the starting
and final points of a movement must correspond, otherwise the movement will not be
executed. Attitude flags signify the S, E, W, A and B parts of a Cartesian position (see
the PDL2 Programming Language Manual for further details).
S indicates that the WCP (Wrist Center Point) is in the zone lying behind the plane
defined by the first and the second axes.
Motion Control
5-11
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
E indicates that the WCP is in the zone lying behind the extension of the second
axis;
W indicates that the value of the fifth axis is negative.
A indicates that the TCP (Tool Center Point) is in the zone lying behind the
extension of the second axis;
B indicates that the TCP (Tool Center Point) is in the zone lying behind the plane
defined by the first and the second axes.
The only exception to this is when passing over a singularity point, in which the W flag
is reversed by the system software.
It is, however, possible to execute the movement even if the flags do not correspond:
set the $CNFG_CARE predefined variable to FALSE to make the flag of the final point
match that of the starting point.
This setting is mainly used when mixing movements that use J OINTPOS type variables
and POSITION type variables with values that have been set directly from the PDL2
program and not taught using the REC key on the teach pendant.
If the starting point is a J OINTPOS, the value of the configuration string is unknown and
it is therefore useful to set the $CNFG_CARE variable to FALSE.
5.3.6 Turn Flag and minimum path
Turn flags (T1, T2, T3, T4) are part of the configuration string and are associated with
axes capable of performing multi-turns, i.e. that can rotate by more than 360 degrees
($STRK_END_P[axis] - $STRK_END_N[axis] >360) (for further details also see the
PDL2 Programming Language Manual).
A Cartesian trajectory (LINEAR or CIRCULAR) generally follows the shortest path for
the joints and the configuration string of the final point that has been reached may
therefore differ from that present in the movement instruction. If so, the system will
execute the movement in any case, unless the predefined variable, $TURN_CARE, has
been set to TRUE; in that case, an error message will indicate the difference in the
number of turns.
POSITION type variables that were taught using a particular $UFRAME may have a
different number of turns when the $UFRAME is changed. For instance, if a P0 point
was taught with axis 4 at 170 degrees and P1 with axis 4 at 179 degrees, the number of
turns will not be included in the position variables (configuration string empty ).
However, if a slight change is made to $UFRAME, the joints associated with P0 and P1
may change. For example, P0 may now have axis 4 at 172 degrees and P1 have axis 4
at 181 degrees. In that case, the shortest path is from 172 to 181 degrees, but in order
to move axis 4 to 181 degrees, position P1 should have flag T1:1. However, there is no
turn flag in the P1 configuration string and therefore, in order to avoid an error on the
LINEAR MOVE from P0 to P1 with a new $UFRAME, $TURN_CARE must be set to
FALSE.
A joint trajectory (J OINT) or a Cartesian movement with WRIST_J NT evolution, effected
on points declared as POSITIONs, sets a path that follows the evolution of the joints,
without considering the shortest or longest route. To follow the shortest route (<180
degrees), set the $J NT_MTURN variable to FALSE.
Note that the $J NT_MTURN variable is ineffective in joint movements on points
declared as J OINTPOS.
Motion Control
5-12
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
5.4 Position Checking
There are two functions, called ON TRAJ ECTORY and ON POS, that can be used to
verify the robots position in relation to the programmed trajectory or to predefined
positions. This is mainly used when monitoring the line from external devices, such as a
PLC. By means of appropriate calls to the built-in routines, ON_TRAJ _SET,
ON_J NT_SET and ON_POS_SET, it is possible to define the bits of analogue ports (e.g.
$WORD) that will be set to 1 when a predefined position is reached or during the robot
movement along the programmed trajectory.
5.4.1 On Trajectory Function
This function, which is always enabled, is used to verify, at any time, whether the robot
is on the trajectory programmed of the PDL2 program that is running.
$CRNT_DATA[arm].OT_POS indicates the robots position along the programmed
trajectory. The $CRNT_DDTP[arm].OT_J NT variable includes information concerning
any auxiliary axes that may be present. $CRNT_DATA[arm].OT_COARSE is TRUE
when the robot is on the programmed trajectory and FALSE if that is not the case.
For safety reasons, the deviation between the current position of the robot and the
$CRNT_DATA[arm].OT_POS position is calculated by taking into account the threshold
in millimeters in relation to the flange ($ARM_DATA[arm].OT_TOL_DIST) and the
threshold in degrees in relation to the orientation of the flange
($ARM_DATA[arm].OT_TOL_ORNT). In case of a very long tool (for instance, 1 meter
in the tools Z direction) and if the robot has stopped in correspondence with
$CRNT_DATA[arm].OT_POS, only a slight rotation of the tool is necessary in order to
provoke a significant flange movement, so that the $CRNT_DATA[arm].OT_COARSE
variable is set to FALSE. In case of rotating auxiliary axes, threshold
$ARM_DATA[arm].OT_TOL is used. In case of traversing auxiliary axes, threshold
$ARM_DATA[arm].OT_TOL_ORNT is used.
If the arm includes integrated auxiliary axes, in case of jog movements in joint mode, all
the axes that have been enabled, including the auxiliary axes, contribute to the
modification of the Cartesian position and result in the arm moving away from the
trajectory ($CRNT_DATA[arm].OT_COARSE =FALSE). In case of jog movements in
Cartesian mode (Base, Tool, etc.) the movement of the auxiliary axis is compensated
by the robots axes in order to maintain the Cartesian point; however, as the entire
configuration of the arm axes is modified, the arm also moves away from the trajectory
in this case ($CRNT_DATA[arm].OT_COARSE =FALSE), extending the concept of
position on the trajectory to the extended position.
If the arm includes auxiliary axes that are not integrated, in case of jog movements in
joint mode, the axis does not modify the Cartesian position, but the overall configuration
of the arm is modified and the arm moves away from the trajectory
($CRNT_DATA[arm].OT_COARSE =FALSE). In case of jog movements in Cartesian
mode, the auxiliary axis cannot be moved and the arm behaves in the same way as the
6 axes robot.
It is always possible to return to the trajectory ($CRNT_DATA[arm].OT_COARSE =
TRUE) by executing a movement on the $CRNT_DATA[arm].OT_J NT variables (or
$CRNT_DATA[arm].OT_POS variables, for robots with no auxiliary axes).
Example:
MOVE TO $CRNT_DATA[ ar m] . OT_J NT
oR
Motion Control
5-13
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
MOVE TO $CRNT_DATA[ ar m] . OT_POS
WI TH $TOOL=$CRNT_DATA[ ar m] . OT_TOOL,
WI TH $UFRAME = $CRNT_DATA[ ar m] . OT_UFRAME
ENDMOVE
The presence of a Remote Tool does not affect functionality. When the program is
deactivated, the $CRNT_DATA[arm].OT_COARSE variable is reset. See following
Tab. 5.1 - On Pos and On Trajectory table.
This function is not available on the following machine types: robots with active
kinematic compensation (file .ROB in RD), robots with conveyor tracking, enabled
cooperative movement.
For further details related to the $OT_xxx system variables and the ON_TRAJ _SET
built-in routine, please refer to the PDL2 Programming Language Manual.
5.4.2 On Position (ON POS)
By means of this function, it is possible to verify, at all times, whether the robots Tool
Center Point (TCP) corresponds to a specific predefined position, such as the Home
position, the Tip-dressing position for SPOT applications or the Service position. The
predefined positions must be stored:
in the $OP_J NT field if the auxiliary axes, or some of these (see predefined
variable $ON_POS_TBL[index].OP_J NT_MASK), must also be controlled;
in the $OP_POS field if only the Cartesian position is concerned.
This information is primarily used to communicate to external devices, such as a line
PLC, that the robot is in the aforesaid positions.
To make the On Pos function operational, each time the control unit is restarted, the
application program must run the following sequence of operations in the order set out
below:
Initialize the predefined fields with the OP_ prefix, in the $ON_POS_TBL table.
Run the built-in procedure ON_J NT_SET or ON_POS_SET to define which port
and which bit are to be assigned upon reaching the main positions.
Execute ON_POS(ON) to enable the function, which will remain enabled until the
subsequent ON_POS(OFF) is executed on the same item of the $ON_POS_TBL
or at the subsequent system restart.
For further details related to the $ON_POS_TBL and $OP_xxx system variables, the
ON_J NT_SET, ON_POS_SET and ON_POS built-in routines, the CONDITION events,
please refer to the PDL2 Programming Language Manual.
This service is disabled in the case of: robot with active kinematic offset (file .ROB) in
When the CNTRL C key is pressed, to interrupt the execution of a NON movement
instruction of a program open in the EZ or PROGRAM EDIT or MEMORY DEBUG
or IDE environment, the $CRNT_DATA[arm].OT_COARSE flag will still be set to
TRUE even if the instruction that was interrupted is between two FLY movements.
If the user then moves the cursor onto a specific instruction from which he wishes
to continue to run the program, skipping some programmed movements, this
could also damage the robot and/or the start of the work cycle (executed in
Remote or Local mode). Responsibility for any damage resulting from such
actions lies with the user in charge of operating and controlling the cell.
Motion Control
5-14
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
UD, robot with cooperative or conveyor tracking enabled.
5.4.2.1 Example of On Pos and On Trajectory
In order to summarize the behavior of the system, let us suppose that a program being
executed is interrupted:
in a configuration in which the arm is on the trajectory;
on a predefined position;
on a predefined joint position for all axes of the arm (the mask of the joints on
ON_J NT_SET corresponds to the $J NT_MASK).
Let us suppose we wish to perform an arm movement, in jog mode, exceeding the
predefined threshold:
5.5 Speed Control
Predefined variables are used to control the maximum or constant speed of a motion,
some of which are system-wide, some of which are program-specific, and some of which
are arm-specific. Two kinds of speed controls are used:
basic speed values or limit values, measured in normal speed units such as
radians per second or meters per second;
override values that govern the basic speed values, measured in percentage.
In the C4G system, not only speed can be controlled by the user, but also acceleration
Tab. 5.1 - On Pos and On Trajectory
On Trajectory
Value of:
$CRNT_DATA[ ].OT_COARSE
On Pos con JOINTPOS
($OP_JNT)
Value of:
$ON_POS_TBL[ ].OP_REACHED
On Pos con POSITION
($OP_POS)
Value of:
$ON_POS_TBL[ ].OP_REACHED
Initial condition TRUE TRUE TRUE
Movement of robot
axis in joint mode
FALSE FALSE FALSE
Movement of
integrated auxiliary
axis in joint mode
FALSE FALSE FALSE
Movement of
non-integrated
auxiliary axis in joint
mode
FALSE FALSE TRUE
Movement in
Cartesian mode with
reference to X, Y, Z
and/or E1, E2, E3
FALSE FALSE FALSE
Movement in
Cartesian mode of
integrated auxiliary
axis
FALSE FALSE TRUE
Deactivation of
movement program
FALSE TRUE TRUE
Motion Control
5-15
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
and deceleration. Independent basic control values and overrides exist for acceleration,
speed, and deceleration. The basic and override values for acceleration and
deceleration are discussed in par. 5.6 Acceleration and Deceleration a pag. 5-20 in the
current chapter.
5.5.1 Speed Overrides
Speed override values govern (or override) the basic speed values (see description
par. 5.5.2 Cartesian Speed Control a pag. 5-16 section).
The speed overrides that apply to all motions are as follows:
$GEN_OVR allows the operator to change simultaneously the acceleration, speed
and deceleration values of Motion programs. Since this influences the
acceleration, speed and deceleration values in a coordinated manner, the
trajectories are usually maintained (unless there are servo tracking errors) when
this variable is changed.
$GEN_OVR is an INTEGER type variable
It is common to the whole system and can be changed from the Teach Pendant.
The PDL2 programs can read it only.
$ARM_OVR permits acceleration, speed, and deceleration of a specific arm to be
modified from within a program. Since it affects acceleration, speed, and
deceleration in a coordinated way, trajectory shapes are generally maintained
when this control is modified (except for differences in servo following errors at
different values of override).
$ARM_OVR is an INTEGER field of the system-wide array of structures,
$ARM_DATA[ ]. There is one $ARM_DATA structure per arm, and the ARM_OVR
field has a default value of 100%.
Note that if constant speed during transitions between continuous motions is more
important than constant trajectory, then $ARM_SPD_OVR or $PROG_SPD_OVR
should be used (acceleration and deceleration will be left at current values as these
speed overrides are reduced).
See section par. 5.10.1 Trajectory Shape During Continuous Motion a pag. 5-30 in
current chapter.
$ARM_SPD_OVR permits the speed of a specific arm to be modified by a program.
Acceleration and deceleration are not affected. This implies that the shape of
continuous motion trajectories may change as this control is changed.
See section par. 5.10.1 Trajectory Shape During Continuous Motion a pag. 5-30 in
current chapter.
$ARM_SPD_OVR is an INTEGER field of the system-wide array of structures,
$ARM_DATA[].
There is one $ARM_DATA structure per arm, and the ARM_SPD_OVR field has a
default value of 100%.
$PROG_SPD_OVR permits speed of all motions issued from a specific program to
be modified by the program. Acceleration and deceleration are not affected.
This implies that the shape of continuous motion trajectories may change as this
control is changed.
It is a program-specific variable with a default value of 100%.
The total speed override for any motion for a specific arm is determined as follows:
t ot al speed over r i de[ ar m] = $GEN_OVR * $ARM_DATA[ ar m] . ARM_OVR *
$ARM_DATA[ ar m] . ARM_SPD_OVR * $PROG_SPD_OVR
Motion Control
5-16
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
$GEN_OVR and $ARM_OVR take effect during motions. That is, if either variable is
changed while a motion is in progress, the current motion will speed up or slow down
accordingly. However, a change in $PROG_SPD_OVR or $ARM_SPD_OVR will not
take effect until the next move statement within the program for which it is defined.
Also, please refer to par. 5.10.1 Trajectory Shape During Continuous Motion a pag. 5-30
section in current chapter, for a discussion of some more effects of such variables.
$ARM_SPD_OVR, $ARM_OVR, and other variables described in this chapter are fields
of the predefined system-wide array of structures, $ARM_DATA. The details of this
structure and how to reference fields within the structure are fully documented in the
chapter referring to the predefined variables of the PDL2 Programming Language
Manual.
5.5.2 Cartesian Speed Control
Under normal operation, the following two predefined variables govern the basic speed
of a Cartesian motion (linear or circular), with any type of orientation control.
$LIN_SPD_LIM determines the linear speed. It is a variable for each Arm, whose
value depends on the Robot and cannot be modified by the User.
It is a REAL field of the system-wide array, $ARM_DATA[], which has one structure
for each arm. The default value for $LIN_SPD_LIM is machine dependent.
(normally: 1.5 m/s).
$ROT_SPD_LIM determines the rotational speed. It is a variable for each Arm,
whose value depends on the Robot and cannot be modified by the User.
It is a REAL field of the system-wide array, $ARM_DATA[], which has one structure
for each arm. The default value for $ROT_SPD_LIM is machine dependent.
The actual speed of motion of a specific arm is determined by computing the maximum
of the motion times for each possible rotation at $ROT_SPD_LIM and the TCP
translation time at $LIN_SPD_LIM. For example, using RS_WORLD orientation control,
three evaluations are performed:
the time for the approach vector to go from its initial orientation to final orientation
at $ROT_SPD_LIM;
the time for the spin about the approach vector to go from its initial orientation to its
final orientation;
the time for the TCP to translate from its initial location to its final location at
$LIN_SPD_LIM.
The component of motion that takes the longest to get from its initial to final location will
move at the programmed speed limit, reduced by the total override. All of the other
components will move at lower than programmed limits, so that all components start and
stop at the same time.
If one of the rotations requires the most time, $ROT_SPD_LIM is used. If the translation
requires the most time, $LIN_SPD_LIM is used. The component moving at the
programmed speed limit is called the maximum stressed component, and it moves at
the speed of maximum stress or SMS.
Using this terminology, the Cartesian speed of a specific arm is determined as follows:
car t esi an speed[ ar m] = SMS[ ar m] * t ot al speed over r i de[ ar m]
where SMS[arm] is $ARM_DATA[arm].ROT_SPD_LIM if rotation takes the longest, or
$ARM_DATA[arm].LIN_SPD_LIM if translation takes the longest. (See previous
Motion Control
5-17
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
par. 5.5.1 Speed Overrides a pag. 5-15 for a definition of total speed override).
5.5.2.1 Cartesian Speed Control Options
The process of determining which component governs Cartesian speed is called
preplanning. This occurs just before the motion actually occurs (i.e. after each MOVE).
It is possible to force the preplanner to pick a particular component of motion using the
predefined variable $SPD_OPT. It is a program-specific variable (each program can
have its own value) that can be assigned the following predefined constants:
SPD_CONST is the default value. It moves the arm at constant speed with the
SMS being picked by the preplanner, as explained previously.
SPD_J NT moves the arm along the requested Cartesian trajectory, but always
moves at least one joint at its maximum speed. The TCP will not move at constant
speed.
SPD_LIN translates the TCP at the requested $LIN_SPD, forcing all other
components to move in the same time.
Note that in this case, $LIN_SPD replaces $LIN_SPD_LIM in the speed
calculation. $LIN_SPD is a REAL field of the system-wide array of structures,
$ARM_DATA.
SPD_ROT ($ORNT_TYPE=RS_WORLD) rotates the approach vector at
$ROT_SPD, forcing all other components to move in the same time.
Note that in this case, $ROT_SPD replaces $ROT_SPD_LIM in the rotation speed
calculations. $ROT_SPD is a REAL field of the system-wide array of structures,
$ARM_DATA.
SPD_SPN ($ORNT_TYPE=RS_WORLD) spins the approach vector at
$ROT_SPD, forcing all other components to move in the same time. (See
SPD_ROT for explanation of $ROT_SPD).
SPD_AZI ($ORNT_TYPE=EUL_WORLD) rotates the azimuth component at
$ROT_SPD, forcing all other components to move in the same time. (See
SPD_ROT for explanation of $ROT_SPD).
SPD_ELV ($ORNT_TYPE=EUL_WORLD) rotates the elevation component at
$ROT_SPD, forcing all other components to move in the same time. (See
SPD_ROT for explanation of $ROT_SPD).
SPD_ROLL ($ORNT_TYPE=EUL_WORLD) spins the approach vector at
$ROT_SPD, forcing all other components to move in the same time. (See
SPD_ROT for explanation of $ROT_SPD).
SPD_FIRST ($ORNT_TYPE=WRIST_J NT) rotates the first wrist joint at
$ROT_SPD, forcing all other components to move in the same time. (See
SPD_ROT for explanation of $ROT_SPD).
SPD_SECOND ($ORNT_TYPE=WRIST_J NT) rotates the second wrist joint at
$ROT_SPD, forcing all other components to move in the same time. (See
SPD_ROT for explanation of $ROT_SPD).
SPD_THIRD ($ORNT_TYPE=WRIST_J NT) rotates the third wrist joint (closest to
the tool) at $ROT_SPD, forcing all other components to move in the same time.
(See SPD_ROT for explanation of $ROT_SPD).
SPD_AUX1 moves the first auxiliary axis at a constant speed while all other
components of the move will run at a reduced speed. If the joint is rotational, the
desired speed for the auxiliary axis should be specified by the predefined variable
Motion Control
5-18
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
$ROT_SPD. If the joint is linear the speed should be specified by the predefined
variable $LIN_SPD. If more than one auxiliary axis is present only one can move
at a constant speed and any other auxiliary axis will move at a reduced speed in
order to start and end the move at the same time.
If fly moves are executed when $SPD_OPT is set to SPD_AUXn then the auxiliary
axis will always run at a constant speed regardless of the value of $FLY_TYPE. If
$SPD_OPT is assigned a value of SPD_AUXn where n is an invalid auxiliary axis
then an error will be reported.
SPD_AUX2 has the same effect as SPD_AUX1 except that the second auxiliary
axis is maintained at a constant speed.
SPD_AUX3 moves the third auxiliary axis at a constant speed while all other
components of the move will run at a reduced speed so that the movement begins
and ends at the same time. All other effects of this option are the same as
SPD_AUX1.
SPD_SM4C - the cartesian movement is performed using the Cartesian
SmartMove4 (optional feature).
For further information, see Cap.13. - SMARTMOVE4 (optional).
In this case, the acceleration, speed and deceleration values aare automatically
calculated and it is impossible to set neither a translational ($LIN_SPD) nor a
rotational ($ROT_SPD) speed as maximum value.
In order to use such an option, it is needed to purchase the software option
SmartMove4.
If the value of $SPD_OPT is not meaningful for the current trajectory type, the default
SPD_CONST is assumed. For example, specifying $SPD_OPT=SPD_SECOND has no
meaning if $ORNT_TYPE=RS_WORLD, so SPD_CONST would be used.
Changes to $SPD_OPT, $LIN_SPD, and $ROT_SPD only take affect at the beginning
of the next move. Changes do not affect the current motion of an arm.
5.5.2.2 Run-Time modifying the Linear Speed Override
It is allowed to run-time modify the TCP speed override, only if the following conditions
are satisfied:
Cartesian movement
the motion control type is $SPD_OPT := SPD_LIN.
Such conditions BOTH have to be satisfied, otherwise no run-time modifications are
allowed. Therefore, it is not possible to apply such a functionality to Arms which
CANNOT move with a cartesian motion.
The predefined variable (available since system software version 3.1) which allows to
run-time modify the speed override, is
$LI N_SPD_RT_OVR
It is referred to $LIN_SPD predefined variable related to the motion, and indicates, as a
percentage, the new TCP speed to be used since the current motion.
The default value is 100: this means that the movement is performed at a maximum
Since system software version 3.1, it is provided a functionality which, in special
conditions, allows run-time modifying the speed override (see the following
section Run-Time modifying the Linear Speed Override)
Motion Control
5-19
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
speed equals to the $LIN_SPD. The maximum value to set $LIN_SPD_RT_OVR to, is
related to $LIN_SPD value, and is calculated as follows:
MAX = ( $LI N_SPD_LI M / $LI N_SPD) * 100
which means that it allows to reach the cartesian speed limit for the robot.
The required modification is active since the current motion, and it is applied so as not
to cause sudden changing motion, even when the Run-Time Speed Override variations
are considerably high.
5.5.3 Joint Speed Control
For joint interpolated motions, the actual motion speed for a specific arm is determined
by computing the maximum of the motion times for each joint travelling at its maximum
limit.
The predefined INTEGER array, $MTR_SPD_LIM[], defines the maximum speed of
each motor, which in turn defines the maximum speed of each joint. $MTR_SPD_LIM is
a field of the predefined system-wide array of structures, $ARM_DATA[].
Thus there is a value for each axis for each arm.
The speed override for each joint is determined by $J NT_OVR, which permits
acceleration, speed, and deceleration to be modified together by a program.
It is a field of $ARM_DATA and it is an INTEGER array of the system-wide array of
structures.
There is an override value for each axis of each arm. The default values are 100%.
The joint speed of a specific axis is determined as follows:
j oi nt speed[ axi s] =
$MTR_SPD_LI M[ axi s] * gear r at i o[ axi s] * $J NT_OVR[ axi s] *
t ot al speed over r i de[ ar m]
where gear ratio indicates the transmission ratio.
The joint that takes the longest to get from its initial to final position will move at the
above computed speed. All of the other joints will move at lower speeds, so that all joints
start and stop at the same time.
5.5.4 Manual Motion Speed Control
If moves are executed while the Control Unit is in PROGR status (status selector switch
on T1) or manual movement is made (jog) in AUTO-T (status selector switch on T2), a
further $MAN_SCALE speed value is used, to keep the maximum speed within the
safety values. If the predefined variable $SPD_OPT is set to SPD_LIN, then the speed
of the arm is determined by the value of the predefined variable $LIN_SPD. If the value
of $LIN_SPD is greater than 0.25 meters per second, then the speed of the arm will be
reduced to 0.25 meters per second. $MAN_SCALE is set at the factory and cannot be
changed by the Customer.
For run-time linear speed variations during synchronized motions, please see
Cap.6. - Synchronous Motion (optional feature) in current Manual.
Motion Control
5-20
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
5.6 Acceleration and Deceleration
Acceleration and deceleration in the C4G controller are each broken into three phases,
a constant jerk phase, followed by a constant acceleration phase, followed by another
constant jerk phase.
See Fig. 5.4 - Speed and acceleration profiles.
Fig. 5.4 - Speed and acceleration profiles
1. speed
2. acceleration
Currently, C4G forces the acceleration profile to be symmetric and the deceleration
profile to be symmetric.
This means that the constant jerk phases during acceleration (T1 and T2) are the same
length and the constant jerk phases during deceleration (T3 and T4) are the same
length.
For joint interpolated motions, the total time of acceleration and deceleration is
established by two predefined variables:
$MTR_ACC_TIME determines the total acceleration time in milliseconds;
$MTR_DEC_TIME determines the total deceleration time in milliseconds.
These variables are INTEGER array fields of $ARM_DATA, one element for each axis
for each arm. For a joint interpolated motion, the time for the joint that takes the longest
to accelerate/decelerate to its final speed is picked for the time to use for all joints to
accelerate/decelerate. This maintains coordinated acceleration and deceleration.
For Cartesian motions, $LIN_ACC_LIM and $LIN_DEC_LIM are used in a similar way,
to establish the total time for acceleration/deceleration. However the units for these
variables are meters per second per second.
The percentage of acceleration time and deceleration time used in the constant jerk
phases is determined by the predefined $ARM_DATA INTEGER array field, $J ERK[],
as follows:
$J ERK[1] defines the percentage of the acceleration time in the constant jerk
phase (T1 +T2);
$J ERK[2] is reserved for future use;
Motion Control
5-21
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
$J ERK[3] is reserved for future use;
$J ERK[4] determines percentage of deceleration time in constant jerk (T3 +T4).
For example, if $J ERK[1] is set to 40, then 20% of the time specified in
$MTR_ACC_TIME will be T1, 60% in constant acceleration, and 20% will be T2.
$J ERK[] is read-only from a PDL2 program.
5.6.1 Acceleration/Deceleration Overrides
As with speed, acceleration and deceleration also have overrides.
As already explained in par. 5.5.1 Speed Overrides a pag. 5-15,
$GEN_OVR and $ARM_OVR not only affect speed, but also acceleration and
deceleration.
In addition, arm specific and program specific variables exist to further override
acceleration and deceleration. Such variables are arm or program specific:
$PROG_ACC_OVR permits acceleration of all motions issued from a specific
program to be modified by the program. It is a program specific INTEGER with a
default value of 100%;
$PROG_DEC_OVR permits deceleration of all motions issued from a specific
program to be modified by the program. It is a program specific INTEGER with a
default value of 100%;
$ARM_ACC_OVR permits acceleration of a specific arm to be modified by a
program. It is an INTEGER field of the array, $ARM_DATA, with one field for each
arm. The default value is 100%;
$ARM_DEC_OVR permits deceleration of a specific arm to be modified by a
program. It is an INTEGER field of the array, $ARM_DATA, with one field for each
arm. The default value is 100%.
The equations for total override for acceleration and deceleration are:
t ot al accel er at i on over r i de[ ar m] =
$GEN_OVR*$ARM_DATA[ ar m] . ARM_OVR*$ARM_DATA[ ar m] . ARM_ACC_OVR*
$PROG_ACC_OVR
t ot al decel er at i on over r i de[ ar m] =
$GEN_OVR*$ARM_DATA[ ar m] . ARM_OVR*$ARM_DATA[ ar m] . ARM_DEC_OVR*
$PROG_DEC_OVR
$PROG_ACC_OVR and $PROG_DEC_OVR are program specific INTEGER values
with default values of 100%. $ARM_ACC_OVR and $ARM_DEC_OVR are INTEGER
fields with one field per arm in multi-arm systems.
Changes in these four overrides take effect only on succeeding motions, not during any
current motion.
However, as with speed, changes in $GEN_OVR and $ARM_OVR take affect in the
current motion.
When HOLD, CANCEL, LOCK, or DEACTIVATE are used, maximum deceleration is
used regardless of the above override settings.
In addition, a predefined variable, $HLD_DEC_PER, can be used to increase the
deceleration rate beyond normal maximum settings. At high speed, normal maximum
deceleration for some arms may require several hundred millimeters to stop. The range
of $HLD_DEC_PER is from 100 to 400 percent, permitting the normal maximum to be
multiplied by a factor up to 4. $HLD_DEC_PER is a read-only INTEGER array field of
the system-wide array of structures, $ARM_DATA[]. Thus, there is one element per axis
Motion Control
5-22
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
for each arm.
5.6.2 Joint Interpolation
After the governing joint is picked (based on speed), the speed of each of the remaining
joints is scaled by the ratio of original time for the joint to the time of motion of the
governing joint. Each joint must accelerate to its scaled speed, not to its requested
speed.
The acceleration time for each joint is evaluated to determine which joint will govern
acceleration. (This is not necessarily the same as the joint governing speed).
This time is a combination of $MTR_ACC_TIME[axis] and $J NT_OVR[axis]. A similar
combination, using $MTR_DEC_TIME and $J NT_OVR is used to find the governing
joint for deceleration.
After the limiting joints for acceleration and deceleration are determined (not necessarily
the same joint), all joints are scaled to accelerate and decelerate in the same amount of
time.
The previously described acceleration and deceleration overrides are also applied to
each joint.
5.6.3 Cartesian Interpolation
The same type of analysis done for joint acceleration and deceleration is done for
Cartesian acceleration and deceleration, except that instead of joints being compared,
translation and rotation are compared.
The acceleration and deceleration in the Cartesian motion (either linear or circular), with
any orientation evolution modality, is controlled by means of the following predefined
variables:
$LIN_ACC_LIM specifies the maximum acceleration for linear translation. There is
a variable for each axis of each arm, whose values depend on the robot model and
cannot be modified by the User.
$ROT_ACC_LIM specifies the maximum acceleration for rotation. There is a
variable for each axis of each arm, whose values depend on the robot model and
cannot be modified by the User.
$LIN_DEC_LIM specifies the maximum deceleration for linear translation. There is
a variable for each axis of each arm, whose values depend on the robot model and
cannot be modified by the User.
$ROT_DEC_LIM specifies the maximum deceleration for rotation. There is a
variable for each axis of each arm, whose values depend on the robot model and
cannot be modified by the User.
The predefined variables $LIN_ACC_LIM, $ROT_ACC_LIM, $LIN_DEC_LIM, and
$ROT_DEC_LIM are used to compute the component that takes the longest time.
These variables are REAL fields of the system-wide array, $ARM_DATA[ ], with one
field per arm. The user is allowed to modify them by system level commands only.
The other components are scaled so that both rotations and translations use the same
time to accelerate and the same time to decelerate. The overrides are also applied.
Motion Control
5-23
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
5.6.4 Manual Motions
When programmed or immediate motions are issued in PROGR state, the described
above acceleration and deceleration overrides are used. However, when jog motions
are issued from the teach pendant, maximum deceleration is used to stop the arms.
An additional override, $MAN_SCALE, is used during manual motions to limit the
maximum speed to safe values. This manual override also affects acceleration and
deceleration to maintain trajectory shape for all motions issued in PROG state, except
for jog motions. For jog motions, $MAN_SCALE only affects speed. $MAN_SCALE is
set by the Builder and cannot be changed by the Customer.
5.7 Motion termination
It specifies the accuracy in robot positioning on the motion final destination, for a NON
FLY movement, before the next operation is performed.
For non-continuous motions, the predefined variable $TERM_TYPE is used to
determine when the motion will be terminated based on how close the arm must be
to its destination.
The predefined constants COARSE, FINE, J NT_COARSE, J NT_FINE, or
NOSETTLE can be assigned to $TERM_TYPE, with NOSETTLE being the default.
5.7.1 COARSE and FINE Termination
The COARSE and FINE values indicate two different thresholds that can be used to
define the motion stop (in-threshold). These thresholds, in the Cartesian frame, are the
radius of a sphere that has the target point as its centre. Furthermore:
COARSE - must be used in Cartesian movements and indicates that the
movement is accomplished if the TCP stays inside the sphere which is centered in
the final destination, with a radius specified by $TOL_COARSE predefined
variable, for a time greater equal to $TOL_ABT (anti-bounce time).
FINE - must be used in Cartesian movements and indicates that the movements is
accomplished if the TCP stays inside the sphere which is centered in the final
destination, with a radius specified by $TOL_FINE predefined variable, for a time
greater equal to $TOL_ABT (anti-bounce time).
The predefined variables $TOL_COARSE and $TOL_FINE indicate the tolerance
values. The default values for $TOL_COARSE and $TOL_FINE are arm dependent.
The predefined variable $TOL_ABT (anti-rebound time) indicates the time during which
the arm is to be within the specified tolerance before the motion is declared
completed/finished.
It has a range of 0 to 2000 milliseconds and a default value of 0 milliseconds. A value of
0 means the motion is terminated as soon as the arm is within the specified tolerance.
The predefined variable $TOL_TOUT (time out) determines the length of time the
system will continue checking to see if the arm is within the specified tolerance. It has a
range of 0 to 20000 milliseconds and a default value depending on the kind of robot. The
value is rounded up to the nearest interpolator frequency ($IPERIOD) tick, so a value
less than this frequency is interpolated as one tick. If the arm does not come within the
specified tolerance within the specified timeout, an error with hold severity is issued.
Motion Control
5-24
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
5.7.2 JNT_COARSE and JNT_FINE Termination
The J NT_COARSE and J NT_FINE values specify the two different tolerances that can
be used to define the conclusion of the motion.
The predefined variables $TOL_J NT_COARSE and $TOL_J NT_FINE indicate the
COARSE and FINE tolerance values respectively, for each joint, measured in degrees.
They represent, for each joint, the acceptable tolerance range in degrees, to be able to
state that the motion has terminated on the final point. They are one dimension vectors.
Note that tolerance settings are joint settings, not tool centre point settings. To obtain
the correct tool centre tolerance values if the tool itself is large, it is necessary to use
lower tolerances than those used for smaller tools; in this case make reference to the
Cartesian frame thresholds (Fine, Coarse)
5.7.3 NOSETTLE Termination
The NOSETTLE value indicates that the motion is to be declared terminated as soon as
the deceleration profile has been completed. There is no settling time for the arm to
position itself precisely within a specified tolerance.
No controls are executed; NOSETTLE is the default setting.
5.8 Trajectory Recovery
If needed, motions can be stopped even before they are accomplished. For example, an
operator might press the HOLD key or the DRIVE OFF softkey. When HOLD button is
pressed, arms will smoothly decelerate and stop exactely on current trajectory. Pressing
START button will resume motion on current trajectory. No trajectory recovery is
needed. The same happens when the DRIVE OFF is requested but the power is also
cut out from the drives and the brakes are activated. The robot can be stopped by
opening the gates: in this case braking will take place with stop on the trajectory. The
robot can be stopped by pressing the safety mushroom-head button. In this case braking
will take place with stop on the trajectory, but with no in-threshold check.
With the status selector switch on T2, pressing the mushroom-head button causes a
stop WITHOUT control of the trajectory, with the power cut off and the brakes opened.
5.8.1 Recovery Strategy
Two forms of recovery are defined, short range and long range. Short range recovery
means recovery from a position that is very close to the original trajectory, as defined by
a predefined variable array of joint tolerances, $TOL_J NT[]. The short range reset takes
place by means of a move in joints interpolation that is entirely transparent to the user.
That is, when START button is pressed to resume a motion, a short range recovery
motion will be inserted immediately before the original motion is resumed. In many
cases, this reset move is not even perceived by the operator.
If the distance between the current position and the nominal position is major to a certain
limit (short range) the resumption of motion takes place according to the modes defined
by the predefined variable $RCVR_TYPE value set. The possible values of this
predefined variable are shown in the following table:
Motion Control
5-25
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
Wherever it is possible to interrupt a program motion executed in Automatic mode, for
example setting it in HOLD state, then switch to Programming mode and jog the robot,
then go back to an Automatic mode. When START button is pressed, short or long
range recovery is determined and such a specified recovery strategy is performed.
When the system is in Programming state and a motion is interrupted by the DRIVE
OFF, recovery will be based upon conditions that exist when the drives are turned back
again and either START or BACK button is pressed. The recovery type will be
determined by whether or not there is a pending motion and from where the motion was
issued. The exact recovery type is determined as follows.
5.8.1.1 Pending Motion Status
If there are no pending motions either START or BACK button is pressed, then no motion
is performed. Recovery will only occur when there is a pending motion, and the recovery
type will be based on the recovery range.
5.8.1.2 Recovery Range
In Programming mode the same strategy is used as for the Automatic status. If the
distance between the stop position and the nominal position is limited, a joints
interpolation move is used to bring the arm to the point where the motion was interrupted
(short range); otherwise the $RCVR_TYPE variable is used (long range recovery) to
execute the recovery move.
5.8.1.3 Execution Environment
When executing from within the edit environment, messages about the recovery are
displayed for the user. After bringing the arm to the position where the motion was
interrupted, press the START key, then press it a second time to continue the motion
along the original path. If the motion was issued from an execution environment other
than edit or memory debug, then no messages are displayed and no user interaction is
required to perform the recovery.
If the user jogs the robot immediately after the interruption, then recovery will not be
0 Bring the arm to the interrupted trajectory position, by the joint interpolation.
1 Bring the arm to the movement start position that was interrupted by the joint
interpolation.
2 Bring the arm to the interrupted movement destination position using the joint
interpolation.
3 Do not reset, generate an error message.
4 If the interrupted movement was Cartesian, restore the interrupted trajectory by
a straight-line movement. Otherwise use joint interpolation .
5 If the interrupted movement was Cartesian, bring the arm back to the start
position of the interrupted movement by a straight-line interpolation. Otherwise
use joint interpolation .
6 If the interrupted movement was Cartesian, bring the arm to the interrupted
movement destination position by a straight-line interpolation. Otherwise use
joint interpolation .
7-8 reserved
Motion Control
5-26
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
performed. If the controller is switched into Automatic state during the interruption, then
all of the recovery rules are followed.
5.9 Process Resume
The process reset allows the robot to return back along the trajectory in progress before
returning to the programmed move. Hereafter this movement will be referred to as return
movement. The maximum distance requested must be defined in the system variable
$RCVR_DIST (in millimeters). If a zero value is attributed to $RCVR_DIST, such a
performance is disabled.
This performance is useful for applications in which the robot effects the process activity
during movement (typical examples are the welding arc and sealant application). If,
during some of these applications, movement is interrupted for any reason, part of the
trajectory that has already been covered should be retraced in order to avoid the risk of
skipping parts of the process.
The return movement is enabled after any stop: HOLD sent from the Teach Pendant,
HOLD due to error, LOCK, state selector switching, DRIVE OFF, emergency stop.
If the interruption is the result of an emergency or DRIVE OFF state, the trajectory will
probably be recovered before the return movement starts. In such cases the return
movement will start after trajectory restore has been performed. The user should
remember that the no return movement t is only allowed in the trajectory restore modes
at the point of interruption ($RCVR_TYPE=0 or 4); it is disabled if a return is performed
on either start or end point.
The return movement is interrupted in advance if it intersects a not in FLY position
(Fig. 5.8 - Return Movements - example D) or upon exhaustion of the movement
preceding the one in progress (Fig. 5.6 - Return Movements - example B and Fig. 5.7
- Return Movements - example C).
Fig. 5.5 - Return Movements - example A
Simplest situation.
1. Programmed Fly position, between two movements
2. First movement - fly termination
3. Second movement - fly beginning
4. Second movement - fly termination
5. Stop position
6. Motion direction
7. First movement fly beginning
Motion Control
5-27
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
Fig. 5.6 - Return Movements - example B
$RCVR_DIST programmed value is greater than the maximum recoverable one
1. Maximum recoverable distance
2. Stop position
Fig. 5.7 - Return Movements - example C
If a fly movement is interrupted, it is possible to go back twice
1. Stop position
2. Maximum recoverable distance
Fig. 5.8 - Return Movements - example D
The return movement is interrupted if a position is encountered
1. Maximum recoverable distance (because there is a non fly position)
2. Stop position
Motion Control
5-28
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
Note that the return movement is possible during linear or circular type movements only.
The system reads the value of the distance to be recovered after each stop. Therefore,
if $RCVR_DIST is adjusted during the return movement, the value will only become
effective after the next stop.
If the return movement is interrupted, the $RCVR_DIST value is read again but the
distance to be recovered is always calculated starting from the point of the original
interruption (Fig. 5.9 - Example in case of $RCVR_DIST modification).
Fig. 5.9 - Example in case of $RCVR_DIST modification
1. Stop position of the return movement
2. First value of $RCVR_DIST=20 mm
3. Return movement interruption: $RCVR_DIST is read again
4. $RCVR_DIST=30 mm after the modification
5. Stop position
Any actual movement CONDITIONs are re-enabled at the next restart after the return
movement. However, if these have not been stated by means of the clause NODISABLE
they can only be released once.
If WHEN RESUME is enabled for an actual movement, this will be signalled at the end
of the return movement immediately before restarting the interrupted trajectory.
As for normal trajectory restore movements, automatic LOCK can be effected by means of
the variable $CRNT_DATA[num_arm].RCVR_LOCK. If the variable value is set to TRUE,
the system is automatically set to the LOCK state upon completion of the return movement.
There are four system events, one per arm, that signal entrance into the automatic LOCK
state (see WHEN EVENT 130...133 in PDL2 Programming Language Manual). In
order to restart the movement a RESUME instruction must be effected by means of a
program PDL2 or the EXECUTE command on the Service page of the Teach Pendant
(in PROGR status).
5.9.1 Automatic Process Resume
It also exists a Process Resume mode working like trajectory recovery number 4
($RCVR_TYPE := 4); in such a modality the covered distance during the return
movement is $RCVR_DIST plus the covered distance, while decelerating, between the
stop command and the actual machine stop.
To enable such a modality, $RCVR_TYPE predefined variable is to be set to 9.
Motion Control
5-29
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
1. motion direction
2. trajectory
3. calculated return movement
4. $RCVR_DIST
5. decelerate distance
6. motion stop command
7. actual motion stop position
5.10 Continuous Motion
The Continuous Motion allows the Program execution without stopping the Arm on the
taught positions.
To indicate a countinuous motion, the MOVEFLY statement is to be used, instead of the
MOVE statement. If one more movement follows the MOVEFLY, the Arm will not stop
on the first destination, moving instead from the starting position to the final position of
the second movement, without stopping on the common position of the two movements.
See Fig. 5.10 - Example of continuous motion in case of linear movement. If another
motion follows the MOVEFLY, the arm will not stop at the first destination.
Fig. 5.10 - Example of continuous motion in case of linear
movement
1. Movement start towards c
2. Movement end towards b
Fly movements between Joint trajectories an Cartesian trajectories are not
allowed (NO mixed fly).
Motion Control
5-30
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
5.10.1 Trajectory Shape During Continuous Motion
Fig. 5.10 - Example of continuous motion in case of linear movement shows a rounded
corner during the transition (fly) between the motion from A to B and the motion from B
to C. This rounding is a result of the deceleration of the first motion combined with the
acceleration of the second motion. The shape and amount of such rounding is a function
of the user settings ($FLY_PER, $FLY_DIST, $FLY_TRAJ ), the speed of the two
motions, the values used for acceleration and deceleration, and the capability of the
servo system of the particular arm and payload.
When $GEN_OVR or $ARM_OVR are changed (or $J NT_OVR in the case of joint
interpolated motions), acceleration and deceleration are changed along with speed in order
to preserve the shape of the trajectory regardless of override. The shape will remain nearly
the same except for the effect of servo following error. The purpose of this feature is to permit
teaching at low override values with little or no touch-up required at production speeds.
Another effect of maintaining trajectory shape at low overrides is that the arm will
accelerate and decelerate more slowly. However, when HOLD, LOCK, CANCEL, or
DEACTIVATE are used, maximum deceleration is used to stop the arm.
When other speed overrides are changed, such as $PROG_SPD_OVR or
$ARM_SPD_OVR, acceleration and deceleration are not changed, and the shape will
change as a result. These overrides are used from within programs where it is desirable
to change only speed, and trajectory shape is unimportant during fly.
5.10.2 Continuous Motion Modes (FLY)
The predefined variable $FLY_TYPE determines which of several different algorithms
are used to control continuous motion. The algorithm used affects not only the speed
and shape of the trajectory during fly motions, but also the amount of stress placed on
the arm and on the component or tool connected to it.
The available $FLY_TYPE values are FLY_NORM and FLY_CART.
5.10.2.1 FLY_NORM
With $FLY_TYPE set to FLY_NORM, MOVEFLY causes the deceleration of the issued
motion to be overlapped with the acceleration of the next motion.
The predefined variable, $FLY_PER, can be used to reduce the time in fly and to bring
the trajectory closer to the intermediate taught position. FLY_NORM is the default value.
Fly will begin at the start of normal deceleration for the motion plus a time equal to 100%
minus the percentage specified in $FLY_PER. For example, if the value of $FLY_PER
is 100%, the fly begins at the start of deceleration of the fly motion. If $FLY_PER is 75%,
then fly will begin after 25% of the deceleration is finished (75% will be combined with
the next motion).
The motion speed during fly is normally not constant. If two straight line segments are
joined by fly and are collinear then the TCP will move at constant speed through the
intermediate taught position as if there were one long segment. However, as the angle
between the two segments increases, the TCP will slow down near the intermediate
position, then speed up again as it moves into the next segment. The most extreme
example of course would be when the angle is 180 degrees (the TCP reverses
direction). In this case, the TCP will stop completely, but not at the intermediate taught
position.
This type of continuous motion control generally causes the least stress on the arm and
Motion Control
5-31
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
part or tool during direction changes. Therefore, FLY_NORM is the default value for
$FLY_TYPE. If the angle between motion segments is very acute, then lower stress can
be achieved by using FLY_CART. (par. 5.10.2.2 FLY_CART (Controller Aided Resolved
Trajectory) a pag. 5-31).
5.10.2.2 FLY_CART (Controller Aided Resolved Trajectory)
Fly_CART is used for $FLY_TYPE when TCP constant speed is needed.
It also allows to control the shape of the trajectory during fly, or the stress on the arm, the
part, or the tool.
For FLY_CART to be effective, $SPD_OPT must be set to SPD_LIN and any movement must
be cartesian.
The default value for $SPD_OPT is SPD_CONST.
As long as various constraints (described below) are not exceeded, the TCP speed will
be maintained constant during fly between Cartesian (linear or circular) segments using
FLY_CART. FLY_CART may also be used during path motions between Cartesian
segments. FLY_CART has no effect when one or both of the motions is joint
interpolated.
5.10.2.2.1 Dynamic Machine Stress Control
The algorithm for FLY_CART control implements the idea of generalized stress, which
is made up three components of stress on the arm and tooling.
Large changes in orientation of the tool, high TCP speed, or large changes in direction
of the TCP all can cause large acceleration forces either on individual components of
the arm, on the part, or on the tooling. A generalized stress limit is defined, which is
proportional to programmed speed, the angle between adjoining trajectories, and the
required orientation change. This stress limit is user setable by the predefined variable
$STRESS_PER.
The default value of $STRESS_PER is 50%, and it must be in the range of 1% - 100%.
Higher values for $STRESS_PER indicate more stress, lower values less stress.
Higher values indicate to the system that higher values of acceleration and deceleration
may be used. It will therefore begin and end fly closer to the taught intermediate point.
A value of 100% will attempt to pass directly through the intermediate point, with little or
no fly.
With $STRESS_PER =50% and two straight line segments at 90 degrees and little
orientation change, the fly trajectory will be nearly the same as if $FLY_TYPE were set
to FLY_NORM. However, unlike FLY_NORM, the TCP speed will remain constant. If the
angle between the straight line segments is increased (the segments are more towards
collinear), the distance covered by the fly, in FLY_CART mode, will be shorter and
therefore the trajectory will be nearer to the intermediate position taken in relation to
FLY_NORM. If the angle is sharper, the trajectory will be farther from the intermediate
point than with FLY_NORM, but lower stress will occur than with FLY_NORM.
See Fig. 5.11 - Comparison between FLY_CART and FLY_NORM
($STRESS_PER=50) for a graphical display of such situations.
Motion Control
5-32
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
Fig. 5.11 - Comparison between FLY_CART and FLY_NORM
($STRESS_PER=50)
A similar control is placed on the generation of circular trajectories. The velocity of
circular motions will be reduced to keep the stress of the arm within the limits specified
by $STRESS_PER. This reduction of motion velocity is more likely to occur with circular
motions having a small radius. (Note that this reduction is for the entire circle, not just
the fly trajectory between the circle and the next motion).
Keep the following points in mind when determining a value for $STRESS_PER.
The larger the value of $STRESS_PER, the larger the probability that the speed
will remain constant. Also, larger values of $STRESS_PER will bring the trajectory
nearer the taught intermediate position. In reality however, an increase in
$STRESS_PER can place greater demands on the controller, causing the quality
of the trajectory to be reduced.
When $STRESS_PER is set to 100%, the planned trajectories become very sharp
since they pass through the programmed point without a reduction in speed. This
can cause very high stress on the robot, the part, and the tooling in some cases.
Lower values of $STRESS_PER can be used to reduce the stress caused by large
wrist orientation changes. However, this smoother trajectory will pass farther from
the taught intermediate position.
5.10.2.2.2 Constant Speed Maintenance
As already described, FLY_CART allows the TCP speed to be maintained as a constant
during the fly motion as long as the limit set by $STRESS_PER is not exceeded. It is
strongly suggested that this feature be used to take advantage of the built-in
computations for fly motion. The following rules affect speed control in this mode:
As for all fly motions, if the planned motion is too short the desired speed can not
be reached. In this situation the speed maintained during the fly motion is the
speed at the moment the fly started.
When using high linear speeds, some motions will be too short and not allow time
for the necessary preliminary calculations. In this case the FLY_CART setting
behaves the same as all the other settings-i.e. the speed can not always be
maintained as a constant.
The speed will not remain constant if the limit set in $STRESS_PER is exceeded
by the programmed trajectory.
5.10.2.2.3 Control of Trajectory During FLY
Quando la modalit fly viene impostata a FLY_CART, la traiettoria pu essere
Motion Control
5-33
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
controllata impostando:
When the fly motion type is set to FLY_CART, the trajectory can be controlled by setting:
$FLY_DIST specifies a distance (in millimiters, default 5 mm) between the the
taught intermediate position and some point on the trajectory. The exact meaning
of the distance is determined by
$FLY_TRAJ which can be set to
FLY_AUTO it is the control which picks the closest trajectory to the
intermediate position that achieves the programmed speed without exceeding
the $STRESS_PER value.
Achieving and maintaining programmed speed has higher priority than
nearness to the intermediate position.
FLY_TOL guarantees the TCP to pass a distance less than $FLY_DIST from
the intermediate point of the trajectories.
If the generated trajectory falls within the distance $FLY_DIST, then the
trajectory will remain unchanged. However, if the trajectory is outside this
limit, then that distance limit will be respected and the speed will be reduced
to maintain the limits specified by $STRESS_PER and $FLY_DIST.
FLY_PASS attempts to move the TCP at the exact distance from the medium
point.
If the planned distance, specified by $FLY_DIST, is too long with respect to
the length of the trajectories, then the fly trajectory is calculated to cross at the
maximum distance possible. If the distance specified is less than that which
would be produced by FLY_AUTO, the speed will be reduced to respect the
limit set by $STRESS_PER (the distance specified will still be maintained
exactly).
FLY_FROM forces the fly motion to begin at the distance specified by
$FLY_DIST from the taught intermediate position.
Note that the dynamics of the machine could make it impossible for the programmed
distance to be maintained. This becomes more likely as the value of $STRESS_PER is
decreased.
Be careful! $FLY_DIST is only used if $FLY_TRAJ is DIFFERENT from FLY_AUTO
Motion Control
5-34
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
Fig. 5.12 - FLY Movements
The above picture (Fig. 5.12 - FLY Movements) shows an example of the use of these
system settings. With $FLY_DIST set equal to 20 mm, the following results will be seen.
When the value of $FLY_TRAJ is set to:
FLY_TOL, then the distance A will be less than or equal to 20 mm;
FLY_PASS, then the distance A will be 20 mm;
FLY_FROM, then the distance B will be 20 mm.
5.10.2.2.4 Debug of Fly Motions
When debugging FLY_CART motions a field of $CRNT_DATA can be used to
determine the status of the last motion. The field name is $FLY_DBUG and will be zero
if the optimized trajectory was obtained or will contain a value to indicate the state of the
movement.
The FLY_DBUG field can be used in a NOHOLD program, from condition handlers, etc.
The programs can simply write the value to the display device for evaluation or
undertake some corrective actions. After the program has been properly configured
these debugging aids should be removed so they dont slow the system down
unnecessarily. The following program demonstrates a simple example of the
FLY_DBUG used in a CONDITION.
PROGRAM mov_cart
CONST
ar m_num= 1
cond_num= 1
ROUTI NE print_debug
BEGI N
WRI TE ( $CRNT_DATA[ arm_num] . FLY_DBUG, NL)
END print_debug
BEGI N
$CRNT_DATA[ arm_num] . FLY_DBUG : = 0
CONDI TI ON[ cond_num] NODI SABLE :
WHEN AT END DO
Motion Control
5-35
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
pr i nt _debug
ENDCONDI TI ON
- - initialisation
ENABLE CONDI TI ON[ cond_num]
- - move statements
END mov_cart
Tab. 5.2 - FLY_DBUG field codes for $CRNT_DATA variable
Code Description
0 Optimal situation indicating that the speed is maintained constant and the trajectory, planned
with $FLY_DIST, is guaranteed.
1 The fly lasts for less than 40ms. It is impossible to activate the constant speed algorithm. This
code is informational only; speed is maintained constant.
2 The angle between the trajectories is too small (less than 5 degrees) so it is impossible to
activate the constant speed algorithm.
3 Acceleration reduction due to an extreme orientation evolution. This is caused by the
evolution of the tool orientation during fly. In this situation, the fly is smoothed and the speed
is maintained constant.
4 Replanning due to weaving causes a distance to be set, which is greater than the user
programmed one ($FLY_DIST). The speed is maintained constant.
5 Speed for passing the planned distance is reduced. In order to respect the restriction of the
passage ($FLY_DIST) and the restriction on the stress ($STRESS_PER), speed is
automatically reduced during fly. By default, $FLY_DIST is set to 5 and $FLY_TRAJ is set to
FLY_TOL. To overcome this speed reduction, increased the tolerance on the planned
trajectory (i.e. increase $FLY_DIST) or increase $STRESS_PER.
6 Speed reduction on a circular motion due to extreme stress. This code means that the
limitation on the maximum stress ($STRESS_PER) is imposing a speed reduction on the
whole circular trajectory. This can be overcome by increasing the radius of the circle,
increasing the value of $STRESS_PER, or reducing programmed speed.
7 Speed reduction due to an extreme orientation evolution. The orientation evolution required
during fly imposes speeds that are greater than the maximum allowed and the speed is
reduced during trajectory. To overcome, spread the orientation variation on the previous and
next motion or increase $STRESS_PER.
8 It is impossible to respect the passage at the planned distance and the resulting distance is in
effect reduced. This occurs only when $FLY_TRAJ is set to FLY_PASS or FLY_FROM. The
passage was programmed by the user to pass through a point that is too far away. It is
possible to obtain some advantages by decreasing the speed or by increasing the
$STRESS_PER value.
9 e 10 Current motion is too short to keep constant speed during fly. The planned speed is reached
during the movement. To change such a condition, increase (if possible) the distance
between the planned points and increase $STRESS_PER.
11 Motion too short to reach the planned speed because the acceleration phase cannot be
terminated. If possible, increase the distance between the two planned points. In some
cases, it could be useful to increase $STRESS_PER.
12 Extreme stress for a short motion. The resulting motion is too short for the execution of the fly
that guarantees the limitations on the maximum stress. The resulting stresses are greater
than the planned ones and the speed could change during fly. To change this condition,
increase (if possible) the distance between the planned points and increase $STRESS_PER.
13 Extreme stresses on the orientation evolution due to a short motion. The resulting motion is
too short for executing a fly that guarantees the limitations on the maximum stress in the
orientation evolution. The resulting stresses are greater than the planned ones and the speed
could change during fly.
Motion Control
5-36
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
5.10.2.2.5 Variables used with FLY Motion
If $FLY_TYPE is equal to FLY_CART, the following table summarizes the other values
that must be defined.
$STRESS_PER {value from 1% to 100% }
$CRNT_DATA[arm].FLY_DBUG: usually used for read-only
$FLY_TRAJ values: FLY_AUTO, FLY_TOL, FLY_PASS, FLY_FROM
$FLY_DIST: values in millimeters. This is used when $FLY_TRAJ is different from
$FLY_AUTO.
5.11 Remote Tool System
Remote tool system is a particular configuration in which the robot is treated as a positioner
referred to a fixed tool. The robot carries the workpiece so that the TCP of the fixed tool
follows the right trajectory on the workpiece.
This is common in applications where the tool is much heavier than the part or is
immobile for some reason. The remote tool system is enabled by setting the
$TOOL_RMT system variable to TRUE.
Since this variable is a field of $ARM_DATA, it is not reset upon program deactivation
and, in addition, its current value is saved in file.C4G by ConfigureSave command.
Note that the workpiece frame is now defined with respect to the flange of the robot by
means of $UFRAME, while $TOOL represents the position of the remote TCP with
respect to the world frame (Fig. 5.13 - Remote Tool System).
14 e 15 Impossibility of fly re-planning due to lack of time. The movement does not last long enough
to allow the completion of the preliminary counts. The resulting stresses are greater than the
planned ones and the speed could change during fly. If possible, increase the distance
between the two planned points. In some cases, it could be useful to increase
$STRESS_PER.
16 Impossibility of fly re-planning with extreme stresses on the orientation evolution. The
resulting stresses are greater than the planned ones and the speed could change during fly. If
possible, increase the distance between the planned points and reduce the planned speed
($LIN_SPD). In some cases, it could be useful to increase $STRESS_PER.
Tab. 5.2 - FLY_DBUG field codes for $CRNT_DATA variable
Code Description
Motion Control
5-37
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
Fig. 5.13 - Remote Tool System
1. Flange Frame
2. User Frame
3. TCP Frame
4. Fixed Tool
5. Base Frame
5.12 Integrated Movement
When the base of a robot is mounted on another mechanism in order to extend the work
envelope, integrated management of the two mechanical systems is possible. Two
situations may arise according to whether the mechanism that transports the robot
consists of a single auxiliary axis (integrated axis) or of a second robot (integrated arms).
In cartesian movement ($BASE, $TOOL, $UFRAME), WITH ENABLED REMOTE
TOOL, while programming robot movement it is necessary to consider the remote
tool virtual motion, INSTEAD OF the actual robot motion.
Example: WITH ENABLED REMOTE TOOL, to be able to execute a Z+ motion in
$BASE Frame of reference (which means Z upward motion), robot must move
along Z downward, because, in such a way, it is a virtual upward movement of the
remote tool (which is actually fixed!): this means Z+ in $BASE as requested by the
user.
Motion Control
5-38
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
1. Slide Base Reference
2. Robot Base
3. User Reference
4. World Reference
5. Side View
6. Top View
7. Column rotation
8. Rotating Column
9. Column Base Reference
10. Robot Base
11. User Reference
12. World reference
13. Rotating Column
14. Column rotation
15. Slide
5.12.1 Integrated Axis
A robot can be mounted on an auxiliary axis in order to extend the work envelope. The
axis may be a slide (translating axis) or a Rotating Column.
In such a situation, it is possible to integrate the auxiliary axis in the movement of the
robot. This means that the cartesian position of the robot is calculated taking into
account the position of the auxiliary axis and therefore in relation to a reference integral
Motion Control
5-39
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
with the floor of the cell (WORLD reference), rather than with the base of the robot.
Practically speaking, it will be possible to move the TCP along a linear or circular path
while the slide/column is moving or to move the slide/column keeping the TCP still in
relation to the floor: in both cases, the robot axes will offset the movement of the auxiliary
axis.
The system sees the set of axes of the two mechanisms as a single manipulator. All the
types available, i.e. J OINTPOS, POSITION, XTNDPOS, can be used to assign the
destination positions of the movements. In the case of XTNDPOS, it is also possible to
specify the cartesian position of the TCP as well as the position of the auxiliary axis at
the same time.
5.12.1.1 Jogging
Moving the slide/integrated column manually (jog), the robot acts differently according
to the handing mode set: in joints mode, pressing the key corresponding to the
slide/column, the robot axes do not move; only the auxiliary axis moves. On the other
hand, in Cartesian mode of manual motion (BASE, TOOL, UFRAME) key 7 moves the
slide/column, keeping the TCP stationary, wherever the robot axes compensate the
movement of the auxiliary axis.
5.12.1.2 Reference Systems
With the slide/integrated column, the base reference of the system of axes (defined
using the $BASE variable) is located at the base of the slide/column. The other
reference systems remain unchanged as described in Frames of Reference section and
shown in following Fig. 5.14 - Base Reference System integrated axes.
Fig. 5.14 - Base Reference System integrated axes
1. Rotating Arm Radius (R)
2. Right-hand rotation of the Column
3. Column Height (H)
4. Left-hand rotation of the Column
For the configuration parameters, see the Cap. Use of Positioners managed by
C4G.
Motion Control
5-40
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
5.12.1.3 Restrictions
Integrated movement of the slide/column and robot is possible in the following
conditions:
there are no limitations as regards the robot model; however this can be positioned
in relation to the flange of the slide/column in only eight positions, i.e.: the
Z
base_robot
axis always parallel to Z
base_slide/column
(in both directions) and the
X
base_robot
axis aligned with the X
base_slide/column
or Y
base_slide/column
(four possible
directions);
the axis corresponding to the slide/column must be the first available auxiliary axis;
it is possible to integrate a single slide or column for each robot;
it is not possible to enable or disable integration of the slide/column in real time (the
controller must be restarted).
Motion Control
5-41
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
Motion Control
5-42
pr-0-0-gpr_04.fm
00/0607
Synchronous Motion (optional feature)
6-1
pr-0-0-gpr_07.fm
00/0607
6. SYNCHRONOUS MOTION
(OPTIONAL FEATURE)
This chapter describes the Synchronous Motion optional i.e., the synchronous motion
between a robot and other axes.
In particular, the following subjects are dealt with:
Synchronization with Auxiliary Axes
Synchronized Arms
Motion limitation of the two Arms
J ogging Synchronized Arms
Teaching and Modifying Positions (REC/MOD) with Synchronized Arms
Loss of Synchronization
Run-time modifying the Linear Speed Override
6.1 Synchronization with Auxiliary Axes
If the axes belong to the same robot arm they are called auxiliary axes and they always
move in a synchronized way with the robot. This means that all the axes start and stop
at the same time.
The movement can be programmed with the J OINTPOS data type, which contains the
joint position of each axis, or by means of the XTNDPOS data type which is composed
of a Cartesian position for the robot and an ARRAY of joint values for the remaining
axes. The use of XTNDPOS data type is recommended.
6.2 Synchronized Arms
The motion of two arms is said to be time synchronized when they start and stop
together. To program synchronized motions of two arms the SYNCMOVE clause on the
MOVE statement has been implemented.
This feature is useful, for example, in a double P-MAST workcell with the two arms
carrying a single workpiece. In addition this feature is necessary for cooperative motion
(see par. 7.1 Cooperative Motion with Auxiliary Axes a pag. 7-1).
The Arms involved in synchronised motion are:
MASTER Arm - it is always the arm that executes the MOVE;
SERVER Arm - it is always the arm that executes the SYNCMOVE.
In order to retrieve Comau Options Codes, please refer to C4G Control Unit
Technical Specifications Manual, chapter Software Options.
Synchronous Motion (optional feature)
6-2
pr-0-0-gpr_07.fm
00/0607
In the following synchronised MOVE:
MOVE ARM[ 1] LI NEAR TO PNT0001P SYNCMOVE ARM[ 2] J OI NT TO PNT001J
the MASTER Arm is ARM[1] and the SERVER Arm is ARM[2]; whereas in the next
synchronised MOVE :
MOVE ARM[ 2] LI NEAR TO PNT0001J SYNCMOVE ARM[ 1] J OI NT TO PNT001P
the MASTER Arm is ARM[2] and the SERVER Arm is ARM[1].
All this does not depend on the declared (or implied) Arm, PROG_ARM, at the head of
the program.
The system variable $SYNC_ARM specifies the default synchronized arm for the
SYNCMOVE clause, similar to $PROG_ARM that defines the default arm for the MOVE
statement. This variable is specific for the program and initialized by the user. For
example, in writing MOVE TO p1, since the arm has not been specified, the value of
$PROG_ARM is assumed. Similarly, in writing SYNCMOVE TO p2, since the arm for
the SYNCMOVE has not been specified, the value of $SYNC_ARM is assumed.
An example follows of a program that controls two Arms that move in synchronised
mode:
PROGRAM example
BEGI N
- - t he mai n ar mi s ar m1, t he synchr oni sed ar m
- - i s ar m2
MOVE ARM[ 1] TO p1 SYNCMOVE ARM[ 2] TO p2
MOVE TO p1 SYNCMOVE ARM[ 2] t o p2
- - $PROG_ARM moves on p1
MOVE ARM[ 1] TO p1 SYNCMOVE TO p2
- - ERROR: $SYNC_ARM i s not i ni t i al i sed
$SYNC_ARM : = 2 - - $SYNC_ARM i s i ni t i al i sed
MOVE ARM[ 1] TO p1 SYNCMOVE TO p2
- - $SYNC_ARM ( ar m2) moves on p2
MOVE TO p1 SYNCMOVE TO p2
- - $PROG_ARM and $SYNC_ARMEND ar e used, exampl e
The ADVANCE clause is applied to the entire MOVE... SYNCMOVE. To perform a fly it
is necessary to specify the FLY clause on the main move and insert ADVANCE before
SYNCMOVE:
MOVEFLY TO p1 ADVANCE,
SYNCMOVEFLY ARM[ 2] TO p2,
ENDMOVE
If an ADVANCE is inserted after p2, the translator sees a warning message and
automatically corrects instruction.
6.3 Motion limitation of the two Arms
The combined motion of the two Arms imposes motion limitation. The following table
highlights the parameters that limit the motion in two frequent situations :
Synchronous Motion (optional feature)
6-3
pr-0-0-gpr_07.fm
00/0607
It will be the task of the user to specify a speed option that is compatible with the
combined motion, since for both Arms all the limitations are valid that are present on the
individual robot: for example a short translation of the MASTER Arm, with
$SPD_OPT:=SPD_LIN, combined with a wide variation of the SERVER Arm orientation,
imposes an over-speed on the SERVER Arm that cannot be controlled with the override
values only.
It can be seen that in the programming of a multi-arm system with two robots that both
move in Cartesian mode with
$SPD_OPT:=SPD_LIN and with
$LIN_SPD equal,
but on paths of different lengths, only the MASTER Arm will observe the speed
restriction, whereas the SERVER Arm will move faster if it has to cover a longer path,
more slowly if the path is shorter.
6.4 Jogging Synchronized Arms
In a double arm system the user may activate two arms (DRIVES ON) and then jog each
of them. Before switching to DRIVES ON it is required to select the main arm (stored in
$TP_SYNC_ARM[1]) and the synchronized arm (stored in $TP_SYNC_ARM[2]). This
has to be performed from the Motion page, Basic sub-page, on the TP4i/WiTP Teach
Pendant if the SYNCARM option has been acquired. If $TP_SYNC_ARM[2] is set to
zero, only one arm will be used, i.e. $TP_SYNC_ARM[1].
The arm specified in the TP4i/WiTP status bar, can be moved with the manual keys. To
pass from one arm to the other, the required Arm has to be either specified in the Arm
field of the Motion page Basic sub-page, or using the Arm key (if needed SHIFT+Arm)
available in the Right Menu of the Teach Pendant. For further information, see the C4G
Control Unit Use - par. Right menu.
6.5 Teaching and Modifying Positions
(REC/MOD) with Synchronized Arms
The enabling and disabling of the SYNCMOVE teaching are selected through either IDE
Page (Selection - REC Setup command), or Program Edit and Memory Debug
environments, under item DEBUG SETUP SYNC.
When disabled, by pressing the REC key, MOVE ARM[#] TO p1 is taught, where #is
the number of the selected arm. Enabling the teaching of SYNCMOVE, by pressing the
REC key the MOVE ARM[#] TO p1 SYNCMOVE ARM[&] TO p2 is taught, where #is
the number of the $TP_SYNC_ARM[1] value and & is the value of $TP_SYNC_ARM[2]
(regardless of the ARM currently selected). Tab. 6.1 - Teach examples (REC key)
illustrates some teach examples.
MASTER Arm trajectory $SPD_OPT value Limiting arm
joints or Cartesian SPD_JNT or SPD_CONST
Arm with more restrictive
parameters
Cartesian
different to SPD_JNT and to
SPD_CONST
MASTER Arm
Synchronous Motion (optional feature)
6-4
pr-0-0-gpr_07.fm
00/0607
For further information, please refer to Use of C4G Controller Unit manual, IDE Page
section.
6.6 Loss of Synchronization
The cases in which loss of synchronization between several arms occurs are described
below. The first case is that of the TIL clause that can be applied either to the main arm
or to the synchronized one; when the event associated with the TIL clause triggers, the
related movement is cancelled and the synchronization is lost. If, during a synchronized
motion, the CANCEL statement is executed, the main arm motion is cancelled, while the
synchronized one continues, hence synchronization is lost. If the user needs to cancel
both, he must cancel the move on both arms.
If the user locks (with LOCK statement) one arm during a synchronized move, the
synchronization is lost. To maintain the synchronization, he must lock both the arms,
with the statement:
LOCK ARM[ 1] , ARM[ 2]
This is not equivalent to:
LOCK ARM[ 1]
LOCK ARM[ 2]
After having locked both arms at the same time, even if arm 1 is resumed with the
RESUME ARM[1] statement, the synchronized motion does not restart. Only if the other
arm is also resumed, the synchronized move restarts on both the arms (RESUME
ARM[2]).
6.7 Run-time modifying the Linear Speed
Override
In single Arm systems, there is only one predefined variable to be used to Run-time
modifying the linear speed: $LIN_SPD_RT_OVR.
Viceversa, in multi-arm systems, there is a $LIN_SPD_RT_OVR for each Arm; in order
to Run-Time modify the linear speed, it is needed to identify which one is to be used
Tab. 6.1 - Teach examples (REC key)
Main Arm Action
1 teaches MOVE ARM[1] TO p1"
2 teaches MOVE ARM[2] TO p2"
1 teaches MOVE ARM[1] TO p3 SYNCMOVE ARM[2] TO p4"
2 teaches MOVE ARM[2] TO p4 SYNCMOVE ARM[1] TO p5"
Since system software version 3.1, a functionality is supplied which, under
special conditions, allows to Run-time modify the linear speed override of a robot
(see par. 5.5.2.2 Run-Time modifying the Linear Speed Override a pag. 5-18).
Synchronous Motion (optional feature)
6-5
pr-0-0-gpr_07.fm
00/0607
while executing a SYNCMOVE.
It is very important to exactely understand on which Arm such a functionality is currently
active. To do that, operate as follows:
Lets have the following PDL2 statement
MOVE ARM[ i ] TO P1 SYNCMOVE ARM[ j ] TO P2
we have three possibilities:
a. BOTH the Arms ARENT a Robot
b. ONE Arm ONLY IS a Robot
c. BOTH the Arms ARE Robots.
In order to understand if the Run-time modification of the linear speed does apply, and
which is the involved Arm, just check the second bit of the following field:
$CRNT_DATA[ num_ar m] . C_ALONG_1D[ 50]
it is automatically set by the system software, for the Arm on which the Run-time
modification functionality is active. If such a bit is set to TRUE, it means that the
associated Arm acts as master, as regards the Run-time speed modification during the
SYNCMOVE execution, while the other Arm follows the modifications. In such a way,
the motion synchronization is always satisfied.
a. no Run-time modifications are allowed for linear speed
b. the Run-Time modification of the linear speed is allowed on
the Robot only (using the $LIN_SPD_RT_OVR predefined
variable which is associated to such an Arm)
c. the Run-time modification is allowed on the Arm which is
executing a cartesian motion. Anyway it is always needed
to use the $LIN_SPD_RT_OVR predefined variable which
is associated to the Arm on which the Run-time
modification functionality is active.
Synchronous Motion (optional feature)
6-6
pr-0-0-gpr_07.fm
00/0607
Cooperative Motion (optional feature)
7-1
pr-0-0-gpr_08.fm
00/0607
7. COOPERATIVE MOTION
(OPTIONAL FEATURE)
The cooperative motion feature simplifies the programming of applications where a
workcell is composed of a robot and one or more positioners (i.e. a rotating table). When
cooperative motion is enabled, the robot position is defined with respect to the positioner
so that Cartesian trajectory can be executed at constant speed while moving the
workpiece. This is mainly useful in welding complex shapes or large workpieces.
A general rule can be followed in the case of cooperative motion: the $UFRAME
transformation defines the position of the workpiece with respect to the flange frame of
the active positioner and not with respect to the world frame. This is shown in (Fig. 7.1
- System frames with auxiliary axes cooperative motion and Fig. 7.2 - User frame with
auxiliary axes cooperative motion). This is because the user frame is not fixed but is
linked with the positioner.
Cooperation can be enabled between a robot and its auxiliary axes or between two
different arms.
This chapter describes the following subjects :
Cooperative Motion with Auxiliary Axes
Cooperative Arms
J ogging
7.1 Cooperative Motion with Auxiliary Axes
If the robot and the positioner are organized in a single arm workcell, the positioner axes
are controlled by means of XTNDPOS data types as auxiliary axes. The cooperative
motion for this type of positioner can only be enabled after the positioner has been
correctly configured. The $AUX_BASE system variable is an array of POSITION used
to define the location of the bases of the positioners with respect to the world.
In order to retrieve Comau Options Codes, please refer to C4G Control Unit
Technical Specifications Manual, chapter Software Options.
Cooperative Motion (optional feature)
7-2
pr-0-0-gpr_08.fm
00/0607
Fig. 7.1 - System frames with auxiliary axes cooperative motion
1. Positioner Flange Frame
2. Positioner 1
3. Positioner 2
Fig. 7.2 - User frame with auxiliary axes cooperative motion
1. User Frame
2. Positioner Flange frame
3. Positioner Base Frame
To enable and disable cooperative motion, the following built-in procedure is available:
AUX_COOPAUX_COOP( f l ag, j oi nt _aus <<, ar m>>)
The data type for the flag is boolean. It can be set to ON or OFF for switching the
auxiliary cooperative motion on or off. Aux_joint field is the number of the last axis
composing a positioner.
The arm field is the arm on which the auxiliary cooperative motion should be executed,
if not explicitly defined, $PROG_ARM is used.
For example, in a system with a 5-axes robot, a first 2-axes positioner (axis 6, 7) and a
second 1-axis positioner (axes 8) the syntax could be the following:
AUX_COOP( ON, 7) - - enables the cooperative motion with the first
- - positioner
AUX_COOP( ON, 8) - - disables the previous cooperative motion end
- - enables the cooperative motion with the
- - second positioner
AUX_COOP( OFF) - - disables the cooperative motion
Cooperative Motion (optional feature)
7-3
pr-0-0-gpr_08.fm
00/0607
7.2 Cooperative Arms
The cooperative motion between two arms of the same work cell controlled by the C4G
can be enabled defining the first arm as the work arm and the second one as positioner.
The positioner trajectory will be computed with respect to the flange of the worker.
To enable and disable cooperative motion between two arms, the following built-in
procedure is available:
ARM_COOP( f l ag <<, ar m_posi zi onat or e <<, ar m_l avor o>>>>)
The data type of flag is boolean. It can be ON or OFF to enable and disable the
cooperation. The second parameter is optional and specifies the positioner arm. If the
positioner arm is not specified, the value of the $SYNC_ARM system variable is
assumed. The third parameter is optional and specifies the working arm. If the working
arm is not specified, the value of the $PROG_ARM system variable is assumed.
Cooperation can be performed independently from the synchronization of the arms by
simply enabling it and moving the positioner and the working arms. However from a
programming point of view, synchronization is preferred.
Fig. 7.3 - System frames with cooperative arms shows how the different frames of
reference for the two arms are defined. The positioner (arm 2) moves its TCP (defined
by $ARM_DATA[2].TOOL) with respect to its user frame ($ARM_DATA[2].UFRAME),
while the TCP of the working arm ($ARM_DATA[1].TOOL) moves the TCP with respect
to a frame of reference referred to by the TCP of the positioner (by means of
$ARM_DATA[1].UFRAME).
Fig. 7.3 - System frames with cooperative arms
1. Working Arm
2. Positioner Arm
7.3 Jogging
Cooperative motion provides easy programming for while jogging the positioner arm, the
working one follows the positioner in order to keep constant the torch position (location
and orientation) with respect to the workpiece. This feature simplifies the programming
of complex trajectories, saving time and reducing the number of points that must be
taught.
Cooperative Motion (optional feature)
7-4
pr-0-0-gpr_08.fm
00/0607
The cooperation during jog must be enabled with the ARM_COOP (for cooperative
arms) and AUX_COOP (for auxiliary axes cooperation) built-in procedures. These can
be executed inside the program by means of the key or through the Execute command
on the Service page (Execute softkey) of the TP4i/WiTP Teach Pendant.
Sensor Tracking (optional)
8-1
pr-0-0-gpr_10.fm
00/0607
8. SENSOR TRACKING (OPTIONAL)
The "Sensor Tracking" environment allows real-time correction of the Cartesian
trajectory based on indications coming from various sensors. The main characteristics
are:
possibility to interface with a wide range of sensors (integrated in C4G, analog I/Os,
serial ports);
projection of corrections in all the main reference systems (tool, user, world,
weaving);
translation corrections and geometry variations;
relative and absolute corrections;
control possibilities with and without programmed move;
sensors dedicated to each arm in multi-arm applications;
possibility to configure the robot dynamic response;
compliance to safety restrictions;
complete compatibility with other C4G services.
Detailed information follows regarding these subjects:
Principle of operation
Configuration on several arms
Sensor interface
Sensor reference system
Type of information acquired by the sensor
Correction actuation criteria
Sensor tracking enable mode
Sensor malfunctioning
Accumulative overall deviations management
Programming example
8.1 Principle of operation
During normal operation, the robot is controlled on a programmed position that is
periodically updated at each interpolation period ($MCP_DATA[n].IPERIOD). The
sensor tracking environment allows the robot to progressively move away from this
position concordantly with the requests coming from a sensor. This is obtained keeping
a deviation vector (overall deviations) that is applied to the nominal programmed
In order to retrieve Comau Options Codes, please refer to C4G Control Unit
Technical Specifications Manual, chapter Software Options.
Sensor Tracking (optional)
8-2
pr-0-0-gpr_10.fm
00/0607
position.
The vector is composed of 6 components; the first three are the deviations in X, Y and
Z directions and the other three the rotations around the same axes. To better
understand the effect of sensor tracking, let us consider an application where there is a
programmed trajectory and a sensor that can bring the TCP on an optimised trajectory
that is different to that programmed. Let us suppose that the program consists of a joints
move on a start position, followed by two linear moves linked in fly and a final joints move
to reach a position out of range.
The program could be the following:
PROGRAM sensor
VAR
p1, p2, p3, p4 : POSI TI ON
BEGI N
$SPD_OPT: =LI N_SPD- - To check t he l i near speed
$LI N_SPD: =0. 1 - - Li near speed i n m/ s
MOVE J OI NT TO p1
MOVEFLY LI NEAR TO p2 ADVANCE
MOVE LI NEAR TO p3
MOVE J OI NT TO p4
END sensor
If the sensor is enabled along the Cartesian path from p1 to p3, the effect could be as
shown in Fig. 8.1 - Programmed trajectory and sensors control where the dashed line is
the programmed trajectory and the continuous line is the trajectory actually travelled by
the TCP under the control of the sensor; the arrow between the two trajectories is the
deviations vector. It can be seen in the example that the tracking terminates when the
nominal position reaches point p3; on this point, the Control Unit re-acquires the actual
position and resets the deviations accumulated along the path, then the next joints move
will terminate exactly on the programmed point p4 as required. The following
paragraphs illustrate all the characteristics of the sensor tracking environment with
explanations on how to use the system and Built-In variables to program applications
that use sensors.
Fig. 8.1 - Programmed trajectory and sensors control
1. Starting point
2. Arrival point
3. Programmed trajectory
4. Trajectory controlled by sensor
Sensor Tracking (optional)
8-3
pr-0-0-gpr_10.fm
00/0607
8.2 Configuration on several arms
C4G can control several robots at the same time (multi-arm system); to do so, the
sensor tracking can be enabled separately on different arms by system variables that
are $ARM_DATA and Built-In fields that allow the arm referred to as an optional
parameter .All the variables are listed in Tab. 8.1 - System variables for Sensor
Tracking; ; it also indicates the limits, the default value and whether the WITH clause
can be used with the variables. Since all the variables are $ARM_DATA fields, they are
not reset when the program where they have been modified is deactivated.
Furthermore, by executing ConfigureSave, they are saved in 'file.C4G' with their current
value Tab. 8.2 - Built-In for Sensor Tracking illustrates the built-ins for sensors
management.
8.3 Sensor interface
A sensor is suitable for sensor tracking applications if it is able to measure one or more
physical values and obtain from them geometrical information regarding the optimal
position, i.e. calculate the error between the actual TCP position and the optimal position
on the workpiece. A sensor may be integrated in the system at different levels; it is
therefore possible to distinguish between INTEGRATED sensors and EXTERNAL
sensors. The $SENSOR_TYPE system variable distinguishes between these two
possibilities.
Tab. 8.1 - System variables for Sensor Tracking
Name Type Limits Default WITH
$SENSOR_ENBL BOOLEAN True-False False YES
$SENSOR_TYPE INTEGER [ 0, 30 ] 0 YES
$SENSOR_CNVRSN ARRAY [6] OF REAL [ -inf, +inf ] 0 NO
$SENSOR_GAIN ARRAY [6] OF INTEGER [ 0, 100 ] 00 NO
$SENSOR_TIME INTEGER [ 0, 10000 ] 0 ms YES
$SENSOR_OFST_LIM ARRAY [2] OF REAL [ 0, +inf ] [0,0] mm, degrees NO
$SFRAME POSITION null position YES
Tab. 8.2 - Built-In for Sensor Tracking
SENSOR_SET_DATA ( err_track <,arm>)
SENSOR_GET_DATA ( sens_read <,flag <,arm>>)
SENSOR_GET_OFST ( ofst_tot <,arm>)
SENSOR_TRK ( bool <,arm>)
Where:
errp_track, sens_read, ofst_tot are ARRAY[6] OF
REAL
flag is an INTEGER value in read
arm is INTEGER type
Sensor Tracking (optional)
8-4
pr-0-0-gpr_10.fm
00/0607
8.3.1 Integrated Sensors ( MCP-ST board (Seam Track))
Some sensors are pre-set for integration into the control system hardware because they
consist of an ST type of MCP board, that can be mounted on the C4G rack and seen as
part of the Control Unit. These devices are integrated sensors if the communication
between sensor and control system is managed by system software and not only by
PDL2 programs. The MCP-ST board is integrated in the C4G; it has been developed by
COMAU for arc welding applications. It allows real-time correction of the robot trajectory
exploiting the reading of the arc current/voltage during high frequency weaving
(Cartesian or joints weaving). In this configuration the torch is kept on the joint to be
welded by subsequent corrections in two directions: crosswise and vertical to the
trajectory.
For less complicated applications the MCP-ST board can be used to keep the wire
length steady (stick-out) optimising the result on welding without weaving. In this case
the correction is only in the direction of the torch.
The $SENSOR_TYPE values for this type of sensor range between 1 and 4. Values 1
and 2 are reserved for the first board and values 3 and 4 for the second. (see Tab. 8.3
- Correction_Speed =Factor*Reference_Speed).
In the case of integrated sensors, the communication of the sensor information takes
place at software level and therefore the values are not known directly at PDL2 level. To
read them there is the following Built-In SENSOR_GET_DATA:
$SENSOR_GET_DATA ( sens_r ead <, f l ag <, ar m>> )
This copies the six components of the vector coming from the sensor into the sens_read
parameter: the first three elements correspond to the translations in X, Y and Z
directions and the others are the rotation around axes X, Y and Z.
If the sensor is only able to control some of the six components, the others will remain
at a value zero. The optional flag parameter is set to value 1 if the data is new i.e. it has
never been read by a previous SENSOR_GET_DATA instruction. Otherwise it is set at
0. The optional arm parameter selects the data relating to an arm that is not the default
one.
8.3.2 External sensors
External sensors are those which communicate with the C4G through signals on the
analog or digital I/O ports and serial ports. Examples of this type of sensors are:
Simple limit switches or binary proximity sensors that give a single digital datum
(they change the signal when the distance measured exceeds a certain threshold);
Capacitive or inductive proximity sensors that communicate by an analog input or
by coded information on several digital inputs;
Sensors connected to the control system by a communication line managed by a
PDL2 program. The two-three dimension cameras may belong to this category
since they usually have a dedicated controller, that makes the necessary
calculations to interpret the image, and a communication line to receive the
commands and transmit the information.
These types of sensors have the characteristic that the reading of the information is
performed by a PDL2 program (usually NOHOLD), created specifically for the sensor.
The program will read the analog or digital I/O channels accordingly and will manage the
Sensor Tracking (optional)
8-5
pr-0-0-gpr_10.fm
00/0607
communication on serial port; It will then appropriately process the information and send
the corrections to the C4G movement environment that will apply them to the trajectory
in progress.
The $SENSOR_TYPE values reserved for this type of sensor are included between 5
and 12 (see Tab. 8.3 - Correction_Speed =Factor*Reference_Speed). To send the
correction request to the movement environment the following Built-In has been
introduced :
SENSOR_SET_DATA ( er r _t r ack <, ar m> )
The err_track parameter is the vector of the corrections required, the first three elements
correspond to the translations in X, Y and Z directions, whereas the others are the
rotations around the same axes.
The unused err_track components have to be initialised in any case to value zero. With
the optional "arm" parameter corrections can be sent to an arm that is not the default
one. The Built-In SENSOR_GET_DATA, described in the previous paragraph can also
be used with this type of sensors. In this case the sens_read variable will contain the
same data as sent with SENSOR_SET_DATA.
8.4 Sensor reference system
The sensors measure the deviations in relation to a reference system that depends on
the characteristics of the actual sensor, that is to say, according to its position and the
type of physical value measured. To cover all the possibilities, the following cases can
be determined: TOOL, USER, WORLD and WEAVE reference. To select these
different cases the $SENSOR_TYPE system variable is used .
8.4.1 Sensor integral with the tool (TOOL)
This type of reference is used when the sensor is mounted on the tool itself.
This is the case of a proximity sensor mounted on the tip of the tool or a laser
camera on the welding torch. The most frequent case is the MCP-ST arc
parameters sensor in the arc height control mode or with joint type weaving; in the
latter case the TOOL reference has to be used because if the weaving is joints
type, a weaving reference system is not defined (therefore it would not make sense
to use the mode in WEAVE reference).
The $SENSOR_TYPE values reserved for this reference are: 1 for MCP-ST, 5 and 9 for
external sensors (Tab. 8.3 - Correction_Speed =Factor*Reference_Speed).
In these tracking modes (TOOL reference) the reference system that describes the TCP
position ($TOOL variable) can be distinguished from the reference in which the sensor
makes the measurements.
To do this there is the $SFRAME system variable. This is a conversion of co-ordinates
referred to the TCP reference system, since it follows $TOOL in the kinematic chain (see
Fig. 8.2 - Tool frame conversion).
Sensor Tracking (optional)
8-6
pr-0-0-gpr_10.fm
00/0607
Fig. 8.2 - Tool frame conversion
1. Flange
2. Tool
3. Sensor
4. Sensor frame
5. TCP frame
8.4.2 Sensor integral with the user reference system (USER)
With this possibility the corrections can be projected in relation to the user reference
system defined by the $UFRAME system variable.
This case also includes sensors that are mounted in a fixed position as to the work
station or that are handled by kinematics that permit the measures executed to be
brought back to the USER reference system .
This mode does not have significance with the MCP-ST sensor, therefore
$SENSOR_TYPE can enable this mode only for external sensors with codes 6 and 10
(see Tab. 8.3 - Correction_Speed =Factor*Reference_Speed).
Also in this case it may be necessary to assign a specific reference system to the
sensor, calculated according to the USER system. This can be obtained with the same
$SFRAME variable that, in these modes, represents a conversion in relation to the
USER reference (it follows $UFRAME in the kinematic chain, see Fig. 8.3 - User frame
conversion).
Fig. 8.3 - User frame conversion
1. World frame
Sensor Tracking (optional)
8-7
pr-0-0-gpr_10.fm
00/0607
$SFRAME also serves to select the centre of rotation for the tool geometry corrections.
If $SFRAME is not zero, the centre of rotation is defined by the $SFRAME itself,
whereas if all the components are null, the centre of rotation coincides with the TCP.
8.4.3 Sensor integral with the world reference system (WORLD)
This is an extension of the USER case. This mode permits the projection of the
corrections in relation to the world reference system - the system to which $BASE and
$UFRAME refer. The values of $SENSOR_TYPE for this mode, for external sensors
only , are 7 and 11 (Tab. 8.3 - Correction_Speed =Factor*Reference_Speed).
8.4.4 Sensor integral with the weaving reference system
(WEAVE)
This is exclusively for arc parameter sensors (MCP-ST board ) with Cartesian type
weaving. In this case the sensor makes the measurement through the torch; it is
independent in its orientation but depends on the direction of the weaving. The
corrections calculated have to be projected, not in the torch reference system (TOOL)
but with regard to the weaving (WEAVE).
The $SENSOR_TYPE values for this type of reference are 2 for the MCP-ST board, 8
and 12 for external sensors (see Tab. 8.3 - Correction_Speed =
Factor*Reference_Speed).
8.5 Type of information acquired by the sensor
The most sophisticated sensors give Cartesian corrections directly in millimetres,
whereas others just give the measurement of the physical value that, in the most
frequent cases, is directly proportional to the distance measured. In such cases the C4G
automatically converts the data read by the sensor (for example ampere, Newton, etc.)
to corrections in millimetres through the $SENSOR_CNVRSN system variable. This is
a vector of 6 REAL type elements that contain the conversion factors. Each sensor data
component is multiplied by a corresponding conversion factor before being applied to
the trajectory.
for example a proximity sensor supplies a current or a voltage that can be
converted in millimetres by multiplying by a specific mm/A or mm/V factor ;
the MCP-ST board operates in a way so that the corrections are calculated on the
basis of the welding current/voltage;
the force sensors are a separate category, since they do not measure a position or
a physical value directly connected to them, but give an indication that there is the
"need to correct the trajectory" in a certain direction. For these sensors the factor
by which the signal is multiplied assumes the significance of a gain since with an
equal signal a correction is calculated in millimetres without being able to know the
exact size of the correction required.
If it is wished to exclude the effect of this conversion, it is sufficient to set the
$SENSOR_CNVRSN components to value 1 (default value). $SENSOR_CNVRSN can
also disable the application of one or more components of the correction: this is obtained
by setting the corresponding element of the vector to zero ($SENSOR_CNVRSN[n]:=0).
Sensor Tracking (optional)
8-8
pr-0-0-gpr_10.fm
00/0607
8.6 Correction actuation criteria
There are three elements that regard the actuation of the corrections: the first is to
distinguish between relative and absolute deviations; the second is for the mode in
which a correction is actuated in time; the third is to check the overall deviations between
the programmed position and the position reached under the control of the sensor.
The following subjects are described:
Relative and absolute deviations
Actuation of deviation in time
Overall deviations control
8.6.1 Relative and absolute deviations
The deviations are considered ABSOLUTE if the correction is requested regarding the
nominal trajectory of the robot, i.e. that which is programmed (Fig. 8.4 - Absolute
deviations). The term RELATIVE deviations means a correction that is made with
reference to the current robot position, i.e. without taking into consideration the error
already accumulated during previous sensor readings (Fig. 8.5 - Relative deviation).
Fig. 8.4 - Absolute deviations
1. Programmed trajectory
2. Trajectory controlled by sensor
3. Correction required =+3 mm
4. Required =+1 mm
5. Required =-2 mm
6. Final deviation =0 mm
7. Required =0 mm
Sensor Tracking (optional)
8-9
pr-0-0-gpr_10.fm
00/0607
Fig. 8.5 - Relative deviation
1. Programmed trajectory
2. Trajectory controlled by sensor
3. Correction required =+3 mm
4. Required =+1 mm
5. Required =-2 mm
6. Final deviation =0 mm
7. Required =0 mm
For integrated sensors the choice between the two modes (absolute or relative)
depends on the type of sensor, and it is managed by system software: for example, the
MCP-ST board functions in relative mode. For external sensors there is a possibility to
choose by means of the $SENSOR_TYPE system variable: the values from 5 to 9
enable the relative mode functioning, whereas from 9 to 12 enable absolute mode
(Tab. 8.3 - Correction_Speed =Factor*Reference_Speed).
in most industrial applications the sensors measure the RELATIVE deviations
since they are able to determine the optimal trajectory position in relation to their
own position. Also in the case of force sensors the most frequent use is to consider
the data measured in relative mode. This means that until the sensor output differs
from zero the trajectory is continually modified adding new deviations to the old
ones, whereas when the output is null, the accumulated corrections are kept and
the robot trajectory remains parallel to the nominal one (Fig. 8.4 - Absolute
deviations);
the correction in ABSOLUTE mode is useful to obtain a yielding effect on the TCP
by means of force sensors. In practice a deviation is applied to the robot trajectory
that is proportional to the force sensor output. This causes the entire robot to
behave like a spring in all directions since as the measured force intensity
increases, the robot deviation from the programmed trajectory increases, when
there is no stress the robot returns to follow the programmed path (Fig. 8.5
- Relative deviation).
8.6.2 Actuation of deviation in time
Corrections measured by the sensor may also be several millimetres, especially if the
frequency at which the information is read is low. Therefore, in some cases it is not
possible to apply the entire deviation in one interpolation operation. There are two
possible rules for the distribution of the deviation during the move execution:
define the speed (SPEED) at which the correction will be performed;
Sensor Tracking (optional)
8-10
pr-0-0-gpr_10.fm
00/0607
define a time period (TIME PERIOD) during which the entire deviation will be
assimilated.
The first criterion guarantees the execution of the correction in the least time possible
and is useful in all cases where the time that lapses between two sensor readings is very
short (high frequency) or is not known.
However, in some applications this method determines a correction in "spurts" since ,
for small deviations the corrections are applied with a fast, brief movement of the robot.
In these cases the second criterion is more effective because it makes it possible to
distribute the entire deviation over a pre-set time.
To choose between these two modes the $SENSOR_TIME variable is used. If
$SENSOR_TIME is zero, the speed criterion is used. A value that is not zero selects the
second mode and indicates the time (in milliseconds) during which the correction is to
be applied.
For external sensors the new data will be read by the sensor only after this time has
expired, starting from the last corrections. Fig. 8.6 - Effects of $SENSOR_TIME (with
relative corrections) illustrates the effect of the two different criteria.
Fig. 8.6 - Effects of $SENSOR_TIME (with relative corrections)
1. Programmed trajectory
2. Trajectory controlled by sensor
In both the correction distribution modes, the speed can be assigned through the
$SENSOR_GAIN system variable. It is a vector with 6 INTEGER elements that have a
percentage significance (variability from 0 to 100 with default 50). It allows the program
to ratio the correction speed with the programmed movement execution speed. .
The first three elements regard the translations in the X, Y and Z directions and in the
case of $SPD_OPT=SPD_LIN, they represent a measurement of the angle between
the programmed trajectory and that which results from the correction. The value 50%
corresponds to the slope of 45 degrees (correction speed equal to the advance speed,
$LIN_SPD), whereas the values 0% and 100% represent the extreme cases of no
Sensor Tracking (optional)
8-11
pr-0-0-gpr_10.fm
00/0607
correction (0%) and immediate assimilation of the correction (100%).
If $SPD_OPT is set for one of the rotation control modes (SPD_ROT, SPD_SPN,
SPD_AZI, SPD_ELV, SPD_ROLL, SPD_FIRST, SPD_SECOND, SPD_THIRD) the
reference speed for the first three components of $SENSOR_GAIN is one fourth of the
maximum linear speed for that arm ($LIN_SPD_LIM/4).
The last three elements of $SENSOR_GAIN serve to control the speed of rotation
around the X, Y and Z axes. If it is $SPD_OPT=SPD_LIN, the reference speed is a
quarter of the maximum rotational speed ($ROT_SPD_LIM/4) thus the value of 50%
corresponds to a speed equal to $ROT_SPD_LIM/4 whereas the values 0% and 10%
represent the extreme cases of no correction (0%) and immediate assimilation of the
geometry variation (100%). If $SPD_OPT is set to one of the rotation control modes
(SPD_ROT, SPD_SPN, etc.) the reference speed for this component is $ROT_SPD.
Tab. 8.3 - Correction_Speed = Factor*Reference_Speed contains the multiplication
factors that, applied to the reference speed, make it possible to obtain the actual
programmed speed. These values are given as an explanation only, since in practice,
the value of $SENSOR_GAIN will be determined by experimentation .
The $SENSOR_GAIN variable is also taken into consideration when the criterion for the
distribution of the deviations is time ($SENSOR_TIME is not zero). In this case the
$SENSOR_GAIN components will be used to define the maximum correction speed
(Fig. 8.7 - Effects of $SENSOR_GAIN). To avoid all types of limitation the
corresponding $SENSOR_GAIN value can be set at 100%.
Tab. 8.3 - Correction_Speed = Factor*Reference_Speed
$SENSOR_GAIN[ i ] Factor
0
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
90
100
0.0
0.11
0.25
0.43
0.67
1.0
1.5
2.3
4.0
9.0
infinite
Sensor Tracking (optional)
8-12
pr-0-0-gpr_10.fm
00/0607
Fig. 8.7 - Effects of $SENSOR_GAIN
1. Programmed trajectory
2. Trajectory controlled by sensor
3. Maximum speed
4. Time increase
The use of this variable will depend on the measuring accuracy of the sensor used, and
the frequency with which these measures are supplied. If the sensor gives a precise
indication of the deviation that is to be assimilated (in millimetres) but with a low
frequency, the value of $SENSOR_GAIN is directly linked to the correction speed. If
instead the sensor is able to give only a generic indication on the direction in which the
correction is required, the $SENSOR_GAIN variable can be used as a gain, i.e. as a
parameter to be set-up on the basis of the fluctuations that are observed during the
application; the MCP-ST board is included in this category of sensors.
8.6.3 Overall deviations control
The overall deviation has already been defined as a vector with 6 elements that
represent the actual position of the robot in relation to its programmed position. This
vector can be read through the following Built-In:
SENSOR_GET_OFST ( of st _t ot <, ar m> )
The first three components of ofst_tot are the deviations in X, Y and Z directions, and
the other three components are the rotations around the same axes. The optional arm
parameter can be used to read the data of an arm that is not the default one.
This deviation vector will always refer to the USER reference system (the system
defined by $UFRAME by which all POSITIONs are defined) regardless of the
$SENSOR_TYPE value.
8.7 Sensor tracking enable mode
The sensor tracking can be activated on Cartesian trajectories only (LINEAR or
CIRCULAR) or, in certain situations, when there is no programmed move. The sensor
tracking is enabled by the $SENSOR_ENBL system variable. This can be assigned a
BOOLEAN type value (TRUE to enable and FALSE to disable). The variable can be
used alone in a single program line ( $SENSOR_ENBL:=TRUE/FALSE) or together with
a MOVE instruction with the WITH (MOVE LINEAR TO p1 WITH
$SENSOR_ENBL=TRUE/FALSE). The enabling and disabling of the tracking is closely
Sensor Tracking (optional)
8-13
pr-0-0-gpr_10.fm
00/0607
linked to the holding or the resetting of the overall deviations (see par. 8.9 Accumulative
overall deviations management a pag. 8-16).
The standard enable mode of sensor tracking permits the application of corrections read
by the sensor only during the execution of a programmed move and therefore the sensor
is ignored when the robot is stationary (even if in DRIVES ON). This is the mode most
frequently used in practical applications.
However, there are certain applications where it is necessary that the robot position is
enslaved to the sensor even without a programmed move.
a typical example is when the robot has to be latched to a moving object, or it
interacts with the workpiece without movement of any controlled axes, but closing
grippers or moving additional axes;
there are also sensors that can move the robot autonomously without the need of
a programmed move.
C4G is preset for this type of application, offering the possibility to enable the arm in a
certain state in which it is completely enslaved to the sensor although still having the
possibility to resume the programmed move at any time.
When introducing this service complete consistency of behaviour has been maintained
with that already possible in C4G in compliance with safety requirements. In particular
the following points are highlighted:
a. robot enslaving to a sensor without a programmed move can only be enabled by a
HOLDABLE program with the Control Unit in AUTO;
b. the start of the enslaving always depends on the pressing of the START key, until
that moment the user is certain that the machine cannot move;
c. movement under the control of the sensor can be stopped by pressing the HOLD
key and can only start again when the START key is pressed;
d. the enslaving terminates when the program that started it is deactivated.
These services have been obtained by introducing a special type of Built-In that can only
be executed by HOLDABLE. programs. The syntax is:
SENSOR_TRKSENSOR_TRK ( bool ean <, ar m> )
The execution of the SENSOR_TRK(TRUE) instruction selects a certain option so that,
enabling the sensor tracking with the $SENSOR_ENBL variable, the arm is in an
extended mode that permits enslaving even without a programmed move.
The optional arm parameter can enable the service on an arm that is not the default one.
There are the following limitations (they refer to the Built-In executed always on the
same arm):
a. the actual enabling of the enslaving without a programmed move is subordinated
to the value of $SENSOR_ENBL (however, it is not necessary to re-run
SENSOR_TRK(TRUE) after bringing $SENSOR_ENBL to FALSE and then to
TRUE);
b. since the SENSOR_TRK can only be run within HOLDABLE programs, it cannot
be run using the EXECUTE command from the system menu, nor by the
SYS_CALL of the EXECUTE command;
Sensor Tracking (optional)
8-14
pr-0-0-gpr_10.fm
00/0607
c. the service disabling through SENSOR_TRK(FALSE) can be executed only from
the same program that enabled it;
d. SENSOR_TRK cannot be executed if it is already enabled by a second
HOLDABLE program that is active at the same time;
e. the SENSOR_TRK mode is automatically disabled when the program that enabled
it is deactivated.
The enabling and disabling of the tracking in this mode has certain effects on the holding
or resetting of overall deviations (see par. 8.9 Accumulative overall deviations
management a pag. 8-16).
8.8 Sensor malfunctioning
There are two characteristics of the sensor tracking environment that help to minimise
the negative consequences of a sensor malfunctioning: the first makes it possible to stop
the robot, the second to redefine the correct deviations before resuming the interrupted
program.
Description of the following subjects:
Robot stop in the case of sensor malfunctioning
Redefinition of overall deviations
8.8.1 Robot stop in the case of sensor malfunctioning
In cases where the sensor is not reliable or is subject to disturbances, it could happen
that the robot moves too far from the programmed position with the risk of damaging the
fixture. For this situation the $SENSOR_OFST_LIM system variable has been provided.
It consists of 2 REAL type elements that indicate the maximum deviation allowed
between the programmed trajectory and the robot guided by the sensor. The first
element is for the translations (along X, Y and Z axes) and is in millimetres; the second
is for the rotations and is in degrees. When the limit of any of these components is
passed, an error message is sent and the robot is stopped in HOLD condition.
8.8.2 Redefinition of overall deviations
When examining error situations caused by malfunctioning of sensors, cases have been
noted where it is necessary to reassign the value of the accumulated deviations. In
particular this is indispensable when, because of a sensor error, the robot is taken away
from the optimal trajectory until it stops because it has exceeded the maximum
thresholds ($SENSOR_OFST_LIM). In these conditions the robot can be brought back
to the correct position and resume the running of the program by using two special
modes to restore the trajectory ($RCVR_TYPE).
By setting $RCVR_TYPE=7 the correct position can be redefined, bring the robot back
to the trajectory with the Teach Pendant and starting again: the interrupted movement
will be picked up again exactly from that position with no recovery. The deviations will
be automatically redefined with a new value. Fig. 8.8 - Effect of $RCVR_TYPE =7
shows the procedure.
Sensor Tracking (optional)
8-15
pr-0-0-gpr_10.fm
00/0607
Fig. 8.8 - Effect of $RCVR_TYPE = 7
1. Programmed trajectory
2. Trajectory controlled by sensor
3. Trajectory after a sensor failure
4. Optimal trajectory
5. HOLD caused by an error message
Not only the translation deviations (first three components) are redefined, but also those
of geometry variations, therefore, if it is wished to resume the move with the same
geometry as when the stoppage took place, this must not be changed during the jog
session.
The $RCVR_TYPE=8 mode is useful in such cases and permits the move to be
resumed returning exactly on the programmed trajectory resetting the deviations
accumulated by the sensor; in this mode the C4G plans a trajectory that recovers the
current position to correspond to the programmed trajectory and resume the interrupted
move.
After recovery, the deviations will be reset. Fig. 8.9 - Effect of $RCVR_TYPE =8 shows
how this mode functions.
The functioning of $RCVR modes from 0 6 are not submitted to variations in the case of
enabled sensor tracking. Therefore modes 0 and 4 bring the TCP exactly on the
interrupted position keeping the deviations accumulated up to that moment, whereas
modes 1, 2, 5 and 6 bring the robot on the programmed initial and final positions,
resetting the deviations.
Fig. 8.9 - Effect of $RCVR_TYPE = 8
1. Programmed trajectory
2. Trajectory controlled by sensor
3. Recovery trajectory
4. HOLD caused by an error message
Sensor Tracking (optional)
8-16
pr-0-0-gpr_10.fm
00/0607
8.9 Accumulative overall deviations
management
In the par. 8.1 Principle of operation a pag. 8-1 a brief description has been given of the
procedure in which the robot position is modified according to the indications of a
sensor. Below it is explained how the enabling and disabling of tracking can interact with
the holding or resetting of overall deviations. To do so, it is necessary to introduce the
following concepts: interrupted sensor tracking session (INTERRUPTED), suspended
session (SUSPENDED) and the spread resetting of the deviations (RESETTING
SPREAD) .
The following subjects are described below:
Interrupted sensor tracking session
Suspended sensor tracking session
Resetting in spread condition
Limitations in parameter changes
8.9.1 Interrupted sensor tracking session
A sensor tracking session is considered interrupted when, during
SENSOR_TRK(FALSE), the robot stops on a position without the move that took it to
that position being in ADVANCE and where the FLY clauses have not been defined.
The interruption of the tracking is important because with this event an acquisition is
made of the TCP actual position, with the consequent resetting of the deviations.
To understand the effect of an interruption, compare Fig. 8.10 - Interrupted sensor
tracking session with Fig. 8.1 - Programmed trajectory and sensors control; the
difference between the two programs consists in the fact that the fly has been removed
(and also the ADVANCE) on the intermediate p2.
The result in practice is that the linear move to p3 will be executed no longer starting
from the programmed point p2 but from point p2'; in p2 the deviations are reset.
Fig. 8.10 - Interrupted sensor tracking session
1. Programmed trajectory
2. Trajectory controlled by sensor
3. Starting point
4. Arrival point
5. New nominal trajectory
If tracking is enabled with the SENSOR_TRK(TRUE) option, the action changes since
Sensor Tracking (optional)
8-17
pr-0-0-gpr_10.fm
00/0607
this option makes it possible to leave the robot enslaved to the sensor, without a
programmed move and during the interruption. Looking again at the example in the case
of SENSOR_TRK(TRUE), a behaviour that is just the same as in Fig. 8.1 - Programmed
trajectory and sensors control can be noted notwithstanding that the fly and the
ADVANCE have been removed; in other words, no interruption takes place on p2. The
resetting will take place the moment the enslaving condition is interrupted with the
SENSOR_TRK(FALSE) or $SENSOR_ENBL:=FALSE instruction.
This indicates that the Built-In SENSOR_TRK(TRUE) can be used to avoid the resetting
of deviations on points where the robot stops (where there is no fly).
8.9.2 Suspended sensor tracking session
There are some cases where it is necessary to ignore the sensor corrections along a
complete move although keeping the deviations acquired up to that moment. This can
be obtained by setting $SENSOR_TYPE:=0 along the move involved (obviously
interruption must be avoided linking the movements in fly or entering
SENSOR_TRK(TRUE)). Fig. 8.11 - Suspended sensor tracking session illustrates this
operation.
Fig. 8.11 - Suspended sensor tracking session
1. Programmed trajectory
2. Trajectory controlled by sensor
3. Suspended sensor tracking
8.9.3 Resetting in spread condition
Resetting in spread is the opposite condition to the suspension of a sensor tracking
session. The latter allows the deviations to be kept along a linked move in fly, whereas
the resetting in spread allows the progressive resetting of deviations terminating the
move very close to the nominal programmed point. It is usually used by introducing an
interruption (as illustrated in Fig. 8.10 - Interrupted sensor tracking session); however
where it is necessary to keep the fly between the moves the $SENSOR_ENBL variable
can be set with the FALSE value, resetting mode in spread, along the move; this can
also be obtained using the WITH clause on the required move. During the move the
sensor is ignored. The effect is shown in Fig. 8.12 - RESETTING SPREAD during a
Move.
Sensor Tracking (optional)
8-18
pr-0-0-gpr_10.fm
00/0607
Fig. 8.12 - RESETTING SPREAD during a Move
1. Programmed trajectory
2. Trajectory controlled by sensor
3. OFFSET RESET without interrupt
8.9.4 Limitations in parameter changes
When using the sensor tracking there are some conditions that would cause
discontinuity in the move, and that are therefore monitored by error messages.
It is not possible to enable sensor tracking on joint type moves; therefore
$SENSOR_ENBL has to be set to FALSE before executing the move.
A joints move cannot be linked in fly, nor be in ADVANCE, with Cartesian moves
where sensor tracking was enabled. In the same way a joints move cannot follow
an enslaving phase without a programmed move before the Built-In
SENSOR_TRK(FALSE) has been executed to disable it.
In the absolute tracking mode ($SENSOR_TYPE=9, 10, 11 or 12) the $BASE,
$TOOL, $USER or $SFRAME cannot be changed without interrupting the sensor
Tab. 8.4 - $SENSOR_TYPE allowed values
$SENSOR_TYPE SIGNIFICANCE
0 Sensor suspended
1 MCP-ST sensor (first board) in TOOL reference
2 MCP-ST sensor (first board) in WEAVING reference
5 External sensor in TOOL reference, relative mode
6 External sensor in UFRAME reference,relative mode
7 External sensor in WORLD reference, relative mode
8 External sensor in WEACING reference, relative mode
9 External sensor in TOOL reference, absolute mode
10 External sensor in UFRAME reference, absolute mode
11 External sensor in WORLD reference, absolute mode
12 External sensor in WEAVING reference, absolute mode
13-14 Reserved
15 Reserved for the management of a certain type of laser camera
16-30 Reserved
Sensor Tracking (optional)
8-19
pr-0-0-gpr_10.fm
00/0607
tracking session (see par. 8.9.1 Interrupted sensor tracking session a pag. 8-16).
On the other hand, the change of reference systems in relative modes does not
create any problems.
It is not permitted to change from relative modes to absolute or vice-versa, without
interrupting the Sensor Tracking session. In the same way, it is not possible, in
absolute modes, to change the type of reference system in which the tracking is
required, without interrupting the enslaving (see par. 8.9.1 Interrupted sensor
tracking session a pag. 8-16).
8.10 Programming example
Below the program already given in the par. 8.1 Principle of operation a pag. 8-1 is
shown, completed with the instructions needed to configure and enable the sensor
tracking. It is assumed to use an external sensor mounted on the torch that is able to
calculate corrections in Y an Z directions in relation to the TOOL reference. The system
variables that are not shown in the example are left at their default value. The
GET_CORR routine, that is not indicated, will be written in PDL2 so as to read the
information of the sensor, process it and copy it in the two corr_y and corr_z.
parameters
PROGRAM sensor
VAR
p1, p2, p3, p4: POSI TI ON
cor r _y, cor r _z: REAL
cor r , of st : ARRAY[ 6] OF REAL
ROUTI NE send_cor r
BEGI N
get _cor r ( cor r _y, cor r _z)
cor r [ 2] : =cor r _y; cor r [ 3] : =cor r _z
SENSOR_SET_DATA( cor r )
SENSOR_GET_OFST( of st )
WRI TE ( X: , of st [ 1] , Y; , of st [ 2] , Z: , of st [ 3] , NL)
$TI MER[ 1] : = 0
ENABLE CONDI TTRUE[ 1]
END send_cor r
BEGI N
CONDI TI ON[ 1] :
WHEN $TI MER[ 1] > 500 DO
send_cor r - - Cor r ect i ons sent ever y 500 ms
ENDCONDI TI ON
cor r [ 1] : =0; cor r [ 2] : =0; cor r [ 3] : = 0
cor r [ 4] : =0; cor r [ 5] : =0; cor r [ 6] : = 0
- - Sensor t r acki ng envi r onment conf i gur at i on
$SPD_OPT : = SPD_LI N - - t o check l i near speed
$LI N_SPD : = 0. 1 - - Li near speed i n m/ s
Sensor Tracking (optional)
8-20
pr-0-0-gpr_10.fm
00/0607
$SENSOR_TYPE : = 5 - - Ext er nal sensor i n r el at i ve mode and TOOL
r ef er ence
$SENSOR_CNVRSN[ 2] : = 0. 2 - - Exampl e of Y conver si on f act or
$SENSOR_CNVRSN[ 3] : = 0. 2 - - Exampl e of Z conver si on f act or
$SENSOR_GAI N[ 2] : = 60 - - Exampl e of Y gai n
$SENSOR_GAI N[ 3] : = 80 - - Exampl e of Z gai n
$SENSOR_TI ME : = 500 - - Devi at i on di st r i but i on i n t i me
$SENSOR_OFST_LI M[ 1] : = 50 - - Tr ansl at i on maxi muml i mi t
- - Pr ogr ami n movement
MOVE J OI NT TO p1
- - Sensor t r acki ng sessi on
$TI MER[ 1] : = 0
ENABLE CONDI TI ON[ 1]
$SENSOR_ENBL : = TRUE
MOVEFLY LI NEAR TO p2 ADVANCE
MOVE LI NEAR TO p3
$SENSOR_ENBL : = FALSE
DI SABLE CONDI TI ON[ 1]
MOVE J OI NT TO p4
END sensor
Conveyor Tracking (optional feature)
9-1
pr-0-0-gpr_11.fm
00/0607
9. CONVEYOR TRACKING
(OPTIONAL FEATURE)
Conveyor Tracking feature allows the user to write simple programs for reaching
positions defined on a moving conveyor-truck: the C4G Controller automatically
compensates the istantaneous position of the conveyor. In order to compute the
instantaneous position of a truck, the conveyor motor has to be equipped with a position
transducer connected to the servo board (MCP) of C4G Controller Unit. Up to two linear
conveyors can be handled and only linear/circular moves can be executed when
tracking is active.
Two kinds of tracking are available:
Cartesian Tracking Cartesian tracking. In the case of cartesian tracking the robot
is bolted to the floor and the conveyor tracking is done using a dynamic conveyor
frame (truck frame) that will be shifted according to the position of the truck. In this
way, it is possible to track trucks mounted on traversing or rotating conveyors
involving, in the first case linear Cartesian tracking and, in the second, circular
Cartesian tracking.
They are no restrictions regarding the placement and orientation of the conveyor.
Since the robot is held and the workpiece moves, the workspace is reduced (the
robot can work on the part for a very short time) so that the cartesian tracking is
recommended for pick and place applications.
Rail Tracking Rail tracking. The rail tracking can be obtained when the robot is
mounted on a rail. In this case the rail is used to track and therefore the conveyor
must be of the linear type and the rail must be parallel to this. The rail motion will
be the sum of two components: a tracking component and the programmed motion
component.
By this, the rail tracking increases the workspace of the robot and allows to work
on very large parts controlling the tool speed and orientation.
This chapter describes the following subjects :
Configuration
Working Principle
Process Monitoring
Tracking Window
Motion Statements
Teaching Positions
Tracking Interruption
Limitations during Conveyor Tracking
In order to retrieve Comau Options Codes, please refer to C4G Control Unit
Technical Specifications Manual, chapter Software Options.
Conveyor Tracking (optional feature)
9-2
pr-0-0-gpr_11.fm
00/0607
Use of the Roto-translating Conveyor
9.1 Configuration
System variables to configure the conveyor are field of two types of data structures:
those relative to the arm are field of $ARM_DATA structure; those related to the
conveyor-belt are field of two tables $CONV_TBL, one for each possible conveyor.
These variables are generally initialized by a setup program provided together with the
system.
To configure the hardware link of the conveyor to C4G Controller the following variables
are available:
$CONV_TBL[n].CT_J NT_MASK is a bit mask specifying the physical axis where the
resolver is connected; $CONV_TBL[n].CT_SCC indicates the servo board number
owing the physical axis.
The $ARM_DATA[n].CONV_CNFG[conv_idx] is a bit mask that specifies the type of
tracking according to the following convention:
The first bit specifies Cartesian tracking (bit set to FALSE) or rail tracking (bit set to
TRUE).
In the case of rail tracking, the second bit defines the direction of travel of the
conveyor. The bit must be set to FALSE if the positive direction of the rail of the
robot coincides with the direction of travel of the conveyor.
In the case of Cartesian tracking, the third bit defines whether the conveyor is of
the traversing type (bit set to FALSE) or rotating type (bit set to TRUE).
the fifth bit indicates the use of the rototranslating Conveyor (Robot enslaving to a
bending-press).
If the bit mask is read as numeric value, the $ARM_DATA[n].CONV_CONFG[conv_idx]
variable may have the following values:
0: linear Cartesian tracking;
4: circular Cartesian tracking;
1: rail tracking with the positive direction of the robot rail in the positive direction of
the conveyor;
3: rail tracking with the positive direction of the robot rail in the negative direction of
the conveyor.
16: rototranslating Cartesian tracking (
The $CONV_TBL[n].CT_TX_RATE system variable indicates the transmission ratio of
the position transducer used to measure the position of the truck: in the case of linear
Cartesian, roto-translating or rail type tracking, its unit of measurement is [mm/motor
turns] while in the case of a rotating conveyor its unit of measurement is [motor
turns/table turns].
The position of the conveyor with respect to the robot world frame is described by means
of $ARM_DATA[n].CONV_BASE[conv_idx] variable. It must be measured when the
conveyor-truck is at the zero position (see later) or in a known position. The position of
the origin of the reference and the direction of the axes must be selected according to
certain criteria that are slightly different in the case of linear, circular or rototranslating
tracking. In case of rototranslating Conveyor, see par. 9.9 Use of the Roto-translating
Conveyor a pag. 9-8.
Conveyor Tracking (optional feature)
9-3
pr-0-0-gpr_11.fm
00/0607
In the case of linear conveyors, the X axis of the basic reference must be aligned with
the direction of travel of the conveyor; the X-Y plane must coincide with the plane of the
truck and the origin must be positioned at the point in which a sensor detects passing of
the truck.
In the case of circular conveyors, the X axis must be tangential to the indexing table; the
Y axis must be in a radial direction in relation to the table and oriented towards the
center of rotation; the position of the Z axis depends on the first two axes according to
the right-hand rule and faces up if the indexing table turns in an anticlockwise direction
and down otherwise. In the circular case, the origin of the reference system must be at
a known distance from the center of rotation and not coincide precisely with this; this
distance represents the radius of the table and must be assigned to the
$CONV_TBL[i].CT_RADIUS variable (in case of rototranslating Conveyor, see par. 9.9
Use of the Roto-translating Conveyor a pag. 9-8). The circumference passing through
the origin of the basic reference of the table plays an important role in managing
rotations in that all distances and speeds are measured in relation to this basic
circumference.
Two variables are available to configure the limits for the speed and
acceleration/deceleration of the robot during the starting and ending phases of the
tracking:
$ARM_DATA[n].CONV_SPD_LIM[conv_idx]
$ARM_DATA[n].CONV_ACC_LIM[conv_idx].
9.2 Working Principle
The conveyor is not controlled by C4G Controller but only monitored by reading the
position of the position transducer connected to the motor of the conveyor and linked
with the servo board of C4G Controller. The position transducer value is stored in the
$CONV_TBL[n].CT_RES variable every interpolation tick.
At a certain distance from the working area, a sensor like a photocell must be placed to
detect the passage of conveyor-truck. This point is called zero position and when the
truck goes through this point the value of $ARM_DATA[n].CONV_ZERO[conv_idx] must
be set to 0.0 by means of an explicit PDL2 assignment statement
($ARM_DATA[n].CONV_ZERO[conv_idx] := 0.0). Then the system computes the
run-time position of the truck with respect to the conveyor base frame by mean of the
following formula and saves the result in the $CRNT_DATA[n].CONV_SHIFT[conv_idx]
system variable:
Every interpolation tick, the truck frame of reference is updated shifting it along X+by
the shift value expressed in mm by $CRNT_DATA[n].CT_SHIFT.
This distance is expressed in millimeters in case of linear tracking and in degrees in case
of circular tracking. When tracking is on, the user frame ($UFRAME) is defined relative
to the truck frame of reference so that all the POSITIONs are referred to the moving
workpiece (see Fig. 9.1 - Reference Frames for linear Cartesian tracking on rail and
Fig. 9.2 - Reference Frames for circular tracking).
$CRNT_DATA[ n] . CONV_SHI FT[conv_idx] : =[ ( $CONV_TBL[ n] . CT_RES -
$ARM_DATA[ n] . CONV_ZERO[conv_idx]) : 65536] * $CONV_TBL[ n] . CT_TX_RATE
Conveyor Tracking (optional feature)
9-4
pr-0-0-gpr_11.fm
00/0607
Fig. 9.1 - Reference Frames for linear Cartesian tracking on rail
1. Tracking Window
2. User Frame
3. Conveyor Base Frame
4. Slide Frame
5. World Frame
6. Sensor
Fig. 9.2 - Reference Frames for circular tracking
1. User Frame
2. Conveyor Base Frame
3. User Frame
4. Slide Frame
5. Sensor
6. User Frame
Conveyor Tracking (optional feature)
9-5
pr-0-0-gpr_11.fm
00/0607
In case of rail tracking, the shift value $CRNT_DATA[n].CONV_SHIFT[conv_idx] is
added to the motion of the robot rail and the result is that the world frame of reference
is moved according to the conveyor movements.
9.3 Process Monitoring
In addition to $CONV_TBL[n].CT_RES and $CRNT_DATA[n].CONV_SHIFT[conv_idx],
other two variables are available for monitoring of truck movement:
$CRNT_DATA[n].CONV_SPD[conv_idx] gives the speed of the truck while
$CRNT_DATA[n].CONV_DIST[conv_idx] indicates its position in thousandths of millimeters.
As $CRNT_DATA[n].CONV_DIST[conv_idx] is an INTEGER type variable, it can be inserted
more effectively than $CRNT_DATA[n].CONV_SHIFT[conv_idx] in a CONDITION to
guarantee maximum efficiency.
Note that the Control Unit considers the speed of the slide to be null if its motion is
reversed.
9.4 Tracking Window
The tracking window is a region that defines where the robot can track the workpiece.
The tracking window has an inbound boundary and an outbound boundary defined by
the system variable $ARM_DATA[n].CONV_WIN[1] and
$ARM_DATA[n].CONV_WIN[2].
$ARM_DATA[n].CONV_WIN[1] contains the distance of the inbound boundary from rhe
origin of the conveyor base frame (where the sensor is placed) and
$ARM_DATA[n].CONV_WIN[2] contains the distance of the outboud boundary (in the
case of an indexing table, these distances are read along the basic circumference).
When tracking is on, no move will begin until the origin of the truck frame is inside the
tracking window. If the robot attempts to move to a position when the part has not
reached yet the window, the controller waits until the part enters the window, which
means until $CRNT_DATA[n].CONV_SHIFT[conv_idx] is greater than
$ARM_DATA[n].CONV_WIN[1].
If the robot attempts to move to a position when the part has moved out of the window
($CRNT_DATA[n].CONV_SHIFT[conv_idx] > $ARM_DATA[n].CONV_WIN[2]), the
controller generates an error. Generally the tracking window is determined during the
configuration phase by moving the robot to the inbound and outbound boundaries.
9.5 Motion Statements
Tracking is switched on or off by the $ARM_DATA[n].CONV_TYPE system variable
which could assume the following values, represented by the following predefined
constants:
CONV_OFF: tracking is disabled
CONV_1ON: tracking is enabled on the first conveyor
CONV_2ON: tracking is enabled on the second conveyor
CONV_1READ: read-only mode is enabled for the first conveyor
CONV_2READ: read-only mode is enabled for the second conveyor
Conveyor Tracking (optional feature)
9-6
pr-0-0-gpr_11.fm
00/0607
CONV_1ON_2READ: tracking is enabled on the first conveyor and read-only
mode is enabled for the second conveyor
CONV_1READ_2ON: tracking is enabled on the second conveyor and read-only
mode is enabled for the first conveyor
Conveyor tracking mode causes that all subsequent POSITIONs are moving positions,
stuck to the truck. C4G Controller automatically compensates for the instantaneous
position referred to fixed positions.
In the above indicated read-only mode, all the monitored variables are updated
according to current values of truck position and speed, while the robot is enslaved to
the tracking.
The first move statement will not start until the destination is inside the tracking window.
Once the robot reaches the first moving position, it will keep on tracking also if it is not
executing a move. Tracking will finish on the first move statement in which
$ARM_DATA[n].CONV_TYPE=CONV_OFF (that is a move to a fixed position).
Parts on moving conveyor are detected by a digital sensor. When the part has triggered
the sensor, the value of $ARM_DATA[n].CONV_ZERO[conv_idx] variable must be set
to 0. This operation must be done inside the PDL2 program or by mean of an application
package.
Here is a program example to pick pieces from a conveyor and place them to a table:
PROGRAM conv
BEGI N
CONDI TI ON[ 1] :
- - for example, the sensor is connected to $DI N[ [ 1]
WHEN $DI N[ 1] DO
$CONV_ZERO[ 1] : = 0. 0
ENDCONDI TI ON
CYCLE
ENABLE CONDI TI ON[ 1]
WAI T FOR $DI N[ 1] - - wait for a workpiece
$CONV_TYPE : = CONV_1ON - - enable tracking
MOVE LI NEAR NEAR P1 BY 100 - - move to the track
MOVE LI NEAR TO P1 - - ove to the workpiece
CLOSE HAND - - pick
MOVE AWAY 100
$CONV_TYPE : = CONV_OFF - - disable tracking
MOVE LI NEAR NEAR P2 BY 100 - - move to a table
MOVE LI NEAR TO P2
OPEN HAND - - place
MOVE AWAY 100
END conv
9.6 Teaching Positions
Teaching cannot be performed when the conveyor is moving since tracking is not
allowed in Programming state.
Before starting the teching session, the $ARM_DATA[n].CONV_ZERO[conv_idx]
variable has to be properly initialized. The best method is to switch the conveyor off after
the passage through the zero position has been detected and the
Conveyor Tracking (optional feature)
9-7
pr-0-0-gpr_11.fm
00/0607
$ARM_DATA[n].CONV_ZERO[conv_idx] has been set.
Otherwise the user has to measure the distance between the workpiece and the sensor
and then assign the zero position by the CONV_SET_OFST built-in. The built-in has the
following parameters: (dist, conv_num ,<arm>) where dist is the distance(in case of
circular tracking it is calculated along the circumference), conv_num is the conveyor
number and the third optional parameter indicates the arm number.
In Programming state and conveyor tracking enabled, every time a move starts the
position transducer is read and the cartesian positions are updated.
9.7 Tracking Interruption
LOCK statement and some alarms due to the motion stop the execution of the program,
but the robot continues its tracking; this means that the robot moves in order to maintain
held the TCP with respect to the moving truck.
Fatal alarms, HOLD and DRIVES OFF commands stop both the execution of the
program and tracking. An output signal should be issue in order to stop and restart the
conveyor motion.
9.8 Limitations during Conveyor Tracking
All cases of Conveyor Tracking involve a number of limitations:
only Cartesian (linear or circular) trajectories on POSITION type points can be
carried out during tracking;
as joint type movements are not allowed, the recovery trajectories must also be of
the Cartesian type. Therefore, the values of the $RCVR_TYPE variable may be 3,
4, 5 , 6 only;
the ADVANCE clause cannot be used on a movement immediately preceding the
first movement interlocked with the conveyor (engage condition) or the last
(release movement);
it is not possible to check tolerances on the stopping points during tracking as the
movement of the carrier involves continuous movement of the axes of the robot
also during stoppages. Therefore the only permissible value of the $TERM_TYPE
system variable is NOSETTLE;
the values of $BASE and $TOOL variables cannot be modified immediately before
the carrier release movement. $UFRAME can however be modified as required;
a linear trajectory on the fixed positions, i.e. with $CONV_TYPE :=CONV_OFF
must be carried out after any error that causes release of robot trajectory;
it is not possible to restart tracking after a power failure without first of all bringing
the robot to a fixed position (i.e. with $CONV_TYPE :=CONV_OFF).
Conveyor Tracking (optional feature)
9-8
pr-0-0-gpr_11.fm
00/0607
9.9 Use of the Roto-translating Conveyor
Usually, $ARM_DATA[n].CONV_BASE[conv_idx], frame cannot be permanently
calculated at the configuration time, because it depends on the fold upward or downward
direction. Anyway, it is possible to fix some headlines which could be usefeul to
determine it.
The X axis of the base frame must be lined up with the Conveyor motion direction (which
means the knife of the bending-press); the X-Y plane must be orthogonal to the
bending-press motion plane and the origin must be fixed in the maximum opening point
of the bending-press.
If the fold direction of the part is upward, the Y axis must enter the fold motion plane; on
the contrary, it must exit the motion plane.
Tab. 9.1 - Conveyor Tracking System Variables
Name Type Limits Default
$ARM_DATA[arm_num].CONV_ZERO ARRAY OF REAL 0 motor turns
$ARM_DATA[arm_num].CONV_WIN ARRAY [2] OF REAL [0.0,0.0] mm
$ARM_DATA[arm_num].CONV_CNFG ARRAY OF INTEGER [ 0, 16 ] 0
$ARM_DATA[arm_num].CONV_BASE ARRAY OF POSITION POS(0,0,0,0,0,0)
$ARM_DATA[arm_num].CONV_SPD_LIM ARRAY OF REAL 10.0 m/s
$ARM_DATA[arm_num].CONV_ACC_LIM ARRAY OF REAL 2.0 m/s2
$CRNT_DATA[arm_num].CONV_SHIFT ARRAY OF REAL 0 mm
$CRNT_DATA[arm_num].CONV_SPD ARRAY OF REAL 0 m/s
$CRNT_DATA[arm_num].CONV_DIST ARRAY OF INTEGER 0 micron
$CONV_TBL ARRAY [2] OF RECORD
$CONV_TBL[conv_tbl_idx].CT_TX_RATE
REAL 0.0 mm/motor turns
or conveyor
turns/motor turns
$CONV_TBL[conv_tbl_idx].CT_J NT_MAS
K
INTEGER [ 0, 1023 ] 0
$CONV_TBL[conv_tbl_idx].CT_SCC INTEGER [ 0, 2 ] 0
$CONV_TBL[conv_tbl_idx].CT_RES REAL 0 motor turns
$CONV_TBL[conv_tbl_idx].CT_RADIUS REAL 0.0 mm
$ARM_DATA[arm_num].CONV_TYPE
INTEGER [CONV_READ,
CONV_1READ
_2ON]
CONV_OFF
Tab. 9.2 - Conveyor Tracking Built-ins
Built-in name Parameters
CONV_SET_OFST (offset, conv_num <, arm_num>)
Where:
offset is a REAL
conv_num and arm_num are INTEGER
Conveyor Tracking (optional feature)
9-9
pr-0-0-gpr_11.fm
00/0607
The value of $CONV_TBL[i].CT_RADIUS is the robot distance from the fold (in mm);
such a value must be calculated referred to the robot position at the beginning of the
fold, from the sheet point of contact (see Fold beginning position).
Fig. 9.3 - Fold beginning position
1. Bending-press 2. Sheet 3. Robot
9.9.1 Configuration parameters
For a good Conveyor tracking, it is needed to configure the geometrical values of the
puch/forming-die couple which is mounted on the bending-press, producing the fold.
The needed geometrical parameters of the bending-press and the sheet, are shown in
the following Fig. 9.4.
Fig. 9.4 - Graphic representation of the bending-press
1. Bending-press kinfe 2. Folded sheet 3. Non folded sheet 4. Folded forming-die
The needed parameters to properly configure the tracking, are as follows:
$CONV_TBL[i].CT_SHEET_DEPTH =S Sheet depth in mm
$CONV_TBL[i].CT_CAVE_ANGLE =alfa Forming-die cave angle in rad
$CONV_TBL[i].CT_SHOULDER_RADIUS =Rsm Forming-die shoulder radius in mm
$CONV_TBL[i].CT_CAVE_WIDTH =V Forming-die cave width in mm
Conveyor Tracking (optional feature)
9-10
pr-0-0-gpr_11.fm
00/0607
Integrated Conveyor Tracking
10-1
hs-0-0-mot_07.fm
00/0607
10. INTEGRATED CONVEYOR
TRACKING
10.1 Introduction
The service of the Integrated Conveyor Tracking (ICT) is necessary to enable 2 robots
to work simultaneously in cooperation on the same positioner.
10.2 Characteristics
Cooperation is possible between an arm and a positioner (cooperative motion with
auxiliary axes) or between 2 arms (cooperative arms). As already stated, the Integrated
Conveyor Tracking enables 2 robots to both cooperate with the same positioner, even
if in actual fact, only the first arm 'cooperates', while the second arm tracks the target
position of the positioner, as if this were a loop conveyor.
To extend the concept of cooperation with the Integrated Conveyor Tracking
performance, it is necessary to use a standard type C4G Controller coupled with a
Power type C4G: this configuration is necessary to have a single motion planner and the
control of up to 20 axes (2 DSA, multi-machine configuration).
The positioner is to be outfitted as an auxiliary axis of the arm it is to cooperate with, the
second arm can follow the auxiliary axis of the first arm as if this were a loop conveyor
controlled by the C4G (instead of by an external sensor as in the case of the classic
Conveyor Tracking).
It will be possible to define a maximum of two conveyor axes in the same cell.
10.3 Programming
For the programming, the user will have to apply simultaneously all the configuration and
activation rules used for the cooperative motion with the auxiliary axes and for the
circular axis conveyor tracking.
In manual mode, until the activations
The following software OPTIONS are NECESSARY:
Cooperative Motion, for the cooperation of the first robot with the
positioner-auxiliary axis (see Cap.7. - Cooperative Motion (optional feature)).
Conveyor Tracking Motion, for the positioner tracking by the second robot
(See Cap.9. - Conveyor Tracking (optional feature)).
Synchronised Arm Motion, to synchronise the motions of the 2 robots (See
Cap.6. - Synchronous Motion (optional feature)).
Integrated Conveyor Tracking
10-2
hs-0-0-mot_07.fm
00/0607
AUX_COOP( ON, ) and
$ARM_DATA[ n] . CONV_TYPE : = CONV_i ON
are executed, the 2 robots can move separately from the positioner; their POSITIONS
will be defined in the user reference (coinciding with the boundary reference if the user
reference is not declared).
Once the services are activated, the robots will track any positioner movement, and
each will still be able to be moved independently; their POSITIONS will be defined in
relation to the positioner reference (defined by $AUX_BASE for the first robot and by
$CONV_BASE for the second).
To be consistent, both $AUX_BASE and $CONV_BASE have their origin in the rotation
center of the axis, therefore CT_RADIUS value is ignored.
For movement in automatic mode, the user who has to move both the robots in
cooperative mode on the positioner can create a single program in which the 2 robots
use the synchronised motion: the first on XTNDPOS type points (that include the
positioner motion), the second on POSITION type points.
10.4 Example
A cell consisting of 2 robots (for example, 2 NS robots) and a PTDV positioner, for a total
of 15 axes configured as follows: on arm 1 the first NS and the PTDV, on arm 2 the
second NS.
10.4.1 Conveyor configuration
10.4.2 Motion programming
PROGRAM ct l i b NOHOLD
BEGI N
- -
- - Conf i gur e axi s 9 ( f or t he f i r st ar m) as l oop conveyor of t he second ar m
- -
$CONV_TBL[ 1] . CT_J NT_MASK : = 0x100
$CONV_TBL[ 1] . CT_SCC : = 1
$CONV_TBL[ 1] . CT_TX_RATE : = $ARM_DATA[ 1] . TX_RATE[ 9]
$ARM_DATA[ 2] . CONV_SPD_LI M[ 1] : = 2
$ARM_DATA[ 2] . CONV_ACC_LI M[ 1] : = 2
$ARM_DATA[ 2] . CONV_CNFG[ 1] : = 4
$ARM_DATA[ 2] . CONV_TYPE : = CONV_OFF
END ct l i b
PROGRAM i ct _st ep3 EZ
VAR pnt 0008p, pnt 0009p, pnt 0010p : POSI TI ON
pnt 0003x, pnt 0006x, pnt 0007x, pnt 0008x : XTNDPOS FOR ARM[ 1]
pnt 0001x, x1, x2, x3 : XTNDPOS FOR ARM[ 1]
pnt 0001p, pnt 0004p, pnt 0005p, pnt 0007p : POSI TI ON
Integrated Conveyor Tracking
10-3
hs-0-0-mot_07.fm
00/0607
BEGI N
- - Def i ni t i on of t he TOOL, BASE, USER FRAME of t he 2 NS r obot s
$ARM_DATA[ 1] . TOOL : =
POS( 250. 381, 1. 8329999, 174. 686, - 0. 032000002, 110. 556, 179. 60001, ' ' )
$ARM_DATA[ 2] . TOOL : =
POS( 250. 381, 1. 8329999, 174. 686, - 0. 032000002, 110. 556, 179. 60001, ' ' )
$ARM_DATA[ 1] . BASE : = POS( 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, ' ' )
$ARM_DATA[ 2] . BASE : = POS( 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, ' ' )
$ARM_DATA[ 1] . UFRAME : = POS( 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, ' ' )
$ARM_DATA[ 2] . UFRAME : = POS( 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, ' ' )

- - Cooper at i ve Base
$ARM_DATA[ 1] . AUX_BASE[ 3] : = pnt 0001p : POS( 0, 0, 0, 0, 180, 180, ' ' )
- - Conveyor Base
$ARM_DATA[ 2] . CONV_BASE[ 1] : = pnt 0004p : POS( 0, 0, 0, 0, 180, - 60, ' ' )

- - Reset cooper at i ve mot i on
AUX_COOP( OFF, 9, 1)

- - Set wi ndow conveyor
$ARM_DATA[ 2] . CONV_WI N[ 1] : = - 200
$ARM_DATA[ 2] . CONV_WI N[ 2] : = 200
- - Reset conveyor mot i on
$ARM_DATA[ 2] . CONV_TYPE : = CONV_OFF
MOVE ARM[ 2] LI NEAR RELATI VE VEC( 0, 0, 1) I N BASE

- - Li f t ed appr oach Move
MOVE ARM[ 1] TO pnt 0001x
MOVE ARM[ 2] TO pnt 0005p

- - Enabl e cooper at i ve mot i on
AUX_COOP( ON, 9, 1)
MOVE ARM[ 1] LI NEAR RELATI VE VEC( 0, 0, 1) I N UFRAME
- - Enabl e conveyor
$ARM_DATA[ 2] . CONV_TYPE : = CONV_1ON
MOVE ARM[ 2] LI NEAR RELATI VE VEC( 0, 0, 1) I N BASE

- - Set auxi l i ar y axi s val ues
x1. POS : = ARM_POS( 1)
x1. AUX[ 1] : = 0
x1. AUX[ 2] : = 0
x1. AUX[ 3] : = 25
x2. POS : = ARM_POS( 1)
x2. AUX[ 3] : = 0
x2. AUX[ 1] : = 0
x2. AUX[ 2] : = 0
x3. POS : = ARM_POS( 1)
x3. AUX[ 1] : = 0
x3. AUX[ 2] : = 0
x3. AUX[ 3] : = - 10
Integrated Conveyor Tracking
10-4
hs-0-0-mot_07.fm
00/0607
CYCLE
- - Cooper at i ve Mot i on act i vat i on
AUX_COOP( ON, 9, 1)
- - Conveyor Tr acki ng act i vat i on
$ARM_DATA[ 2] . CONV_TYPE : = CONV_1ON
- - Conveyor coupl i ng move
MOVE ARM[ 2] LI NEAR RELATI VE VEC( 0, 0, 1) I N BASE
- - Mot i on cont r ol l ed by posi t i oner onl y, t he 2 r obot s f ol l ow
DELAY 1000
MOVE ARM[ 1] LI NEAR TO x1
DELAY 1000
MOVE ARM[ 1] LI NEAR TO x2
DELAY 1000
MOVE ARM[ 1] LI NEAR TO x3
DELAY 1000
- - Synchr oni sed and cooper at i ve mot i on of t he 2 r obot s on posi t i oner i n mot i on
MOVE ARM[ 1] LI NEAR TO pnt 0003x SYNCMOVE ARM[ 2] LI NEAR TO pnt 0007p
MOVE ARM[ 1] LI NEAR TO pnt 0006x SYNCMOVE ARM[ 2] LI NEAR TO pnt 0008p
MOVE ARM[ 1] LI NEAR TO pnt 0007x SYNCMOVE ARM[ 2] LI NEAR TO pnt 0009p
MOVE ARM[ 1] LI NEAR TO pnt 0008x SYNCMOVE ARM[ 2] LI NEAR TO pnt 0010p
- - End of cooper at i ve mot i on and conveyor t r acki ng
AUX_COOP( OFF, 9, 1)
$ARM_DATA[ 2] . CONV_TYPE : = CONV_OFF
- - Conveyor r el ease move
MOVE ARM[ 2] LI NEAR RELATI VE VEC( 0, 0, 1) I N BASE
- - 2 r obot s move separ at el y t o i dl e posi t i on
MOVE ARM[ 1] TO pnt 0001x
MOVE ARM[ 2] TO pnt 0005p
END i ct _st ep3
Motion with Weaving (optional feature)
11-1
pr-0-0-gpr_09.fm
00/0607
11. MOTION WITH WEAVING
(OPTIONAL FEATURE)
Weaving is an oscillating motion superimposed on a Cartesian trajectory. It is useful for
arc-welding applications and some gluing and sealing applications. Weaving is a
method used to distribute material in gaps with large cross sections relative to the
material bead.
Weaving can be superimposed on any Cartesian motion (either linear or circular) or
multiple motions connected in fly. The shape of the weaving pattern is defined by a set
of parameters (parametric weaving). Two modes of weaving are available, cartesian
weaving and joint weaving.
The subjects described in this chapter are the following :
Weaving Mode
Weaving Activation
Weaving Parameters
Stopping Motions with Weaving
Programming Weaving
Weaving without Arm motion
11.1 Weaving Mode
The weaving mode can be selected through the $WEAVE_TYPE variable Leaving this
variable set at default value zero, cartesian weaving is selected. In this mode, weaving
is defined relative to a frame determined by the trajectory itself and is not affected by
changes in tool orientation along the trajectory. If $WEAVE_TYPE is assigned a value
between 1 and 10, the weaving selected is joint mode. In this case, the value of the
system variable indicates the axis on which the weaving is done and the weaving
direction depends on the position of all axes. J oint weaving allows higher weaving
frequencies than cartesian weaving.
11.2 Weaving Activation
Weaving is activated and deactivated using the predefined variable $WEAVE_NUM.
This variable contains the number of the active weave table. The default value of 0
means that weaving is disabled.
Weaving is activated by simply assigning the index number of the desired weave table
to $WEAVE_NUM. All succeeding Cartesian moves will be made using the weaving
In order to retrieve Comau Options Codes, please refer to C4G Control Unit
Technical Specifications Manual, chapter Software Options.
Motion with Weaving (optional feature)
11-2
pr-0-0-gpr_09.fm
00/0607
parameters in $WEAVE_TBL[$WEAVE_NUM].
It is possible to continue weaving during a series of fly motions or along a path motion.
However, weaving will only occur during the Cartesian motions or Cartesian path
segments. If a series of fly motions or a path includes a joint interpolated motion,
weaving will stop during the joint motion and then start again with the next Cartesian
motion or path segment.
The first move with weaving is the movement after a weaving stop. A weaving stop can
occur if the user disables it expressly, or if the move is a joint move. or if two moves with
weaving are not linked with a continuous motion (fly). This principle is applied not only
to singular motions, but also in case of path segments (PATH).
11.3 Weaving Parameters
$WEAVE_TBL predefined variable is used to define all the weaving characteristics.
$WEAVE_TBL is an array of records that allows a user to define up to 10 different weave
tables. The fields of $WEAVE_TBL are defined as follows:
$WEAVE_MODALITY the weaving wave form generation modality. It is an
INTEGER with possible values 0,1 and 2 :
$WEAVE_MODALITY=0 - the wave form is generated by the transverse
speed;
$WEAVE_MODALITY=1 - the wave form is generated by the wavelength. In
this case the wave form does not change as the overrides related to the feed
speed vary;
$WEAVE_MODALITY=2 - the wave form is generated with 4 different
transverse speeds, to produce asymmetrical profiles.
$WV_LENGTH_WAVE - is an INTEGER (from 0 to 10,000 mm) and represents the
wave length in the weaving form;
two REAL fields define the left and right amplitudes:
$WEAVE_TBL[n].WV_LEFT_AMP defines the left amplitude (0 - 20),
$WEAVE_TBL[n].WV_RIGHT_AMP defines the right amplitude (0 - 20); four
INTEGER fields define the hold time:
$WEAVE_TBL[n].WV_LEFT_DWL defines the dwell time (in ms) on the left;
if $WEAVE_MODALITY=1 it defines the distance covered (in mm) on the left
along the path. Limits: from 0 to 10,000;
$WEAVE_TBL[n].WV_CNTR_DWL defines the dwell time (in ms) in the
centre; if $WEAVE_MODALITY=1 it defines the distance covered (in mm) at
the centre along the path. Limits: from 0 to 10,000;
$WEAVE_TBL[n].WV_RIGHT_DWL defines the dwell time (in ms) on the
right; if $WEAVE_MODALITY=1 it defines the distance covered (in mm) on
the right along the path. Limits: from 0 to 10,000;
$WEAVE_TBL[n].WV_END_DWL defines the dwell time (in ms) at the end of
the move; if $WEAVE_MODALITY=1 it defines the distance covered (in mm)
at the end of the move, along the path. Limits: from 0 to 10.000;
a BOOLEAN field controls the rounding or smoothness of corners of the wave
shape:
$WEAVE_TBL[n].WV_SMOOTH (see explanation below);
a REAL field controls the transverse speed:
$WEAVE_TBL[n].WV_TRV_SPD (recommended 0.035 m/sec);
4 REAL fields for the 4 transverse speeds that are used in modality 2:
Motion with Weaving (optional feature)
11-3
pr-0-0-gpr_09.fm
00/0607
$WEAVE_TBL[ n] . WV_TRV_SPD_PHASE[ m] ; ( con 1<=m<=4)
a REAL field defines the weave plane and weave direction (see explanation
below):
$WEAVE_TBL[n].WV_PLANE (from -180 to +180 degrees);
an INTEGER field defines the weave amplification factor (%):
$WEAVE_TBL[n].WV_AMP_PER (from 0% to 1000%);
a BOOLEAN field indicates that the acceleration and deceleration characteristics
are used
$WEAVE_TBL[n].WV_SPD_PROFILE; using this function the transverse speeds
are reached with a ramp, so as to remain within the acceleration/deceleration limits
of the axis involved in the weaving, for joints weave; or within Cartesian
acceleration/deceleration limits for Cartesian weave. Furthermore, a test is made
on the maximum speed that can be reached.
Index n varies from 1 to 10 and the user can change a range of the 10 elements of the
table at any time
Parametric weaving is defined by three indications:
Wave Shape
Weave Plane (angle of weaving plane)
Weave Amplification (used to vary the weaving amplitude)
11.3.1 Wave Shape
The basic weave pattern is a trapezoidal pattern. The units of measurement of some
fields of $WEAVE_TBL are dependent upon the type of weaving selected. If cartesian
weaving is being used, $WV_LEFT_AMP and $WV_RIGHT_AMP are expressed in
millimeters; in the case of joint weaving these parameters are expressed in degrees or
millimeters depending on if the selected axis is rotational (degrees) or translational
(mm). $WV_TRV_SPD is expressed in meters/second when using cartesian weaving,
in radians/sec for a rotational axis with joint weaving, and in meters/sec for a
translational axis with joint weaving.
If WEAVE_MODALITY=0,the wave is described by the transverse speed, the amplitude,
the dwell times, and the speed along the trajectory. The frequency of the pattern is fixed
by the first 3 of these parameters. The motion speed along the trajectory ($LIN_SPD)
does not affect frequency, but rather how much the pattern is stretched. Fig. 11.1
- Weave Parameters - A shows the basic shape and defines the various dwell times.
Also shows how the speed and slope are calculated.
If WEAVE_MODALITY=1, the wavelength (and therefore the frequency) are maintained
as the speed varies; the overrides do not influence the wave form.
If WEAVE_MODALITY=2, the wave form is generated with 4 different transverse
speeds. The profiles are asymmetric.
Motion with Weaving (optional feature)
11-4
pr-0-0-gpr_09.fm
00/0607
Fig. 11.1 - Weave Parameters - A
Note that the following formula is used for transverse speed calculation
Left amplitude
Transverse speed =----------------------------
ts
a. Direction of weaving
b. Time
1. ts[1]
2. Left dwell time
3. ts[2]
4. Central dwell time
5. ts[3]
6. Right dwell time
7. ts[4]
8. Final dwell time
9. Left amplitude
10. Right amplitude
Meaning of the terms ts[n] (ramp up or down times), according to the weaving
modality:
Modality 0 - ts times are all equal and are generated to reach a transverse
speed $weave_tbl[n].wv_trv_spd;
Modality 1 - the ts times are all equal and are generated to create the weaving
period according to the programmed wave length;
Modality 2 - The ts[n] times are generated to reach the respective transverse
speeds $weave_tbl[n].wv_trv_spd_phase[n].
Motion with Weaving (optional feature)
11-5
pr-0-0-gpr_09.fm
00/0607
Fig. 11.2 - WeaveParameters - B
1. Weaving direction
2. Path
3. Transverse speed
4. Torch speed =Linear speed
5. Torch speed =Resulting speed
6. Linear speed
The amplitude, dwell, smoothness, and speed fields will take affect immediately after the
change (even during a weave motion). The direction and amplification factor will take
affect only on the first move with weaving.
When the left and right dwells are set to 0, a triangular or sawtooth wave shape results.
The sharp peaks of the sawtooth shape can be rounded to produce a sinusoid-like
shape by setting the smoothing field to TRUE. Fig. 11.3 - Weave waves shows the
different shapes that can be achieved using the $WEAVE_TBL settings.
Fig. 11.3 - Weave waves
1. Saw tooth, not chamfered
2. Saw tooth, chamfered
3. Trapezoidal (left and right dwell)
4. Chamfering variation during motion, with central dwell time
5. Different left and right amplitudes.
The weave wave frequency, according to the modality used, is calculated in one of these
ways:
modality 0
Motion with Weaving (optional feature)
11-6
pr-0-0-gpr_09.fm
00/0607
modality 2
where:
dwell sum =left dwell +right dwell +2 * center dwell (ms)
The maximum frequency is dependent on the mechanical design of the arm, but the
weave shape will match the theoretical up to about 5 Hz (cartesian weaving) or 8 Hz
(joint weaving) on arms intended for arc welding.
11.3.2 Weave Plane
Weave plane only applies to cartesian weaving and is established as explained below.
At the beginning of the first move with weaving, the approach vector of the tool and the
tangent to the move trajectory establish a plane, called the torch plane. A plane called
the zero plane is defined perpendicular to the torch plane and contains the trajectory. (If
the motion is a straight line, then the tangent to the trajectory is the straight line. If the
motion is a circle, then the tangent to the trajectory is the tangent to the circle at its start
point). An error will be generated (37111 tool collinear with weave trajectory) if the
torch approach vector is in the same direction as the intended trajectory.
The weave plane is established by rotating from the zero plane about the trajectory
tangent by the rotation angle specified in $WEAVE_TBL[n].WV_PLANE. A positive
angle is in the direction established using the left-hand-rule with respect to the trajectory
direction. Fig. 11.4 - Weave Plan shows such a procedure.
Motion with Weaving (optional feature)
11-7
pr-0-0-gpr_09.fm
00/0607
Fig. 11.4 - Weave Plan
1. Torch plane
2. Path
3. Weaving plane angle
4. Approach vector (along Z Tool)
5. Weaving plane
6. Zero plane
7. Weaving plane angle
8. Zero plane
9. Weaving plane
10. Approach vector (along Z Tool)
Weaving can be executed between two trajectories connected in fly; in this case, the
direction of weaving on the second trajectory is recalculated maintaining the angle of
inclination in relation to the plane of the two trajectories. Weaving will change from one
direction to another without interruption. This capability promotes very simple
programming of complex paths. The angle must be assigned only at the start of the first
movement with weaving and the control will automatically calculate the direction of
subsequent movements, Note that, on the second trajectory, the angle between the
plane of the torch and the direction of weaving will no longer be equal to the angle
indicated in $WEAVE_TBL[n].WV_PLANE; the control will refer to this angle only for the
first movement with weaving.
The trajectory weaving linked in fly can be improved in some cases by using the
FLY_CART mode. The weaving direction continuously evolves during fly, without being
interrupted when passing from one motion segment to another. (par. 5.10.2.2
FLY_CART (Controller Aided Resolved Trajectory) a pag. 5-31) section for futher
details.
Motion with Weaving (optional feature)
11-8
pr-0-0-gpr_09.fm
00/0607
Fig. 11.5 - Weaving with fly
1. Start point
2. Weaving plane angle=0
For a circular motion, the weave plane is continuously evaluated relative to the path, so
that the weave direction is always perpendicular to the path. If the weave plane is not
parallel to the plane of the circle, the weave plane will be on the frustum of a cone as
shown in Fig. 11.6 - Circular Weaving.
Fig. 11.6 - Circular Weaving
1. Initial weaving direction
2. Start point
3. Final weaving direction
4. Final point
5. Centre of circumference
11.3.3 Weave Amplification
Weave amplification permits weaving to be performed on V-grooves or flat butt welds
Motion with Weaving (optional feature)
11-9
pr-0-0-gpr_09.fm
00/0607
where the gap between parts varies from beginning to end because of imperfect
alignment.
The weave amplification factor in $WEAVE_TBL[n].WV_AMP_PER is used to grow or
shrink the weave amplitude linearly along the motion. The start of the move is
considered 100%. The value from $WEAVE_TBL determines the percentage at the end
of the move.
If a series of moves is issued in fly or a path is executed, the amplitude corresponding
to 100% is determined at the first move with weaving. Then at the beginning of every
succeeding move, the percentage starts the same as the end of the previous move, and
$WEAVE_TBL[n].WV_AMP_PER is read to determine the percentage at the end of the
move. Thus, a series of moves can be used to weld a long groove or seam without
stopping, and the amplification will change continuously from the start of the first move
to the end of the last move. (Note that the $WEAVE_TBL[n].WV_AMP_PER variable is
read each move, but the definition of 100% is only determined at the first move with
weaving).
Fig. 11.7 - Weave amp illustrates the weave amplification feature.
Fig. 11.7 - Weave amp
1. Final amplitude
2. Final point
3. Start point
4. Initial amplitude
Motion with Weaving (optional feature)
11-10
pr-0-0-gpr_09.fm
00/0607
1. Welded part
2. First move in fly
3. Second move in fly
4. Welding
5. Fly move node
11.4 Stopping Motions with Weaving
When movement stops at the last position of a move or because an operator has
pressed HOLD, the tool can be far away from the original trajectory because of weaving.
In this case, the C4G Controller will bring the torch to the end position before stopping.
In emergency stop or power failure cases, the arm stops as fast as possible, which could
be far from the original trajectory. When power is restored and pressed, trajectory
recovery will occur before the weaving motion resumes.
Fig. 11.8 - Weave stop illustrates these cases.
Motion with Weaving (optional feature)
11-11
pr-0-0-gpr_09.fm
00/0607
Fig. 11.8 - Weave stop
1. System in Hold state
2. Stop point
3. Original path
4. Emergency stop or Power failure
5. Path reset
6. Original path
11.5 Programming Weaving
Weaving is done by first assigning weave table values and then activating weaving by
selecting an appropriate index into the table by assigning it to $WEAVE_NUM.
$WEAVE_NUM can also be used in a WITH clause. In that case the $WEAVE_NUM
applies only to that motion. If $WEAVE_TYPE is changed during fly, the error (37158)
mismatch in fly $WEAVE_TYPE will be generated.
$WV_AMP_PER can also be used in a WITH clause. The parent structure name and
index ($WEAVE_TBL[n]) is not needed to assign a value to $WV_AMP_PER; the index
previously assigned to $WEAVE_NUM will apply.
It is not possible to switch the active weave table during a move or path segment, as the
same table is used for the entire segment or move. However, the weave shape can be
changed during a motion by changing the parameters of the active table. This can be
done either by using a CONDITION statement or by changing the
$WEAVE_TBL[$WEAVE_NUM] fields directly.
The following table is a summary of the predefined variables for the Weaving (see.
Tab. 11.1).
Motion with Weaving (optional feature)
11-12
pr-0-0-gpr_09.fm
00/0607
(*) Se $WEAVE_MODALITY=0, represents mm
Se $WEAVE_MODALITY=1, represents ms
11.6 Weaving without Arm motion
This kind of weaving (provided since system software version 3.10) allows to weld
without a programmed Arm motion: the target is to be able to weave the Arm while the
being welded part is moved by another Arm.
This kind of weaving is similar to the previously described one; the differences are
explained in the following sections.
11.6.1 Mode
The weaving without Arm motion mode is activated by means of
$CRNT_DATA[num_arm].WEAVE_TYPE_NOMOT predefined variable which has got
the same functionalities as described in par. 11.1 Weaving Mode a pag. 11-1: the only
Tab. 11.1 - Predefined variable for Weaving
Nome Tipo Limiti Default WITH
$WEAVE_NUM INTEGER [ 0, 10 ] UNINIT YES
$WEAVE_MODALITY INTEGER [ 0, 2 ] 0 YES
$WV_LENGTH_WAVE INTEGER [ 0, 10000 ] 0 NO
$WEAVE_TYPE INTEGER [ 0, 10 ] UNINIT YES
$WEAVE_TBL ARRAY
[$NUM_WEAVES]
OF RECORD
NO
$WEAVE_TBL[idx].WV_PLANE REAL [-180, +180]
deg
0.0 NO
$WEAVE_TBL[idx].WV_AMP_PER INTEGER [ 0, 1000 ] % 100 % YES
$WEAVE_TBL[idx].WV_RIGHT_AMP REAL [0, 20] mm o
deg
0,0 NO
$WEAVE_TBL[idx].WV_LEFT_AMP REAL [0, 20] mm o
deg
0.0 NO
$WEAVE_TBL[idx].WV_CNTR_DWL (*) INTEGER [0, 10000] mm
o ms
0 NO
$WEAVE_TBL[idx].WV_RIGHT_DWL (*) INTEGER [0, 10000] mm
o ms
0 NO
$WEAVE_TBL[idx].WV_LEFT_DWL (*) INTEGER [0, 10000] mm
o ms
0 NO
$WEAVE_TBL[n].WV_END_DWL INTEGER [0, 10000] mm
o ms
0 NO
$WEAVE_TBL[idx].WV_SMOOTH BOOLEAN FALSE NO
$WEAVE_TBL[n]WV_TRV_SPD REAL 0 NO
$WEAVE_TBL[n]WV_TRV_SPD_PHASE REAL 0 NO
$WEAVE_TBL[n]WV_SPD_PROFILE BOOLEAN FALSE NO
$NUM_WEAVES INTEGER [ 0, 16 ] 10 NO
Motion with Weaving (optional feature)
11-13
pr-0-0-gpr_09.fm
00/0607
difference is that such a mode is performed without a motion embedded to the weaving.
11.6.2 Activation
For this functionality too, the activation is performed by means of defining the weave
table; it is anyway needed to use the predefined variable
$CRNT_DATA[ 2] . WEAVE_NUM_NOMOT
which specifies that the weaving functionality will be performed without Arm motion.
The weave tables are exactely the same as for the weaving with Arm motion. In such a
way, if in a PDL2 program the user needs to perform both weaving with and without Arm
motion, the same information can be used.
11.6.3 Parameters
The used parameters belong to the same group described in the previous I parametri
utilizzati appartengono allo stesso insieme introdotto nel par. 11.3 Weaving Parameters
a pag. 11-2.
Anyway, there are some features which make a no-sense for this functionality: e.g.
mode 1 cannot be selected which involves a wave shape related to the wavelength,
because the Arm does not move.
11.6.4 Example - Using the weaving without Arm motion
To better understand how this kind of weaving does work and how to use it, an example
is provided: lets suppose that Arm 2 must execute a weaving operation without motion,
Arm 1 moves the part to be welded, and the required time to perform the welding
operation is 3 seconds. Note that it is needed to know the welding time in order to weld.
a. definition of a suitable weave table (e.g. table 1)
$WEAVE_TBL[ 1] . WV_LEFT_AMP : = 5
$WEAVE_TBL[ 1] . WV_RI GHT_AMP : = 5
$WEAVE_TBL[ 1] . WV_LEFT_DWL : = 0
$WEAVE_TBL[ 1] . WV_CNTR_DWL : = 0
$WEAVE_TBL[ 1] . WV_RI GHT_DWL : = 0
$WEAVE_TBL[ 1] . WV_SMOOTH : = TRUE
$WEAVE_TBL[ 1] . WV_TRV_SPD : = 0. 035
$WEAVE_TBL[ 1] . WV_PLANE : = 0
$WEAVE_TBL[ 1] . WV_AMP_PER : = 100
b. setup of the following features:
the Arm must not weave,
the Arm must use 0 mode which achieves a wave shape related to the
transverse speed,
the weaving is performed in cartesian (WEAVE_TYPE_NOMOT :=0):
$CRNT_DATA[ 2] . WEAVE_NUM_NOMOT : = 0
$CRNT_DATA[ 2] . WEAVE_MODALI TY_NOMOT : = 0
$CRNT_DATA[ 2] . WEAVE_TYPE_NOMOT : = 0
Motion with Weaving (optional feature)
11-14
pr-0-0-gpr_09.fm
00/0607
c. speeds definition
$SPD_OPT : = SPD_LI N
$LI N_SPD : = 0. 050000001
d. Arm motion, to go to the position where Arm 2 is supposed to weld
MOVE LI NEAR TO p1
e. weave on p1 position, for the required time (3 s).
$CRNT_DATA[ 2] . WEAVE_NUM_NOMOT : = 1
DELAY 3000
$CRNT_DATA[ 2] . WEAVE_NUM_NOMOT : = 0
The statement $CRNT_DATA[2].WEAVE_NUM_NOMOT :=0
disables weaving after 3 seconds, in order to allow the Arm to continue its working
motions.
Path Governor (optional)
12-1
hs-0-0-mot_05.fm
00/0607
12. PATH GOVERNOR (OPTIONAL)
12.1 Introduction
The Path Governor is a software option to obtain very accurate Cartesian, circular
and/or linear moves, reducing the path error.
It can be applied to any type of machine since it is based on the ACTUAL behaviour of
the robot. It can be executed for all the MOVE instructions, or if preferred only for some
of them.
Enable Path Governor
Disable Path Governor
12.2 Enable Path Governor
The user can enable the use of the Path Governor algorithm by a simple PDL2
assignment:
$SPD_OPT:=SPD_PGOV
Having enabled the Path Governor, the user has to set the following predefined
variables :
$LIN_SPD - maximum speed value to execute the path
3 predefined variables that indicate the precision:
In order to retrieve Comau Options Codes, please refer to C4G Control Unit
Technical Specifications Manual, chapter Software Options.
This function has to be used when MAXIMUM ACCURACY is the priority.
If instead the priority is to obtain robot MAXIMUM SPEED, it is necessary to use
the SMARTMOVE4 (optional)
Important note: greater path accuracy is obtained accepting lower performance
regarding speed, since the enabling of the Path Governor increases the cycle
time, if $PGOV_MAX_SPD_REDUCTION is not zero.
Therefore, according to the application to be executed, the user will have to find
the compromise between reduction in Cartesian speed and increase in cycle
time.
The Path Governor is enabled ONLY in Local Automatic status (status selector
switch on AUTO).
Path Governor (optional)
12-2
hs-0-0-mot_05.fm
00/0607
$PGOV_ACCURACY - maximum Cartesian error (in mm) allowed during the
execution of the required Cartesian path (with a tolerance of approx. 0.5mm)
$PGOV_ORNT_PER - indicates the geometry error percentage to be taken
into consideration in the execution of the path. This value can be first set at
0%, then later, if the geometry error is still high, it can be increased
$PGOV_MAX_SPD_REDUCTION - the accepted Cartesian speed reduction
percentage to obtain the required path precision (limits: 0..95).
These predefined variables can be set once for all at the beginning of the motion
program, or also from outside, or they can have different values for each Cartesian
MOVE.
The $PGOV_MAX_SPD_REDUCTION predefined variable is the variable that can have
enormous influence on whether or not the required precision is obtained. In fact, setting
a zero valve will not give any improvement in the path execution in relation to the same
move with the Path Governor disabled.
Furthermore, if the allowed speed reduction is not found adequate for the precision
required in $PGOV_ACCURACY, a Cartesian speed value will be seen that is referred
to a value equal to:
and, as a consequence, the error in the path could be greater than that required.
It is to be noted that, with the Path Governor enabled, the target speed profile will not be
trapezoidal, except in cases of saturation, but will have a speed trend that very similar
to the example shown in Fig. 12.1, where the result obtained during a Cartesian MOVE
is compared with the Path Governor Enabled and Disabled.
Path Governor (optional)
12-3
hs-0-0-mot_05.fm
00/0607
Fig. 12.1 - Cartesian Speed profile with Path Governor
enabled/disabled
As can be seen in Fig. 12.1, with the Path Governor, the maximum speed value set is
not necessarily reached, but there is a speed modulation during the motion according to
the Cartesian error that is taking place.
12.3 Disable Path Governor
There are two ways the user can disable the Path Governor:
Assign a value that is not SPD_PGOV to the predefined variable $SPD_OPT, or
Assign a zero (0) value to the predefined variable
$PGOV_MAX_SPD_REDUCTION.
Path Governor (optional)
12-4
hs-0-0-mot_05.fm
00/0607
SMARTMOVE4 (optional)
13-1
hs-0-0-mot_06.fm
00/0607
13. SMARTMOVE4 (OPTIONAL)
Description
J erk Limitation
Cartesian Motions
13.1 Description
It is an algorithm that can be enabled as a software option to optimise the execution
time of joint AND/OR CARTESIAN motionS. When SmartMove4 functionality is
active, all joint motions are automatically executed using such an algorithm. As far as
executing Cartesian motions, please refer to par. 13.3 Cartesian Motions a pag. 13-2.
By means of the robot dynamic model on all 6 axes, through which the inertia, frictions,
centrifugal and coriolis torques can be determined according to the robot posture and
the load conveyed, the robot motion is planned in the joints space fully exploiting the
torque and speed characteristics made available by the actuators that handle the joints,
so as to have at least one axis with maximum torque.
To optimise the results of the algorithm and avoid excessive torque requirements on
axes in motion, it is fundamental to declare the load data correctly, possibly using the
Payload identification (optional function) procedure.
The tolerance between the current predicted by the dynamic model and the actual
current of each individual axis can be configured through the system variables
$ARM_DATA[num_arm].SM4_SAT_SCALE[num_axis].
Fig. 13.1 shows a comparison between two speed profiles, without and with the
SmartMove4 algorithm.
In order to retrieve Comau Options Codes, please refer to C4G Control Unit
Technical Specifications Manual, chapter Software Options.
This function has to be used when robot MINIMUM CYCLE TIME is the priority.
If instead the priority is to obtain robot MAXIMUM ACCURACY, it is necessary to
use the Path Governor (optional)
It is recommended to reduce such tolerances, because they are directly related to
the stress passed by the reducers.
SMARTMOVE4 (optional)
13-2
hs-0-0-mot_06.fm
00/0607
Fig. 13.1 - SmartMove4 - Comparison
Spd - Speed
Tr - Time reduction
13.2 Jerk Limitation
It is an algorithm to limit the dynamic over-stress, avoiding moves, especially short
moves, with acceleration variations that limit the joints oscillation.
The J erk limitation is incorporated in SmartMove4 and automatically manages the
J erk value to be used for each move.
However, if, for the particular application to be executed, the moves cause too much
stress, or on the contrary a reduction of the cycle time is preferred, to the detriment of
the stress, it is possible to ask COMAU to change the J erk limitations to suit the specific
requirements.
13.3 Cartesian Motions
Unlike joint motions (MOVE J OINT), to perform cartesian motions (either LINEAR or
CIRCULAR) it is needed to set the following $SPD_OPT value:
$SPD_OPT := SPD_SM4C
SmartMove4 algorithm will automatically calculate the maximum TCP acceleration and
speed values, depending on the specified payload, on the operating zone and on the
axes configuration.
Flow Modulate Algorithm
14-1
pr-0-0-gpr_12.fm
00/0607
14. FLOW MODULATE
ALGORITHM
This service, used in applications such as Cosmetic Sealing and Glueing, modulates
the flow of the material to be delivered during the part machining, according to the speed
of the TCP (Tool Center Point).
The delivery device, according to the voltage set, delivers a certain material .
The material dispensing machine defines the maximum voltage value it can handle.
The voltage to be delivered is passed from the C4G each time by a predefined $WORD
variable. Maximum value allowed is 65535.
If, for example, the maximum voltage value that can be delivered is 10 Volt and the
$WORD is set at 65535 (maximum $WORD value), this means that the machine will
apply the maximum voltage (10 Volt ) for the material delivery.
Certain parameters have to be set to define the modulation functioning.
These parameters are kept in the predefined variable $FLOW_TBL (2 elements array);
the values are set by the motion parameters, with the following fields:
$FW_ARM (integer): arm to which this algorithm is applied.
$FW_AXIS (integer): axis to which this algorithm is applied ; only to be specified
when $FW_VAR is set at 2.
$FW_CNVRSN (real): conversion factor to be applied to calculate the flow to be
delivered.
This conversion value can be modified during the algorithm operation.
$FW_VAR (integer): INTEGER. Type of variable to be operated on. If set at 1 the
flow modulation algorithm is applied to $ARM_VEL /cosmetic sealing); if set at 2
the flow modulation algorithm is applied to $RAD_VEL (glueing).
$FW_SPD_LIM (2 real array ): indicates the minimum and maximum speed limits
over which the flow modulation algorithm will apply the nearest limit.
$FW_FLOW_LIM (2 integer array ): indicates the minimum and maximum flow
limits over which the modulation algorithm will apply the nearest limit .
$FW_ENBL (boolean): algorithm state indicator - enabled or disabled.
$FW_START (boolean): indicates the time interval (in milliseconds) between the
speed sample acquisition (immediately following the call to FLOW_MOD_ON) and
the data writing on the analog port indicated in the call to FLOW_MOD_ON.
The formula that determines the conversion factor calculation is based on the maximum
speed that is intended to be used for the robot and the maximum applicable voltage in
bits. These values are defined during the initial configuration when setting the
$FLOW_TBL fields.
Flow Modulate Algorithm
14-2
pr-0-0-gpr_12.fm
00/0607
Example:
The voltage, in bits, is determined by the formula:
The voltage value is read by the machine that delivers the material on an integer port,
usually a $WORD, defined during the algorithm enabling; to enable the algorithm, the
FLOW_MOD_ON built-in routine is used , with the call:
FLOW_MOD_ON (<analog_port>, <flow_table_index>)
where:
<port>is to be INTEGER type. For example: $WORD.
<flow_table_index>where the type of INTEGER is the $FLOW_TBL index .
Possible values: 1 or 2.
Obviously there is also a built-in routine for disabling, its call is:
FLOW_MOD_OFF (<flow_table_index>)
<flow_table_index>INTEGER. The $FLOW_TBL index. Possible values: 1 or 2.
The program that calls the FLOW_MOD_ON on a certain index must be the same as
that which calls FLOW_MOD_OFF on that index.
When the program is deactivated the table is automatically released (implicit
FLOW_MOD_OFF ).
Flow Modulate Algorithm
14-3
pr-0-0-gpr_12.fm
00/0607
Fig. 14.1 - Delivery voltage
1. Delivery flow
2. Conversion factor
y Voltage (V) to be delivered by the dispensing machine (written in the analog port passed to
FLOW_MOD_ON)
x TCP speed ($ARM_VEL or $RAD_VEL)
Flow Modulate Algorithm
14-4
pr-0-0-gpr_12.fm
00/0607
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-1
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
15. PRESUPPOSITIONS FOR SMART
ROBOT PROGRAMMING
15.1 Introduction
Current chapter summarizes further information related to the use of COMAU robots.
They are classified as being with spherical wrist or with non-spherical wrist.
COMAU robots which are involved in current chapter are shown in the following
Tab. 15.1 - Involved Robot models:
It refers to System Software 1.0 and following versions.
The following topics are fully described:
Glossary
Offset algorithm with Dynamic Model
Kinematic offset algorithm (optional feature)
Moving through axis 5 singularities
Robots without compensation (effect of the inverse kinematics)
Programming rules for non-spherical wrist robots (SMART NH4)
Appendix (working range pictures for SMART NH4 models)
The list of error messages is reported and the meaning is explained. Some notes are
also given about mapping between C4G error messages and RRS (Robot Realistic
Simulation) ones that are sent by Robcad while simulating a program. This is useful
because RRS specification doesn't include messages enough to describe all the
situations.
Tab. 15.1 - Involved Robot models
Robot Spherical wrist Non-spherical wrist
SMART NH1 X
SMART NH2 X
SMART NH3 X
SMART NH4 X
SMART NS X
SMART NM X X
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-2
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
15.2 Glossary
TCP - Tool Center Point. It is the point at the end of the tool and it is geometrically
described by the $TOOL system variable or by the Tool tables in EZ environment. It can
be local or remote. For SMART NH4(L) robot the TCP position, with reference to the
robot axes, causes some limitations to the robot working area.
WCP - Wrist Center Point. For spherical wrist robots, WCP is the intersection point
between joint 5 and joint 6; for SMART NH4 robots (non-spherical wrist) there isnt a true
WCP: such a word means the intersection point between joint 4 and joint 5.
1. Wrist offset
RRS - Robot Realistic Simulation. It is a protocol that defines some rules to implement
a software sequence that allows a robotics CAD simulator (i.e. Robcad) to move the
robot using the same algorithms than the original Controllers. Such a software sequence
is called RCS module. It is provided by Comau and integrated into the simulators.
Nominal position - This term refers to machines with the Kinematics compensation
algorithm. The nominal position is the destination where the robot must move its TCP.
It usually comes from a CAD simulation where the model of the robot is theoretical,
without mechanical strains due to payload, calibration errors, etc.
Internal representation of the robot position - This term refers to machines with the
Kinematics compensation algorithm. The internal representation of the robot position is
the one coming out from the encoders/resolvers. It is also the position where the robot
is really moved to compensate the differences between the real machine and the
theoretical robot model.
Cartesian position or POSITION - It is a variable that describes the target position for
a MOVE statement by referring to a Cartesian frame of reference. In C4G each
POSITION has three components for the location (X, Y, Z), three angles for the
orientation and a configuration string.
Joint position or JOINTPOS - It is a variable that describes the target position for a
MOVE statement by reporting the value of each robot axis.
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-3
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
15.3 Offset algorithm with Dynamic Model
This algorithm improves the mechanical precision in movement and positioning, thus
cutting down the cycle time.
The algorithm functions continually, both during robot movement and during stops,
regardless of the type of trajectory or the duration of the pause: the only condition is that
the arm be in DRIVE ON.
The modelling of the robot dynamic characteristics requires an accurate definition of the
tool that is mounted on the flange.
The description of the tool can be executed by means of three system variables that
are added to $TOOL. These are $TOOL_MASS, that is the tool mass, $TOOL_CNTR,
which is the centre of the tool mass and $TOOL_INERTIA.
It must be noted that accuracy in the assignment of the tool characteristics has a strong
influence on the machine performance.
Furthermore, if the robot is used to transfer components, it is important that the
declaration of the dynamic characteristics includes the contribution of the workpiece
mass, as well as that of the gripping tool; this also applies for the definition of the mass
centre coordinates.
15.4 Kinematic offset algorithm (optional feature)
This algorithm improves the precision of the robot positioning in the work area.
The software offsets the kinematic errors, caused by the imprecision of the robot lever
lengths or the incorrect coupling of the axes (axis orthogonality ), and deflection error
caused by the weight of the mechanical parts.
To make it operational, it is necessary to identify the actual kinematic model of each
individual robot so as to obtain a machine offset file.
15.5 Moving through axis 5 singularities
In current paragraph information are given about the following topics:
Using WRIST_J NT modality to go through singularities
J ogging through wrist singularities
15.5.1 Using WRIST_JNT modality to go through singularities
In all the robot mechanical structures there are particular positions where performances
are reduced; such positions are called singularities. Usually, when robot gets close to a
singularity while moving in a linear/circular way, either the speed is reduced or the
trajectory is changed as to the espected one. This is true for every robot regardless the
manufacturer.
In order to retrieve Comau Options Codes, please refer to C4G Control Unit
Technical Specifications Manual, chapter Software Options.
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-4
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
Anthropomorphic robots, like the ones in Tab. 15.1 - Involved Robot models, have three
singularities. The most evident one happens when axis 5 is at zero degrees. When this
occurs, axis 4 is aligned with axis 6. This produces different behaviors depending on the
shape of the wrist. Further information are described in the following par. 15.6.1.4 Axis
5 singularity a pag. 15-7 for non-spherical wrist robots and par. 15.6.2.1 Axis 5
singularity a pag. 15-15 for spherical wrist robots.
Nevertheless there is a general feature available with Comau C4G Robot Controller that
allows the robot to achieve high performances while moving through axis 5 singularity
(wrist singularity).
It is possible to enable this type of evolution by setting the $ORNT_TYPE system
variable to the WRIST_JNT value ($ORNT_TYPE:=WRIST_JNT). It is advisable to
enable this modality only with moves that have to go through the singularity because
the default evolution modality, RS_WORLD, generally achieves the best behavior from
the application point of view. The RS_WORLD modality allows either maintaining
constant orientation, if necessary, or changing it by keeping the tool on a plane.
1. Side view 2. Front view
Nevertheless the RS_WORLD evolution doesn't allow the robot always to move through
the singularity zone. In this cases the WRIST_JNT modality performs the best behavior.
The effect is that the speed is maintained at a high value while the orientation of the tool
slightly looses the plane.
The evolution can also be very big if the starting and ending point are very far from the
singularity zone. This can happen because the WRIST_JNT evolution implements an
algorithm that maintains the TCP exactly on the Cartesian path while the wrist axes are
moved from the initial to the final position in joint evolution.
The effect of WRIST_JNT modality is generally good from the application point of view.
In some particular cases it would be necessary to follow additional programming rules
explained later in this document (see par. 15.7 Programming rules for non-spherical
wrist robots (SMART NH4) a pag. 15-17).
The only limitation referring to the WRIST_JNT is that it is not allowed to continuously
move (MOVEFLY TO ...) between two movements with different evolution type. So if a
move has the standard RS_WORLD evolution and the next is WRIST_JNT, either the
fly must be removed or the evolution type of the first one must be set to WRIST_JNT too.
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-5
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
1. Linear trajectories while getting near the singularity.
The curved lines are the flange trajectories, while the TCP moves along the right path
2. Exact singularity position
3. Behaviour of the WRIST_J OINT modality.
Getting closer to the singularity, speed is maintained high while orientation slightly changes
15.5.2 Jogging through wrist singularities
Also during the jogging phase (manual movement of the robot) it is possible to avoid all
problems due to axis 5 singularity by using the WRIST_JNT evolution.
There are 4 standard modalities for jogging:
TOOL
UFRAME
BASE
JOINT
The first three ones are for Cartesian movements, with reference to tool frame, user
frame and world frame; the last one allows moving each single robot joint. These
modalities are usually the best from the application point of view but they do not allow
robot to move in a Cartesian way when axis 5 is inside the singularity zone. To achieve
this task it is necessary to enable the WRIST_JNT modalities for jogging.
The WRIST_JNT evolution can be set for Cartesian manual, from the Motion page,
Basic sub-page, COORD field of the Teach Pendant. On the TP4i/WiTP status bar the
following words will be seen: Wr-Base, Wr-Tool, Wr-Ufrm, J oint.
WRIST_JNT modalities allow TCP to move along a straight line without moving wrist
axes, by pressing the first three jog buttons: +1X/-1X, +2Y/-2Y, +3Z/-3Z. On the other
hand, pressing jog buttons +4/-4, +5/-5, or +6/-6, it is possible to move a single wrist axis
while maintaining TCP steady. These modalities are useful to go through the singularity
because they allow the robot to be jogged in a Cartesian way also if axis 5 is exactly at
0 degrees.
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-6
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
15.6 Robots without compensation (effect of the
inverse kinematics)
In current paragraph, information are given about the following topics:
Inverse conversion of SMART NH4 (non-spherical wrist) model
Inverse conversion of SMART NH, NS and NM (spherical wrist models only)
15.6.1 Inverse conversion of SMART NH4 (non-spherical wrist)
model
SMART NH4(L) robot has a particular hollow wrist with an offset between axis 4 and 6.
To compute the value of the axes that allows the robot moving to a specific Cartesian
position (inverse kinematics conversion), it is necessary to run an iterative algorithm that
uses the WCP position and the TCP position of the robot, with reference to its base.
In the following sections the related effects are shown:
Approximation in the orientation
Move to a taught POSITION
Fly between MOVE LINEAR/CIRCULAR and MOVE J OINT
Axis 5 singularity
Cartesian position out of range
TCP in the back of the robot
TCP behind axis 2
WCP close to axis 1
15.6.1.1 Approximation in the orientation
The Cartesian position reached by the TCP is always correct in X, Y and Z. This means
that the X, Y and Z coordinates of the final position correspond to the taught one (unless
some effect due to compensation). On the other hand, the orientation can be
approximated. This means that the robot reaches the final position with the Euler angles
slightly different to the original ones. This difference is usually less than 0.8 degrees (can
be bigger in proximity of the border of the working area).
This approximation affects all the axes and can produce some unexpected error
message because some of the axes can get closer to some limit than the taught joints.
For this reason some bigger ranges are advised in the following paragraphs. These
ranges are called safe ranges.
The approximation does not affect the locations recorded as JOINTPOS.
15.6.1.2 Move to a taught POSITION
The approximation in the orientation can produce the following effect. When a MOVE is
executed to a Cartesian position, the flange (not the TCP) can move a few millimetres
around its position. The displacement is usually less that 10 millimeters with a tool 1500
millimeters long.
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-7
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
1a - 1b: difference between the two flange positions, due to the orientation approximation
2a - 2b: orientation approximation
15.6.1.3 Fly between MOVE LINEAR/CIRCULAR and MOVE JOINT
The approximation in the orientation causes a small difference between the computed
joint values (to finish current movement) and the real values.
For this reason it is advisable not to use a fly between a linear/circular move and a joint
move or vice-versa.
15.6.1.4 Axis 5 singularity
Due to the hollow wrist the singularity zone for SMART NH4(L) robot is wider than the
position at 0 degrees of axis 5. The conversion can give back a solution only if axis 5 is
out of range 6 around zero value and multiple of 180. If, during the conversion, axis
5 enters this zone an error message is issued.
Due to the approximation in orientation, the error message can come out also on a
POSITION that had been taught with axis 5 slightly out of 6 threshold . Since the
approximation is usually less than 0,8, a safe range is 7.
Forbidden ranges
[ -6; +6 ]
[ -174; -186 ]
[ +174; +186 ]
Safe ranges
[ -7; +7 ]
[ -173; -187 ]
[ +173; +187 ]
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-8
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
Fig. 15.1 - SMART NH4 forbidden zone
1. 6 degrees around 0 and 180
Actions Allowed Forbidden Notes
REC J OINTPOS inside the singularity zone
X
It is possible to record a joint
position (JOINTPOS).
REC POSITION/XTNDPOS inside the
singularity zone X
It is NOT possible to record a
Cartesian position (POSITION or
XTNDPOS).
MOVE J OINT through singularity zone X
MOVE LINEAR/CIRCULAR through
singularity zone with the standard evolution
modality (RS_WORLD)
X
It is possible to move in a
Cartesian way only with the
WRIST_JNT evolution (see
par. 15.5 Moving through axis 5
singularities a pag. 15-3). In the
standard modality (RS_WORLD)
MOVE LINEAR/CIRCULAR is
not allowed.
MOVE LINEAR/CIRCULAR through
singularity zone with the WRIST_J NT
evolution modality
X
JOG JOINT inside the singularity zone X It is possible to jog the robot in a
Cartesian way only if the
WRIST_JNT modalities are
enabled (WR-BASE, WR-UFRM,
WR-TOO, see par. 15.5.2
J ogging through wrist
singularities a pag. 15-5). It is not
allowed to jog inside the
singularity zone with the standard
jog modalities (BASE, UFRAME,
TOOL).
JOG BASE, UFRM, TOOL inside the
singularity zone
X
JOG WR-BASE, WR-UFRM, WR-TOOL inside
the singularity zone
X
MOVE J OINT TO J OINTPOS inside the
singularity zone
X
MOVE LINEAR TO J OINTPOS inside the
singularity zone
X
If the destination point is inside
the singularity zone it is not
possible to move there both with
the standard evolution and with
WRIST_JNT.
MOVE J OINT TO POSITION/XTNDPOS inside
the singularity zone
X
MOVE LINEAR TO POSITION/XTNDPOS
inside the singularity zone
X
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-9
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
15.6.1.5 Cartesian position out of range
Due to the particular wrist of SMART NH4(L) model, the external boundary of the
Cartesian working area is slightly reduced with respect to spherical-wrist machines.
This reduction depends on the direction of the wrist offset:
If the wrist offset is downward there is no limitation.
If the wrist offset is upward there is an additional forbidden area for SMART NH4(L)
robot. The width of this area is 180 mm in the front area and 225 mm in the rear
area. For SMART NH4(L) robots, the width is 140 mm in the front area and 215 mm
in the rear area.
Error messages
36996 (0x9084) "Wrist axis at undefined position" before starting the move.
62479 (0xf40f) "Wrist axis at undefined position" while moving into the forbidden
zone.
40014 (0x9c4e) "Wrist axis at undefined position" while teaching/modifying a point.
RCS MODULE - Status returned: -59 " The specified position is singular" .
These areas can be reached in a joint way; the limitations only refer to Cartesian
movements
See pictures in the Appendix for further details
Actions Allowed Forbidden Notes
REC J OINTPOS inside the forbidden zone
X
It is possible to record a joint
position (JOINTPOS).
REC POSITION/XTNDPOS inside the
forbidden zone X
It is NOT possible to record a
Cartesian position (POSITION or
XTNDPOS).
MOVE J OINT through the forbidden zone X It is allowed to move through this
zone with every type of
movement. It is sufficient that the
destination point is out of the
forbidden zone.
MOVE LINEAR/CIRCULAR through the
forbidden zone
X
JOG J NT inside the forbidden zone X
It is possible to jog the robot in
every modality.
JOG BAS, USR, TOL inside the forbidden
zone
X
JOG BWR, UWR, TWR inside the forbidden
zone
X
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-10
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
15.6.1.6 TCP in the back of the robot
There are some limitations in the working area that are not immediately visible to the
user. They depend on the position of the TCP with respect to the robot axes. For this
reason they are related to the current dimension of the tool (both remote and local).
There is a forbidden zone when the TCP tries to go in the back of the robot with respect
to axis 1. The width of this area is approximately 150 mm on both sides.
Approaching this area the approximation on the orientation increases up to some
degrees.
The same situation can also happen with remote tool ($TOOL_RMT:=TRUE or nodal
MOVE J OINT TO J OINTPOS inside the
forbidden zone
X
If the destination point is inside
the forbidden zone, it is possible
to reach it only if it is a
JOINTPOS.
MOVE LINEAR TO J OINTPOS inside the
forbidden zone
X
MOVE J OINT TO POSITION/XTNDPOS inside
the forbidden zone
X
MOVE LINEAR TO POSITION/XTNDPOS
inside the forbidden zone
X
Error messages
36994 (0x9082) "Pos out of range" before starting the move.
62477 (0xf40d) "Cartesian position out of range" while moving into the forbidden
zone.
40012 (0x9c4c) "Pos out of range" while teaching/modifying a point.
RCS MODULE - Status returned: -52 " Cartesian position is out of work
range" .
Actions Allowed Forbidden Notes
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-11
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
move with rtf(i,j)).
1. Remote TCP inside the forbidden zone
Actions Allowed Forbidden Notes
REC J OINTPOS inside the forbidden zone
X
It is possible to record a joint
position (JOINTPOS).
REC POSITION/XTNDPOS inside the
forbidden zone X
It is NOT possible to record a
Cartesian position (POSITION or
XTNDPOS).
MOVE J OINT through forbidden zone X
MOVE LINEAR/CIRCULAR through forbidden
zone with the standard evolution modality
(RS_WORLD)
X
It is possible to move in a
Cartesian way only with the
WRIST_JNT evolution (see
par. 15.5 Moving through axis 5
singularities a pag. 15-3). In the
standard modality (RS_WORLD)
MOVE LINEAR/CIRCULAR is
not allowed.
MOVE LINEAR/CIRCULAR through forbidden
zone with the WRIST_J NT evolution modality
X
JOG J NT inside the forbidden zone
X
It is possible to jog the robot in a
Cartesian way only if the
WRIST_JNT modalities are
enabled (BWR, UWR, TWR, see
par. 15.5.2 J ogging through wrist
singularities a pag. 15-5). It is not
allowed to jog inside the
forbidden zone with the standard
jog modalities (BAS, USR, TOL).
JOG BAS, USR, TOL inside the forbidden
zone
X
JOG BWR, UWR, TWR inside the forbidden
zone
X
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-12
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
15.6.1.7 TCP behind axis 2
There is a forbidden zone when the TCP tries to go behind a plane containing axis 2.
The width of this area is approximately 150 mm on both sides. Approaching this area
the approximation on the orientation increases up to some degrees.
This same situation can happen also with remote tool ($TOOL_RMT:=TRUE or nodal
move with rtf(i,j)).
MOVE J OINT TO J OINTPOS inside the
forbidden zone
X
If the destination point is inside
the forbidden zone, it is possible
to reach it only if it is a
JOINTPOS.
MOVE LINEAR TO J OINTPOS inside the
forbidden zone
X
MOVE J OINT TO POSITION/XTNDPOS inside
the forbidden zone
X
MOVE LINEAR TO POSITION/XTNDPOS
inside the forbidden zone
X
Error messages
36995 (0x9083) "Axis 1 at undefined position" before starting the move.
62478 (0xf40e) "Axis 1 at undefined position" while moving into the forbidden zone.
40013 (0x9c4d) "Axis 1 at undefined position" while teaching/modifying a point.
RCS MODULE - Status returned: -52 " Cartesian position is out of work
range" .
Actions Allowed Forbidden Notes
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-13
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
15.6.1.8 WCP close to axis 1
There is a forbidden zone when the WCP tries to enter a cylinder around the axis 1. The
radius of the cylinder is approximately 200 mm. Physically the WCP of the normal
SMART NH4(L) can't reach this zone. Only the shelf mounted SMART NH4(L) can do
this (see Fig. 15.2 - SMART NH4 / SH (top view)).
Actions Allowed Forbidden Notes
REC J OINTPOS inside the forbidden zone
X
It is possible to record a joint
position (JOINTPOS).
REC POSITION/XTNDPOS inside the
forbidden zone X
It is NOT possible to record a
Cartesian position (POSITION or
XTNDPOS).
MOVE J OINT through forbidden zone X
MOVE LINEAR/CIRCULAR through forbidden
zone with the standard evolution modality
(RS_WORLD)
X
It is possible to move in a
Cartesian way only with the
WRIST_JNT evolution (see
par. 15.5 Moving through axis 5
singularities a pag. 15-3). In the
standard modality (RS_WORLD)
MOVE LINEAR/CIRCULAR is
not allowed.
MOVE LINEAR/CIRCULAR through forbidden
zone with the WRIST_J NT evolution modality
X
JOG J NT inside the forbidden zone
X
It is possible to jog the robot in a
Cartesian way only if the
WRIST_JNT modalities are
enabled (BWR, UWR, TWR, see
par. 15.5.2 J ogging through wrist
singularities a pag. 15-5). It is not
allowed to jog inside the
forbidden zone with the standard
jog modalities (BAS, USR, TOL).
JOG BAS, USR, TOL inside the forbidden
zone
X
JOG BWR, UWR, TWR inside the forbidden
zone
X
MOVE J OINT TO J OINTPOS inside the
forbidden zone
X
If the destination point is inside
the forbidden zone, it is possible
to reach it only if it is a
JOINTPOS
MOVE LINEAR TO J OINTPOS inside the
forbidden zone
X
MOVE J OINT TO POSITION/XTNDPOS inside
the forbidden zone
X
MOVE LINEAR TO POSITION/XTNDPOS
inside the forbidden zone
X
Error messages
36994 (0x9082) "Pos out of range" before starting the move.
62477 (0xf40d) "Cartesian position out of range" while moving into the forbidden
zone.
40012 (0x9c4c) "Pos out of range" while teaching/modifying a point.
RCS MODULE - Status returned: -52 " Cartesian position is out of work
range" .
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-14
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
Fig. 15.2 - SMART NH4 / SH (top view)
Fig. 15.3 - SMART NH4 / SH (side view)
Actions Allowed Forbidden Notes
REC J OINTPOS inside the forbidden zone
X
It is possible to record a joint
position (JOINTPOS).
REC POSITION/XTNDPOS inside the
forbidden zone X
It is NOT possible to record a
Cartesian position (POSITION or
XTNDPOS).
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-15
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
15.6.2 Inverse conversion of SMART NH, NS and NM (spherical
wrist models only)
SMART NH1-NH2-NH3, NS and NH robots have spherical wrist and this simplifies the
conversion algorithm with respect to SMART NH4 model. This removes the most part of
the limitations explained in previous par. 15.6.1 Inverse conversion of SMART NH4
(non-spherical wrist) model a pag. 15-6. There is only some limitation about the
singularity of axis 5 and when the TCP is close to axis 1 for spherical wrist shelf mounted
machines.
Detailed information are given about the following topics:
Axis 5 singularity
TCP close to axis 1
15.6.2.1 Axis 5 singularity
There is not a forbidden zone when axis 5 is close to zero degrees but it is anyway
advisable not to move through the singularity because close to this zone axes 4 and 6
are required to accelerate and move very fast. The speed of the TCP is reduced while
moving in a Cartesian way close to this zone.
MOVE J OINT through forbidden zone X
Only MOVE JOINT are allowed
inside this forbidden zone.
MOVE LINEAR/CIRCULAR through forbidden
zone with the standard evolution modality
(RS_WORLD)
X
MOVE LINEAR/CIRCULAR through forbidden
zone with the WRIST_J NT evolution modality
X
JOG JOINT inside the forbidden zone
X
JOG WR-BASE, WR-UFRM, WR-TOOL inside
the forbidden zone
X
JOG BWR, UWR, TWR inside the forbidden
zone
X
MOVE J OINT TO J OINTPOS inside the
forbidden zone
X
MOVE LINEAR TO J OINTPOS inside the
forbidden zone
X
MOVE J OINT TO POSITION/XTNDPOS inside
the forbidden zone
X
MOVE LINEAR TO POSITION/XTNDPOS
inside the forbidden zone
X
Error messages
36995 (0x9083) "Axis 1 at undefined position" before starting the move.
62478 (0xf40e) "Axis 1 at undefined position" while moving into the forbidden zone.
40013 (0x9c4d) "Axis 1 at undefined position" while teaching/modifying a point.
RCS MODULE - Status returned: -52 " Cartesian position is out of work
range" .
Actions Allowed Forbidden Notes
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-16
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
The WRIST_JNT modality (see par. 15.5 Moving through axis 5 singularities a
pag. 15-3) is a good method to move through the singularity zone when the
accelerations are too high or when the behavior of the robot is not proper for the specific
application.
15.6.2.2 TCP close to axis 1
There is a singularity zone related to axis 1 of SMART NH1-NH2-NH3 shelf mounted
robots. Inside this zone, axis 1 acceleration and speed considerably increase while TCP
is slowly moving along a Cartesian path. This zone is not forbidden by the system but,
approaching it with TCP, axis 1 behavior could be nervous. Typically, fly motion between
two LINEAR movements having the intermediate point inside this zone, can be hard to
be performed with high speed and sharp corner.
The shape of the zone is a cylinder around axis 1. The radius is approximately 200 mm,
but a fixed rule doesn't exist.
Fig. 15.4 - SMART NH3 / SH - axis 1 singularity
Actions Allowed Forbidden Notes
REC J OINTPOS inside the forbidden zone X
REC POSITION/XTNDPOS inside the
forbidden zone
X
JOG JOINT inside the forbidden zone X It is possible to jog the robot in
both the Cartesian modalities:
standard and WRIST_JNT.
Nevertheless there could be big
acceleration of the axis 1 when
changing direction with the TCP
very close to the axis 1
prolongation.
JOG BASE, UFRAME, TOOL inside the
forbidden zone
X
JOG WR-BASE, WR-UFRAME, WR-TOOL
inside the forbidden zone
X
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-17
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
15.7 Programming rules for non-spherical wrist
robots (SMART NH4)
In current paragraph, some programming rules are described in order to help the robot
user and the CAD programmer, to properly use COMAU robots (mainly SMART NH4
models).
Here following, some hints are given about:
How to stay away from a singularity zone
Using WRIST_J NT modality to go through singularities
MOVE J OINT through forbidden zone X
Executing Cartesian movements
(MOVE LINEAR/CIRCULAR) is
allowed but it is not advisable.
This is true mainly with moves in
fly (MOVEFLY LINEAR TO . . .
ADVANCE) and big changes of
the move direction. In these
cases the axis 1 could be asked
to move with very high
accelerations. There are no
problems to cross this zone in the
joint modality (MOVE JOINT or
jog JNT).
MOVE LINEAR/CIRCULAR through forbidden
zone with the standard evolution modality
(RS_WORLD)
X
MOVE LINEAR/CIRCULAR through forbidden
zone with the WRIST_J NT evolution modality
X
MOVE J OINT TO J OINTPOS inside the
forbidden zone
X
MOVE LINEAR TO J OINTPOS inside the
forbidden zone
X
MOVE J OINT TO POSITION/XTNDPOS inside
the forbidden zone
X
MOVE LINEAR TO POSITION/XTNDPOS
inside the forbidden zone
X
This table is only valid for SMART NH3 robot shelf models!
The prohibited zone for SMART NH1-NH2-NH3 robots that are not shelf, is very
limited. When the WCP is exactly under axis 1, one of the three following error
messages is displayed :
36995 (0x9083) "Axis 1 at undefined position" before starting the move.
62478 (0xf40e) "Axis 1 at undefined position" while moving into the forbidden zone.
40013 (0x9c4d) "Axis 1 at undefined position" while teaching/modifying a point.
RCS MODULE - Status returned: -52 " Cartesian position is out of work
range" .
Actions Allowed Forbidden Notes
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-18
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
The disadvantage is that SMART NH4 robot has a larger singularity zone around axis 5
with respect to spherical wrist robots (see par. 15.6.1.4 Axis 5 singularity a pag. 15-7).
The following programming rules explain how it is possible to perform application
processes staying away from the singularity zone or moving through it with the
WRIST_JNT feature of the C4G Robot Controller.
15.7.1 How to stay away from a singularity zone
The width of the singularity zone for non-spherical wrist robots (SMART NH4) is 6
degrees. As it has been explained in par. 15.5 Moving through axis 5 singularities a
pag. 15-3 it is possible to go through this zone also following a Cartesian path, but in
most cases it is possible to stay away from the singularity. There are three methods to
achieve this task:
Changing the orientation of the points along the path;
Properly designing the work-cell layout;
Modifying tool inserting a small angle between robot flange and tool flange.
The same methods are useful to solve problems with points which are very close to the
working area borders.
15.7.1.1 Changing the orientation of the points along the path
In most applications the tool has a shape that allows rotating around the approaching
direction, without reducing the process quality. This is possible with tools that are
symmetric along a direction. The arc-welding torch and the spot-welding gun are typical
examples.
1. Tool approach vector
SMART NH4 robot has been designed for integration of cabling and ease of
off-line programming. For this reason it has a fixed wrist configuration to give the
needed space and distances to include pre-twisted cables and hoses through the
wrist. Following this concept, such a robot model is completely without any
external cable on the forearm, avoiding the unknown behavior of the cables with
conventional robots while moving close to the wrist singularity.
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-19
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
In these cases it is always possible to modify the points (typically POSITIONS) only
adding a small rotation around the approach direction. With the real robot this can be
done by jogging in the TOL modality (jogging with reference to the tool frame) and
pressing jog button +6/-6 (rotation around Z axis that is typically the approach vector); if
the position comes from a CAD system or it is directly written in the program, just modify
the third Eulerian angle e3 (POS(x, y, z, e1, e2, e3, )). On the real robot, a small
rotation of 5 up to 10 allows the wrist to go away from the singularity zone.
The following picture shows three different cases with a spot welding gun.
Fig. 15.5 - BEST situation (90 between axis 6 and gun approach
vector)
Fig. 15.6 - WORST situation (approach vector aligned to axis 6)
The rotation takes more effect if the tool approach vector is not parallel to axis 6
of the robot. If they are parallel, something can still be done, provided that the TCP
is not aligned along axis 6.
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-20
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
Fig. 15.7 - GOOD situation (approach vector parallel to axis 6, but
not aligned)
1. Distance between axis 6 and tool approach vector
Note that rotating around the approach vector is not the only way to stay away from the
singularity zone. Any rotation works and never changes the TCP position in x, y, z.
When the application does not strictly force the orientation of the tool, a small change
could considerably improve the wrist position and the robot performances.
15.7.1.2 Properly designing the work-cell layout
There are some cases where the first method (par. 15.7.1.1 Changing the orientation of
the points along the path a pag. 15-18) doesnt apply. This happens, sometimes, with
palletizing applications where the orientation is fixed. In such cases it is necessary to
properly design the work-cell layout, in order to avoid entering the singularity zone. Also
the shape of the tool is very important to solve bad situations and improve the robot
performances (see par. 15.7.1.3 Modifying tool inserting a small angle between robot
flange and tool flange a pag. 15-23).
The programmer must avoid situations in which pallets are exactly in front of the robot
and grippers are oriented in the direction of axis 6 (see pictures below).
Such a bad situation comes from the following three conditions:
the gripper is aligned with axis 6;
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-21
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
the pallet is placed at the same level of the robot calibration position;
the pallet is placed exactly in front of the robot.
To eliminate any singularity problems, the programmer has to remove al least one of the
listed above conditions. For example, putting the pallet in a lower position or mounting
the robot in a higher place the robot will be able to reach all the positions on the rack
without any problems (see next picture).
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-22
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
Similarly it is possible to solve any singularity problem by laterally moving the rack. In
this case it is not necessary to change the height.
In any case the best solution can be found by means of an off-line simulation. In this way
it is possible to calculate the minimum displacement of the rack, either sideways, or up,
or down .
It is important to remember that SMART NH4 models gives big advantages during
simulation because there arent any external cable on the forearm. This allows solving
any reachability problem during the work-cell design phase. At this time it will be
possible to choose the best location for the elements, the best gripper shape and robot
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-23
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
paths.
15.7.1.3 Modifying tool inserting a small angle between robot flange and tool
flange
The gripper design is very important to improve the robot capabilities. This is true for all
the robot models. In addition to this, for SMART NH4 robots the gripper shape can solve
any problem with singularity.
A small angle between the robot flange and the gripper is recommended in order to
considerably improve the reachability of singular positions.
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-24
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
As shown in the above pictures, such a solution allows the robot to follow a linear
trajectory exactly in front of it from up to down. It also allows to reach all the available
working area always maintaining the frontal position and the same orientation.
The same applies to spot-welding guns. If the work-cell layout is already defined, a small
angle can considerably improve the behavior of the robot. This method can also solve
the worst situations where the approach vector of the gun is exactly aligned with axis 6
(see par. 15.7.1.1 Changing the orientation of the points along the path a pag. 15-18).
Of course, the use of an off-line simulation simplifies the chose of the angle and allows
an optimization of all the details of the application.
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-25
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
15.7.2 Using WRIST_JNT modality to go through singularities
As clearly explained in par. 15.5 Moving through axis 5 singularities a pag. 15-3,
WRIST_JNT is the right method to solve singularity problems. It is useful mainly for
moving through the singularity zone because it allows axis 5 to reach the zero position
while TCP is following the required Cartesian trajectory.
Here follows an example involving SMART NH4 model. With WRIST_JNT modality it is
possible to perform vertical trajectories around the singularity point. Of course, all the
positions must be out of the singularity zone (see par. 15.6.1.4 Axis 5 singularity a
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-26
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
pag. 15-7) but any trajectory can cross it.
If the program is correctly designed, axis 5 is asked to move from a negative to a positive
value (or vice-versa) while the wrist offset is always maintained on the same side. As
already explained, the orientation is slightly changed during the movement. This is
automatically done by the system without any need of modifying points.
1. Level of the singularity point
The following picture shows an example of the maximum angular error that is applied
to the orientation while entering different circular zones around the singularity point.
These data has been computed with a tool 560 mm long and exactly aligned with axis
6. Many vertical trajectories have been executed around the calibration position of the
SMART NH4 model, properly programming the points and moving in WRIST_JNT
evolution method through the singularity zone.
As clearly shown, the angle is more than 2 degrees inside a small circle with a diameter
of about 90 mm. Out of a zone of about 290 mm it is possible to cross the singularity
zone without any error.
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-27
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
1. Singularity exact position
15.7.3 Conclusions
Many methods and hints have been given to increase the capabilities of SMART NH4
robots inside the singularity zone. It has been demonstrated that in the most cases it is
possible to stay out of this zone, getting the best performances from the robot anyway.
When it is absolutely necessary to go through the singularity, WRIST_JNT modality
allows the robot to move at a very high speed with an angular error that can be accepted
in the most processes. In any case the simulation tools can be effectively used to obtain
the best results from the system.
Presuppositions for SMART Robot programming
15-28
pr-0-0-gpr_05.fm
00/0607
15.8 Appendix
15.8.1 Exact working range for SMART NH4
Collision Detection (optional)
16-1
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
16. COLLISION DETECTION
(OPTIONAL)
16.1 Introduction
The Collision Detection algorithm allows the system to stop the robot arm motion, as
soon as any noise force on joints takes effect.
Such a capability can be enabled and disabled by the user, by means of a predefined
variable, using either a Program statement or a system Command
Current chapter supplies information about the following topics:
Basic concepts
Activation/deactivation of Collision Detection function Collision Detection
functionality
Collision Detection sensitivity type
Reliability of Collision Detection functionality
Notes about the collision detection use procedure
CollMngr Program to activate/deactivate the sensitivity thresholds calculation
Sample Programs.
16.2 Basic concepts
When enabled, the Collision Detection functionality allows detecting situations such as
robot arm collisions with the surrounding environment
stuck tips in welding operations,
etc.
When a collision condition is detected (error message 62513SAX: collision detected),
the system may enter into a particular phase during which the robot gets compliant and
the emergency braking takes place
In order to retrieve Comau Options Codes, please refer to C4G Control Unit
Technical Specifications Manual, chapter Software Options.
The Collision Detection functionality has NOT been designed in order to protect
the personnel, but to limit any damage to the robot mechanical parts and
therefore to its equipments!
Collision Detection (optional)
16-2
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
Compliance
The axes compliance has been used in order to be able to absorb part of the collision
energy (or part of the over-traction in case of stuck tips) and to minimize any possible
damage, this compliance can be activated by the user. Carefully assess its use in the
application.
Severity of collision error
As from version 2.20 the severity of the collision error can be changed by bringing it from
10 (that causes a DRIVE OFF) to 8 (that generates a HOLD). To do this, set the new
predefined variable $COLL_EFFECT ($ARM_DATA field ) to the value:
0 to generate, in the case of collision, a DRIVE OFF;
1 to set the machine in HOLD state.
2 to generate the system event 197 that indicates "collision detected"
If it is wished, in the case of a severity 8 alarm, to activate the compliance mode, it is
better to increase the SoftServo after collision ($TUNE[25]) timeout bringing it from 600
(default) to 1000 or 1200.
This way of managing the Collision Detection is useful for "Pallet Search" applications
in the robot operating area: the arm moves along a Cartesian direction and when it
meets the pallet it stops, remaining fed, instead of generating an error and passing in
DRIVE OFF.
16.3 Activation/deactivation of Collision
Detection function
Since System Software release 2.02, Collision Detection handling is changed.
In order to enable the Collision Detection functionality, it is enough to set
$CRNT_DATA[num_arm].COLL_ENBL predefined variable to TRUE, by either a
Program Statement or a System Command:
$CRNT_DATA[ num_ar m] . COLL_ENBL : = TRUE
By default, it is not reset by the system upon each drive off command; it continues to be
working until the user consciously decides to disable it, by setting the mentioned above
flag to FALSE.
It is also possible to go back to the previous operating mode (that is to software versions
less than 2.02) for automatically disabling the Collision Detection functionality, setting to
1 bit number 10 of $ARM_DATA[num_arm].A_ALONG_1D[12] predefined variable, by
means of the BIT_SET built-in.
BIT_SET($ARM_DATA[num_arm].A_ALONG_1D[12], 10)
The bit modification is allowed both at run-time and by means of the configuration file,
and it is possible to save it into the configuration file .C4G.
The robot DOES NOT STOP, but continues the programmed motion: it is the
responsibility of the user to appropriately deal with the event that has occurred,
cancelling the current motion, that would continue toward the obstruction, and
programming the new trajectory. In the par. 16.8.5 Managing " collision detected"
event on page 16-28, there is an example program.
Collision Detection (optional)
16-3
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
Compliance
After a collision alarm, the robot stop may be made compliant. The compliance
occurence after collision is statedby setting to 1 bit number 11 of
$ARM_DATA[num_arm].A_ALONG_1D[12] predefined variable, and it is up to the user
to enable it by inserting in his program the following statement:
BI T_SET( $ARM_DATA[ num_ar m] . A_ALONG_1D[ 12] , 11) .
Such a flag can be disabled by means of the following statement:
BI T_CLEAR( $ARM_DATA[ num_ar m] . A_ALONG_1D[ 12] , 11) .
To avoid that this bit is unintentionally saved in .C4G and enables the compliance
service linked to the Collision Detection unexpectedly after a restart, the bit itself will be
automatically reset by the system during the start-up.
16.4 Collision Detection sensitivity type
A detailed description follows of predefined variables which are involved in the Collision
Detection functionality. They are:
$COLL_TYPE
$ARM_SENSITIVITY (sensitivity threshold of the axes)
$COLL_SOFT_PER (axes compliance thresholds)
16.4.1 $COLL_TYPE
In order to define the Collision Detection sensitivity type, it is available $COLL_TYPE
predefined variable. The allowed values for such a predefined variable are as follows:
COLL_LOW
COLL_MEDIUM
COLL_HIGH
COLL_MANUAL
initialized by COMAU, and
COLL_USER1
COLL_USER2
...
NOTE THAT:
if the used System Software version is less than 2.02, when the Collision
Detection functionality is enabled, any occurring DRV OFF automatically disables
it (error message 62514 SA: collision detection disabled upon DRV OFF). To
enable it again, it is necessary to do it intentionally, executing the following
statement again:
$CRNT_DATA[num_arm].COLL_ENBL := TRUE
For versions after 2.02 the Collision Detection, once enabled, remains active until
the user disables it.
Collision Detection (optional)
16-4
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
...
COLL_USER10
that can be handled by the user to customise COMAU data.
During a Program execution, while some particular arm movements are performed, it is
possible that an occurring collision should be detected using more or less sensitivity.
The collision sensitivity can be modified both for a MOVE sequence and for just one
MOVE statement.
Modal assignment (for the whole MOVE sequence):
$CRNT_DATA[ num_ar m] . COLL_ENBL : = TRUE
$COLL_TYPE: = COLL_MEDI UM
MOVE TO PNT0001J
MOVE TO PNT0002J
In the shown above example, the collision sensitivity takes effect for both the MOVE
statements.
Nodal assignment (for just one MOVE statement):
$CRNT_DATA[ num_ar m] . COLL_ENBL : = TRUE
$COLL_TYPE : = COLL_LOW
MOVE TO PNT0001J
MOVE TO PNT0002J WI TH $COLL_TYPE : = COLL_HI GH
In the shown above example, the first MOVE statement is executed using a LOW
collision sensitivity, while the second one is performed using a HIGH collision sensitivity.
A set of values corresponds to each value of $COLL_TYPE for the axes sensitivity,
$ARM_SENSITIVITY and a set of values (if any) for the compliance of
$COLL_SOFT_PER (just in the case in which the compliance modality after collision
has been enabled). Basic values (HIGH, MEDIUM, LOW, MANUAL) are set by COMAU.
COLL_USER1 and COLL_USER2 values can be used under the care and the
responsibility of the user.
16.4.2 $ARM_SENSITIVITY (sensitivity threshold of the axes)
This bidimensional array represents the snsitivity threshold for each robot axis, used by
the Collision Detection algorithm. Maximum sensitivity is 100, minimum is 0.
The first dimension is the one of all possible values of $COLL_TYPE. The second one
is the axis number. Example: $ARM_SENSITIVITY[COLL_LOW, 1]
As from version 2.3x of the system software, the calculation of the Collision Detection
sensitivity thresholds will be possible by means of a built-in that can be run while the
robot executes the work cycle.
The characteristics of this built-in are the following:
When the Collision Detection functionality is enbled in PROGR state (jog,
ProgramEdit, etc.), the COLL_MANUAL correponding thresholds (which
means $ARM_SENSITIVITY [COLL_MANUAL,nax] and $COLL_SOFT_PER
[COLL_MANUAL,nax] ) are used, regardless the current value of $COLL_TYPE.
For system software versions less than 2.02, the user is responsible of enabling
the Collision Detection functionality again, by means of the following statement
$CRNT_DATA[num_arm].COLL_ENBL := TRUE, as previously decribed.
Collision Detection (optional)
16-5
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
ARM_COLL_THRS(Arm, Coll_type, Time, Margin)
Arm is the arm where the acquisition is to be made.
Coll_type is the type of sensitivity for acquisition: the built-in will go directly to load
the $ARM_SENSITIVITY variables for the specified Coll_type. To obtain the
optimising of the sensitivity thresholds, the types of collision increase from 6 to 14,
with the introduction of the types from COLL_USER3 to COLL_USER10.
Time is the time, in seconds, that the acquisition lasts, and it has to correspond to
at least the time of the path for which the thresholds are to be valid (a work cycle
or a single motion). It may be from 1 to 300 seconds.
Margin is a flag (TRUE/FALSE) that defines whether the thresholds are to be
calculated with a margin of variability (TRUE, default value) or exactly on the
assigned path (FALSE).
The value of the variability margin is contained in the predefined variable
$A_ALONG_2D[10,ax] that will be initialised, in the configuration file, with the value
{7,7,6,6,6,0,0,0,0}which means 7% of the drive full scale on the first 3 axes, and
6% on the wrist axes (value determined experimentally). The privileged user can
change this margin.
For example,
ARM_COLL_THRS( 1, COLL_USER2, 60, FALSE)
Acquires the data starting from the instant the built-in is executed and for the next 60
seconds: the end being indicated with the message
62520 - 02 SA DETERMINATION OF THE COLLISION CONCLUDED THRESHOLD
loads the values obtained, with no variability margin, in the predefined variables
$ARM_SENSITIVITY[COLL_USER2, ax].
The built-in can be used in a PDL2 program, linked to opportune CONDITIONS, to
adjust the sensitivity thresholds should the movement execution conditions change.
Since System Software version 2.42 and subsequent, values 1 and 0 of the Time
parameter, take a new meaning:
1 - indicates to start the data acquisition in order to calculate the sensitivity
thresholds
0 - indicates to stop the data acquisition and to assign the sensitivity
thresholds.
Example of usage:
ARM_COLL_THRS( 1, COLL_USER7, 1)
MOVE . . .
. . . .
MOVE . . .
ARM_COLL_THRS( 1, COLL_USER7, 0)
It is to be noted that the recalculation requires the same time as for the
acquisition, before the new thresholds can be actuated. During this time, the
active thresholds (i.e. the current ones) could cause false collisions or poor
sensitivity.
Opportune measures, such as to use the standard safety thresholds during the
transition stage (from the start of the built-in execution to the receiving of the
message) should allow the acquisition phase to be overcome .
Collision Detection (optional)
16-6
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
16.4.3 $COLL_SOFT_PER (axes compliance thresholds)
This predefined variable represents the compliance percentage for each robot axis, in
the compliance condition (when enabled), caused by a detected collision. Maximum
compliance percentage is 100, minimum is 0.
The first dimension is one of all possible values of $COLL_TYPE. The second one is the
axis number. Example: $COLL_SOFT_PER[COLL_HIGH, 3]
16.5 Reliability
In order to make the Collision Detection algorithm to operate in a safe and reliable way,
it is ABSOLUTELY REQUIRED that the user properly identifies the payload.
The Collision Detection performance strictly depends on a proper declaration of the
currently used payload: if the estimated payload is wrong, the Collision Detection could
be misevaluated (i.e. false collision during a Program execution); furthermore, while in
the compliance phase, with consequent deceleration and stop, the robot arm could have
unpredictable behaviours due to either an underestimated or an overestimated payload.
16.6 Notes about the collision detection use
procedure
16.6.1 Introduction
The following remarks are provided to help the user in setting up the Collision Detection
functionality.
The essential condition for the Collision Detection functionality to work properly is that
the dynamic model of the currents does exist for the related arm/robot. Only if the robot
is provided with such a dynamic model, it is possible to activate the functionality (if the
optional feature is present/purchased).
The dynamic model is able to calculate in advance the currents that will be used to move
the robot in a specific motion, using robot position, payload and inertia data. Today all
robots (except auxiliary axes) are provided with dynamic model.
In order to obtain the best performances from the dynamic model, it is NECESSARY to
have properly configured the following payload variables:
$TOOL_MASS
$TOOL_CNTR
$TOOL_INERTIA
It is the operators care either to insert the nominal data or to use (if present/purchased)
the Payload Identification Program (optional feature), to modify the above listed values
while the application program is running, so the current payload values are always
For these reasons, before activating the Collision Detection function, the user is
to check that the load used has been defined precisely.
Collision Detection (optional)
16-7
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
defined for the Controller.
The Collision Detection functionality operates using the currents calculated in advance
by the dynamic model and the actual currents of each axis motor during the movement.
Such a functionality warns the user that a collision occurred. The Collision Detection
functionality works using the currents which are calculated in advance by the dynamic
model and the currents actually used in each motor (axes) movements. The functionality
warns the user about the occurring collision on one or more axes, if the difference
between the two above mentionned currents is significantly big.
When a collision error occurs, the robot is immediately put in DRIVE OFF state and the
following error message is issued:
62513 10 SAX COLLI SI ON DETECTED
in order to reset the alarm state, the alarms latch command is to be used:
ULLA command, or
Alarm Page, Latched sub-page, Ack softkey, in case of use of TP4i/WiTP Teach
Pendant (for further information see Use of C4G Control Unit , chapter USE OF
TP4 TEACH PENDANT,l).
Now, lets go through Collision Detection variables setting. It is strongly recommended
to follow all the listed below steps:
a. What is to be done before enabling the Collision Detection?
a.1 It is necessary to have the final work program.
a.2 To identify the thresholds for that work cycle.
Because of the sensitivity of the algorithm, there is a difference between identifying
the COLD ROBOT thresholds (robot stationary, has been in DRIVE OFF for hours,
if possible overnight) and WARMED ROBOT (a robot is considered WARMED
after it has performed at least 15-20 work cycles).
To be certain that false collisions will not occur, the thresholds are to be identified
with the machine COLD.
If greater sensitivity is desired with WARMED ROBOT, 2 sets of thresholds have
to be identified:
one for COLD ROBOT and
one for WARMED ROBOT.
It will be the task of the user to provide a non-holdable PDL2 program that, at the
same time as the work cycle, manages the graduation of the thresholds from COLD
VERY IMPORTANT! Remeber that the Collision Detection functionality has been
designed to limit any damage to the robot and therefore to its equipment, in case
of collision. So, since it is a functionality that immediately acts to limit the
collision effect, it is expectable it also limits damages to the equipment of the cell
where the robot works in. But it is important to understand that the Collision
Detection functionality has not been designed to protect the operator in case of
bad/wrong use of the robot.
Identifying the thresholds with the robot COLD limits, to a certain extent, the
sensitivity of the algorithm. The rules for use that are given below can help
understand these aspects and advise the user how to also make the function very
sensitive.
Collision Detection (optional)
16-8
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
to WARMED and from WARMED to COLD, based on events (for example machine
stop for maintenance or a halt in the working activities and a restart) and the
associated timers.
The user can develop the program using the example in the par. 16.8.4 Updating
of thresholds in cold robot/warmed robot mode on page 16-16.
b. Splitting-up the program
The user program is to be splitted-up in some parts, in order to make it more
efficient end effective. For example:
A: Via point movements
B: short positioning movements
C: technological movements (pick, drop, welding, etc.)
The user has to specify, for each type of movement, the right threshold which is
due both to the robot position and its payload.
When the program movements have been logically splitted-up, based upon the
different movement types, go to the following step.
c. Activating the functionality
In order to activate the functionality, it is enough to insert the following statement
at the program beginning:
$CRNT_DATA[ num_ar m] . COLL_ENABLE: =TRUE
To deactivate it:
$CRNT_DATA[ numer o_ar m] . COLL_ENABLE: =FALSE
As far as using the DRIVE OFF command with system software varsions less than
2.02, please read the described above note (see NOTE THAT:).
d. Definition of Nodal/ModalSensitivity
The system is provided with some predefined thresholds, for a general payload,
like the robot payload:
COLL_LOW
COLL_MEDIUM
COLL_HIGH
While in programming state, the system automatically uses a 4th threshold:
COLL_MANUAL
Two more thresholds exists which can be configured by the user:
COLL_USER1
COLL_USER2
...
COLL_USER10
The sensitivity type can be defined in the program by means of two different
strategies:
modal definition
. . .
$COLL_TYPE : = COLL_xxxx
Note that the thresholds definition does NOT take place inside this program, but
in the work program !
Collision Detection (optional)
16-9
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
MOVE . . .
. . .
this means that the chosen sensitivity threshold (COLL_xxxx) will be used
nodal definition for all MOVE statements
MOVE . . . WI TH $COLL_TYPE: = COLL_xxxx ( A) ( see st ep b. )
. . .
MOVE . . . WI TH $COLL_TYPE: = COLL_yyyy ( B) ( see st ep b. )
this means that the chosen sensitivity threshold, (COLL_xxxx), will be used
for (A) type MOVEs; the other one, (COLL_yyyy), will be used for (B) type
MOVEs instead.
e. False collisions
If the user has chosen the thresholds (COLL_LOW, COLL_MEDIUM,
COLL_HIGH, COLL_MANUAL, COLL_USER) without analyzing the type of
collision he would like to prevent, and some wrong thresholds have been set for the
movements included in the program, some False Collisions will occur; this means
, during the robot motion, the system will detect a collision which never happened.
The reason is that a threshold too sensitive for the movement has been used (for
example: too high sensitivity in a movement with high accelerations/decelerations).
f. What does the sensitivity percentage threshold mean?
For each axis, there is a maximum value of its deliverable current; for example, if
IMAX=60 A, saying that the axis sensitivity is 90%,it means:
( 100%- 90%) * 60 A = 6 A
g. Use strategy
First of all the user must understand what he really does need:
REQUIREMENT No.1: immediate use of the Collision Detection
functionality
The modal strategy is the one that allows the user to activate the Collision
Detection functionality and to set, for example, just one threshold for all
motion types (i.e. the user tries using COLL_MEDIUM, then, if any false
collisions occured, switching to COLL_LOW). Obviously, the disadvantage of
such a strategy is that the Collision Detection sensitivity has not been tuned
by the user to have high performances. The advantage is that setting the
sensitivity is very fast.
Once the user program has run with Cold Robot (which means not working
for hours), if no false collisions are detected, the chosen threshold is good to
assure the Collision Detection activation without any false collisions.
Otherwise, it is needed to use a COLL_USERx threshold: they have the same
starting values as COLL_LOW, reduced by 3% for each axis.
REQUIREMENT No. 2: customized use
The nodal strategy has been designed for advanced users who need to reach
a high level protection against collisions, stuck tips, pick/drop movements,
etc.
In such a situation, the user, after having logically grouped the program
movements, as suggested in step b., has to perform some more tests in order
to identify, for each movement, which is the threshold that guarantees the
highest level of protection.
Here follows some operating rules for any single motion.
Consider a single movement and identify its motion type:
Movement with high accelerations/decelerations (many centimeters) -->
(A) type movement (see step b.)
Collision Detection (optional)
16-10
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
Movement at maximum speed
Short movement (few centimeters) -->(B) type movement (see step b.)
Movement at reduced speed
For (A) type movements, it is recommended to start with a COLL_MEDIUM
threshold \ for (B) type movements, start with COLL_HIGH
Execute some motion cycles with Cold robot at 100% (max speed of program
execution). If no false collisions occur, the chosen threshold is the right one.
Otherwise, if some false collisions occur, set the threshold to COLL_LOW (for
(A) type movements) or COLL_MEDIUM (for (B) type movements).
If some false collisions still occur, initialize COLL_USER1 threshold to
COLL_LOW values:
$ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ COLL_USER1, ax: = $ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ COLL_LOW, ax]
Decrease by 3% the value for each axis on which the false collision occured
($ARM_SENSITIVITY[COLL_USER1,ax]) and try again until no false
collisions are detected.
In the thresholds definition, it is recommended to try to keep uniformity in the
values of the main axes 1-2-3 and the wrist axes 4-5-6
The thresholds resulting from the described above tests, are to be used for
any movement which is similar to the analyzed one.
As an alternative the ARM_COLL_THRS(Arm, Coll_type, Time, Margin)
built-in can be used to identify the collision thresholds runtime.
h. Programming tips
If the user would like to operate with the Nodal strategy, in order to obtain the
maximum results from the Collision Detection functionality, it is needed to follow
the listed below suggestions:
avoid technological positions (i.e. Spot Welding positions) by means of an (A)
type movent, which means with big accelerations/decelerations. Insert a
small approach movement.
deactivate the Collision Detection functionality during the technological
operation (i.e. closing the gun). This is to avoid that umpredictable
movements of the equipments could generate torques on robot axes that
could be seen as a collision.
i. Compliance thresholds
If the soft servo modality is activated after a collision, it allows the user to define if,
upon a collision, the robot axes should operate with compliance to absorbe the
impact energy.
The following variable is provided:
$ARM_DATA[ 1] . COLL_SOFT_PER[ COLL_xxxx, axi s]
where:
0 means the axis is rigid
100 means that in case of collision, before the robot goes to DRIVE OFF (in
about 600 ms), the axis will be very compliant. This means that the posture of
the robot adapts to the impact/traction force of the blow and that therefore the
robot could also move quite a lot from the position where the collision took
place.
As far as predefined values (COLL_LOW, COLL_MEDIUM, COLL_HIGH,
COLL_MANUAL, COLL_USER) the compliance thresholds are as follows:
COLL_LOW: 1 for all axes, which means not compliant
COLL_MEDIUM: 50% for all axes, which means medium compliance
COLL_HIG: 50% for main axes, 90% for wrist axes
COLL_MANUAL: similar to COLL_HIGH
Collision Detection (optional)
16-11
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
COLL_USER1..COLL_USER10: set to 1 for all axes, which means not
compliant (to be configured by the user)
16.7 CollMngr Program to activate/deactivate the
sensitivity thresholds calculation
This program is available on the Controllers provided with the Collision Detection
software option.
It makes two functions available, which the user should include in his/her program, in
order to be able to activate/deactivate the sensitivity thresholds calculation, related to
the Collision Detection functionality:
CollisionStart
CollisionEnd
To use such functions, the procedure described in par. 16.7.3 How to use the Collision
Manager on page 16-12 must be performed.
16.7.1 CollisionStart
This function allows to activate the sensitivity thresholds calculation. It is to be called
before the motion statements.
Syntax:
Col l i si onSt ar t ( col l i si on1)
The compliance is to be chosen on the basis of the requirements; for example:
if he would like to avoid very strong collisions, where the robot runs into big
and rigid bodies, a high axes compliance would help to absorbe the impact,
preserving mechanical parts
if the robot operates in restricted areas, close to delicate equipments, a high
compliance index could take damage because the robot, upon a collision,
could run into such an equipment. So, in this situation it would be better to
have a medium axes compliance.
In the case of Spot Welding, if the user would like to prevent the tips from being
stuck, a medium compliance for main axes and a higher compliance for wirst axes
would be reasonable.
Since 2.02 software version, the soft servo modality is not automatically enabled
by the system, upon a collision.
The reason is that if the payload identification is strongly wrong (i.e. the user
declares 100 kg of payload instead of the actual 10 kg!), when a Collision
Detection Alarm occurs, during the hundredths of ms of stop time the robot axes
would be compliant and, with a wrong payload, the TCP could significantly move
in an unpredictable way, because the balancing torque due to gravity is wrong.
The user must INTENTIONALLY enable the compliant modality; he will be able to
take real advantage from it, only if the payload has been carefully identified, in
each step of his program.
Collision Detection (optional)
16-12
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
where collision1 is a paramter of CollData Data Type. The IMPORT statement of such
a Data Type is automatically inserted in IDE environment, as soon as the programmer
inserts the Collision Start function in the program.
It is up to the programmer to declare collision1 variable and to initialize its subfields
related to the Arm and to the threshold index to be used for the calculation.
The CollData Data Type, inported from CollMngr program, is as follows:
TYPE Col l Dat a=RECORD
f i _i dx : I NTEGER
f i _ar m: I NTEGER
f b_det _col l _hot : BOOLEAN
f b_det _col l _col d : BOOLEAN
gi _col l _col d : ARRAY[ 6] OF I NTEGER
gi _col l _hot : ARRAY[ 6] OF I NTEGER
ENDRECORD
16.7.2 CollisionEnd
This function allows to end the sensitivity thresholds calculation.
16.7.3 How to use the Collision Manager
To do that, it is needed to proceed as follows:
a. check if CollMngr.cod file is present in UD:\SYS\UTIL;
b. be sure the System is provided with a software version in which CollisionStart and
CollisionEnd functions are available in IDE environment;
c. in IDE environment (on the Teach Pendant), open the user program in which
inserting the two functions to activate/deactivate the thresholds calculation;
d. write the remaining needed statements:
VAR col l i si on1 : Col l Dat a
BEGI N
col l i si on1. f i _i dx : = 2
col l i si on1. f i _ar m: = 1
Col l i si onSt ar t ( col l i si on1)
. . .
MOVE TO pnt 0001J
MOVE TO pnt 0002J
. . .
Col l i si onEnd
Please note that, every time the CollisionStart - CollisionEnd bolck is called, a
CollMngr.txt file is created (or updated) which keeps track of any operation
executed by the sensitivity thresholds calculation algorithm.
There is an index to prevent creating more than 96 of such files: if one more is
created, it causes to generate a backup file.
Collision Detection (optional)
16-13
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
16.8 Sample Programs
The following sample Programs are provided:
Enabling the Collision Detection functionality for a single MOVE statement
Enabling Collision Detection again from within a Program
Automatic calculation of the sensitivity thresholds
Updating of thresholds in cold robot/warmed robot mode
Managing "collision detected" event
16.8.1 Enabling the Collision Detection functionality for a single
MOVE statement
PROGRAM col l i si on
VAR pnt 0001j , pnt 0002j , pnt 0003j , pnt 0004j : J OI NTPOS FOR ARM[ 1]
BEGI N
CONDI TI ON[ 1] :
WHEN AT START DO
$COLL_TYPE : = COLL_HI GH
$CRNT_DATA[ 1] . COLL_ENBL : = TRUE
ENDCONDI TI ON
CONDI TI ON[ 2] :
WHEN AT END DO
$CRNT_DATA[ 1] . COLL_ENBL : = FALSE
ENDCONDI TI ON
MOVE TO $CAL_SYS
CYCLE

MOVE TO pnt 0001j
MOVE TO pnt 0002j
- - act i vat i ng t he col l i si on det ect i on f unct i onal i t y when needed onl y
MOVE LI NEAR TO pnt 0003j WI TH CONDI TI ON[ 1] , CONDI TI ON[ 2]
MOVE TO pnt 0004j
END col l i si on
Collision Detection (optional)
16-14
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
16.8.2 Enabling Collision Detection again from within a Program
To be used in the case in which Collision Detection is disabled upon DRV OFF.
PROGRAM col l i si on2
VAR pnt 0001j , pnt 0002j , pnt 0003j , pnt 0004j : J OI NTPOS FOR ARM[ 1]
BEGI N
CONDI TI ON[ 1] NODI SABLE :
WHEN EVENT 99 DO
- - enabl i ng col l i si on det ect i on upon dr i ve on ( usef ul unt i l 2. 01 sw ver si on)
$CRNT_DATA[ 1] . COLL_ENBL : = TRUE
ENDCONDI TI ON

ENABLE CONDI TI ON[ 1]

MOVE TO $CAL_SYS
- - act i vat i ng col l i si on det ect i on i n modal mode, l ow sensi t i vi t y
$COLL_TYPE : = COLL_LOW
$CRNT_DATA[ 1] . COLL_ENBL : = TRUE
CYCLE

MOVE TO pnt 0001j
MOVE TO pnt 0002j
- - i ncr easi ng t he sensi t i vi t y f or t he movement t o be moni t or ed
MOVE LI NEAR TO pnt 0003j WI TH $COLL_TYPE = COLL_HI GH
MOVE TO pnt 0004j
END col l i si on2
Collision Detection (optional)
16-15
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
16.8.3 Automatic calculation of the sensitivity thresholds
- -
- - Recal cul at es t he col l i si on sensi t i vi t y t hr eshol ds ever y del t a_t mi nut es
- - and at each GEN_OVR var i at i on.
- -
PROGRAM t hr eshol ds NOHOLD
VAR dummy : BOOLEAN
col l : I NTEGER
del t a_t : I NTEGER
ROUTI NE r u_t hr s
BEGI N
- - Cal cul at es t he col l i si on t hr eshol ds f or ARM 1, ' col l ' sensi t i vi t y t ype and
- - acqui r es dat a f or 120 seconds.
ARM_COLL_THRS( 1, col l , 120)
END r u_t hr s

BEGI N
- - Var i abl e t o keep t he pr ogr amact i ve
dummy : = FALSE
- - Type of sensi t i vi t y f or whi ch t he t hr eshol ds r ecal cul at i on i s asked
col l : = COLL_USER3
- -
- - Def i nes a del t a t i me t o r ecal cul at e t he t hr eshol ds
- -
del t a_t : = 60000 * 10 - - each 10 mi ns

CONDI TI ON[ 1] NODI SABLE :
- -
- - Recal cul at es t he t hr eshol ds i f GEN_OVR changes
- -
WHEN EVENT 85 DO
$TI MER[ 1] : = 0
r u_t hr s
ENDCONDI TI ON

CONDI TI ON[ 2] :
- -
- - Recal cul at es t he t hr eshol ds at t he t i meout .
- -
WHEN $TI MER[ 1] > del t a_t DO
$TI MER[ 1] : = 0
ENABLE CONDI TI ON[ 2]
r u_t hr s
ENDCONDI TI ON

ENABLE CONDI TI ON[ 1]
ENABLE CONDI TI ON[ 2]

- - Cal cul at es t he st ar t t hr eshol ds
r u_t hr s
- - Keeps t he pr ogr amact i ve
WAI T FOR dummy
END t hr eshol ds
Collision Detection (optional)
16-16
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
16.8.4 Updating of thresholds in cold robot/warmed robot mode
PROGRAM col l i si on NOHOLD, STACK = 2048
CONST ks_sw_r el = ' 02. 08b ' - - Ver si on I ndex
CONST ks_sw_dat e = ' 03. 06. 06' - - dat e of t he l ast modi f i cat i on
CONST ki _i dx_num_col l i si on = 100 - - al l owed col l i si on number
CONST ks_moni t or _f i l e_name = ' TD: \ \ moni t or _col l . t xt '
CONST ks_ol d_moni t or _f i l e_name = ' TD: \ \ Ol d_moni t or _col l . t xt '
CONST ki _num_ar m= 1 - - ar mnumber
VAR
- - SAVED GLOBAL VARS
vb_st ar t , vb_save, vb_comm, vb_t i me_out , vb_r ob_move : BOOLEAN
vb_syst em_per cent , vb_r i d, vb_cl ear _al l : BOOLEAN
vi _dat a_f i ne, vi _vt _a, vi _vt _b : I NTEGER
wb_det _col l : ARRAY[ ki _i dx_num_col l i si on] OF BOOLEAN
wb_det _col l _col d : ARRAY[ ki _i dx_num_col l i si on] OF BOOLEAN
vi _per _mi n : I NTEGER - - EXPORTED FROM col l i si on
wi _col l _col d : ARRAY[ ki _i dx_num_col l i si on, 6] OF I NTEGER - - EXPORTED FROM
col l i si on
wi _col l _hot : ARRAY[ ki _i dx_num_col l i si on, 6] OF I NTEGER - - EXPORTED FROM
col l i si on

- - NO SAVED GLOBAL VARS
vb_col l _col d, vb_st andby, vb_t i _out : BOOLEAN NOSAVE
vi _numci cl i , vi _col l _i dx, vi _ci cl o, vi _t empoci cl oi nsec : I NTEGER NOSAVE
ws_comment o : ARRAY[ 10] OF STRI NG[ 100] NOSAVE
wi _pr ev_col l : ARRAY[ 6] OF I NTEGER NOSAVE

CONST
ki _max_ci cl i = 50 - - number of cycl es bef or e del et i ng t he moni t or f i l e
ki _t empo_at t esa = 1800 - - r obot wai t i ng t i me bef or e st ar t i ng wi t h a new cycl e
( i n
- - mi l l i seconds, set t o 30 mi nut es
ki _t empo_t i me_out = 5000 - - not movi ng r obot t i me ( i n ms, set t o 5 mi n)
ki _t empo_at t i va_col l _col d = 300000 - - col l i si on swap t i me war mt o col d
- - ( i n ms, set t o 5 mi n)

- - i f TRUE, t he comput ed t hr eshol ds ar e r educed by t he syst emsof t war e
kb_r i duzi one_sw = FALSE

- - DI CHI ARAZI ONE DI I NPUT
ki _sdout _dr i ve_on = 9 - - mot or s on
ki _sdout _sel _manu = 112 - - manual sel ect or
ki _sdout _move_esec = 99 - - mot i on i n pr ogr ess
ki _sdout _st andby = 97 - - r obot i n st andby
ki _sdout _al l ar me_col l i si on = 137 - - col l i si on al ar m
ki _sdout _col l i si on_det ect ed = 138 - - occur r ed col l i si on

ki _no_move = 3 - - val ue speci f yi ng not movi ng r obot

- - Condi t i on decl ar at i on
ki _cond_check_al l ar m= 1 - - Robot Al ar mCondi t i on decl ar at i on
Collision Detection (optional)
16-17
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
ki _cond_t i me_out = 2 - - Not movi ng r obot Condi t i on decl ar at i on
ki _cond_r ob_move = 3 - - Movi ng r obot Condi t i on decl ar at i on
ki _cond_r ob_st op = 4 - - Robot i n st andby st at e Condi t i on decl ar at i on
ki _cond_ch_abi l i t a = 17 - - Act i ve Pr ogr amCondi t i on decl ar at i on

- - Ti mer decl ar at i on
ki _t i mer _t empo_ci cl o = 1 - - Cycl e t i me cal cul at i on t i mer
ki _t i mer _t i me_out = 2 - - Ti me- out cal cul at i on t i mer

ki _col l _det ect = 5 - - $col l _t ype Cal cul at ed Col l i si on
ki _col l _act ual = 6 - - $col l _t ype War mCol l i si on
ki _col l _basse = 7 - - $col l _t ype Col d Col l i si on
ki _col l _df l t = 10 - - $col l _t ype def aul t Col l i si on


- - Expor t ed r out i nes
ROUTI NE r u_col l i si on_st ar t ( ai _col l : I NTEGER) EXPORTED FROM col l i si on
ROUTI NE r u_col l i si on_end EXPORTED FROM col l i si on
ROUTI NE r u_ver EXPORTED FROM col l i si on

- - I nt er nal r out i nes
- - ROUTI NE r u_col l i si on_l ow - - EXPORTED FROM col l i si on
- - ROUTI NE r u_check_var - - EXPORTED FROM col l i si on
- - ROUTI NE r u_check_col l - - EXPORTED FROM col l i si on
- - ROUTI NE r u_moni t or _col l i si on - - EXPORTED FROM col l i si on
- - ROUTI NE r u_r i d_asse( num_asse, per c_r i d : I NTEGER) - - EXPORTED FROM col l i si on
- - ROUTI NE r u_agg_col l _col d - - EXPORTED FROM col l i si on
- - ROUTI NE r u_swap_col l i si on - - EXPORTED FROM col l i si on
- - ROUTI NE r u_cl ear _col l - - EXPORTED FROM col l i si on
- - ROUTI NE r u_l eggi - - EXPORTED FROM col l i si on
- -
- - r u_ver
- -

ROUTI NE r u_ver
BEGI N
WI N_SET_CRSR( 5, 3, ' CRT: ' ) ; WI N_SET_CRSR( 5, 1, ' TP: ' )
WI N_CLEAR( WI N_CLR_ALL, ' CRT: ' ) ; WI N_CLEAR( WI N_CLR_ALL, ' TP: ' )
WRI TE LUN_CRT ( ' Pr ogr amCALCOLO COLLI SI ON C4G ver si on: ' , ks_sw_r el , NL)
WRI TE LUN_TP ( ' Pr og. CALC. COLLI SI ON C4G ver s. : ' , ks_sw_r el , NL)
WI N_SET_CRSR( 6, 3, ' CRT: ' ) ; WI N_SET_CRSR( 6, 1, ' TP: ' )
WRI TE LUN_CRT ( ' Last modi f . dat e: ' , ks_sw_dat e)
WRI TE LUN_TP ( ' Last modi f . dat e: ' , ks_sw_dat e)
END r u_ver
- -
- - r u_cl ear _col l
- -
ROUTI NE r u_cl ear _col l
VAR vi _f or _3 : I NTEGER
BEGI N
I F vb_cl ear _al l = TRUE THEN
FOR vi _f or _3 : = 1 TO ki _i dx_num_col l i si on DO
wb_det _col l _col d[ vi _f or _3] : = FALSE
ENDFOR
SYS_CALL( ' MS' , ' UD: \ \ COLLI SI ON' , ' Y' )
vi _vt _b : = 0
Collision Detection (optional)
16-18
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
ENDI F
vb_cl ear _al l : = FALSE
END r u_cl ear _col l

- -
- - r u_check_col l
- -
ROUTI NE r u_check_col l
VAR l i _i : I NTEGER
BEGI N
I F ( vb_col l _col d = TRUE) AND ( wb_det _col l _col d[ vi _col l _i dx] = FALSE) THEN
I F wb_det _col l [ vi _col l _i dx] = FALSE THEN
ws_comment o[ 1] : = ' COLD COLLI SI ON NOT CALCULATED'
ELSE
wb_det _col l _col d[ vi _col l _i dx] : = TRUE
FOR l i _i : = 1 TO 6 DO
I F $ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _det ect , l i _i ] < 1 THEN
wb_det _col l _col d[ vi _col l _i dx] : = FALSE
ws_comment o[ 9] : = ' COLD COLLI SI ON OUT OF RANGE'
ELSE
I F $ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _det ect , l i _i ] > 30 THEN
wi _col l _col d[ vi _col l _i dx, l i _i ] : =
ROUND( $ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _det ect , l i _i ] - 20)
ELSE
wi _col l _col d[ vi _col l _i dx, l i _i ] : =
ROUND( $ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _det ect , l i _i ] )
ENDI F
wi _col l _hot [ vi _col l _i dx, l i _i ] : = wi _col l _col d[ vi _col l _i dx, l i _i ]
wb_det _col l [ vi _col l _i dx] : = FALSE
ENDI F
ENDFOR
ENDI F
ELSE
I F wb_det _col l [ vi _col l _i dx] THEN
FOR l i _i : = 1 TO 6 DO
I F $ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _det ect , l i _i ] < 1 THEN
wb_det _col l [ vi _col l _i dx] : = FALSE
ws_comment o[ 9] : = ' COLLI SI ON OUT OF RANGE'
ELSE
I F $ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _det ect , l i _i ] > wi _col l _hot [ vi _col l _i dx,
l i _i ] + 3 THEN
wi _col l _hot [ vi _col l _i dx, l i _i ] += 2
ELSE
I F $ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _det ect , l i _i ] < wi _col l _hot [ vi _col l _i dx,
l i _i ] THEN
wi _col l _hot [ vi _col l _i dx, l i _i ] : =
ROUND( $ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _det ect , l i _i ] )
ENDI F
ENDI F
I F wi _col l _hot [ vi _col l _i dx, l i _i ] > 30 THEN
wi _col l _hot [ vi _col l _i dx, l i _i ] - = wi _col l _hot [ vi _col l _i dx, l i _i ] *
vi _vt _a DI V 100
ENDI F
ENDI F
ENDFOR
ENDI F
ENDI F
Collision Detection (optional)
16-19
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
END r u_check_col l
- -
- - r u_check_var
- -
ROUTI NE r u_check_var
VAR l i _f or _1, l i _f or _2, l i _i : I NTEGER
BEGI N
vb_st ar t : = FALSE
vb_r i d : = FALSE
I F NOT FL_STATE( ' uD: col l i si on. var ' ) THEN
vi _ci cl o : = 0
vi _numci cl i : = ki _max_ci cl i + 1
vb_cl ear _al l : = TRUE
ENDI F
I F VAR_UNI NI T( vi _per _mi n) THEN
vi _per _mi n : = 10 - - r educi ng t he comput ed val ue
ENDI F
I F VAR_UNI NI T( vb_save) THEN
vb_save : = TRUE
ENDI F
FOR l i _f or _1 : = 1 TO ki _i dx_num_col l i si on DO
FOR l i _f or _2 : = 1 TO 6 DO
I F VAR_UNI NI T( wi _col l _col d[ l i _f or _1, l i _f or _2] ) OR vb_cl ear _al l THEN
wi _col l _col d[ l i _f or _1, l i _f or _2] : = 10
ENDI F
I F VAR_UNI NI T( wi _col l _hot [ l i _f or _1, l i _f or _2] ) OR vb_cl ear _al l THEN
wi _col l _hot [ l i _f or _1, l i _f or _2] : = 10
ENDI F
I F VAR_UNI NI T( wi _pr ev_col l [ l i _f or _2] ) THEN
wi _pr ev_col l [ l i _f or _2] : = 10
ENDI F
ENDFOR
I F VAR_UNI NI T( wb_det _col l [ l i _f or _1] ) THEN
wb_det _col l [ l i _f or _1] : = FALSE
ENDI F
I F VAR_UNI NI T( vi _dat a_f i ne) THEN
vi _dat a_f i ne : = CLOCK
ENDI F
I F VAR_UNI NI T( wb_det _col l _col d[ l i _f or _1] ) THEN
wb_det _col l _col d[ l i _f or _1] : = FALSE
ENDI F
ENDFOR
I F VAR_UNI NI T( vb_cl ear _al l ) THEN
vb_cl ear _al l : = TRUE
ENDI F
FOR l i _i : = 1 TO 10 DO
ws_comment o[ l i _i ] : = ' 0'
ENDFOR

vi _vt _a : = 0

vb_syst em_per cent : = kb_r i duzi one_sw
ARM_COLL_THRS( ki _num_ar m, ki _col l _det ect , 0, vb_syst em_per cent )

- - Robot Cont r ol l er wai t i ng
Collision Detection (optional)
16-20
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
I F CLOCK > vi _dat a_f i ne + ki _t empo_at t esa THEN
WRI TE LUN_TP ( ' ROBOT I N STANDBY COLLI SI ON COLD ACTI VATED' , NL)
WRI TE LUN_CRT ( ' ROBOT I N STANDBY COLLI SI ON COLD ACTI VATED' , NL)
vb_st andby : = TRUE
ELSE
vb_st andby : = FALSE
ENDI F

vb_t i _out : = FALSE
$TI MER[ ki _t i mer _t i me_out ] : = 0
vb_col l _col d : = FALSE

- - Robot Al ar mCondi t i on
CONDI TI ON[ ki _cond_ch_abi l i t a] :
WHEN DEACTI VATE DO
vb_st ar t : = FALSE
vb_save : = TRUE
ENDCONDI TI ON
ENABLE CONDI TI ON[ ki _cond_ch_abi l i t a]

- - Rout i ne t o cal cul at e agai n al l t he col l i si ons
r u_cl ear _col l
END r u_check_var
- -
- - r u_moni t or _col l i si on
- -
ROUTI NE r u_moni t or _col l i si on
VAR l i _i , l i _l un : I NTEGER
BEGI N
- - Col l i si on moni t or i ng f i l e cr eat i on
I F FL_STATE( ks_moni t or _f i l e_name) THEN
OPEN FI LE l i _l un ( ks_moni t or _f i l e_name, ' wa' )
ELSE
OPEN FI LE l i _l un ( ks_moni t or _f i l e_name, ' wa' )
WRI TE l i _l un ( NL, NL)
WRI TE l i _l un ( ' Cycl e t i me moni t or i ng Pr ogr ami s ' , NL)
WRI TE l i _l un ( ' Col l i si on sensi t i vi t y ' , NL)
WRI TE l i _l un ( ' cr eat ed on , ' , DATE, ' , VERS. 2- 8 , SEVEL' , NL)
WRI TE l i _l un ( NL, NL)
ENDI F

WRI TE l i _l un ( NL, NL)
WRI TE l i _l un ( ' COLL_USER' , vi _col l _i dx, NL)
FOR l i _i : = 1 TO 10 DO
I F ws_comment o[ l i _i ] = ' 0' THEN
ELSE
WRI TE l i _l un ( ws_comment o[ l i _i ] , NL)
ENDI F
ENDFOR
WRI TE l i _l un ( ' Col l i si on enabl ed: ' , $CRNT_DATA[ ki _num_ar m] . COLL_ENBL,
$COLL_TYPE, NL)
FOR l i _i : = 1 TO 6 DO
WRI TE l i _l un ( $ARM_DATA[ ki _num_ar m] . ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ $COLL_TYPE, l i _i ] )
Collision Detection (optional)
16-21
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
ENDFOR
WRI TE l i _l un ( NL, ' STBY : ' , vi _vt _a > 0, ' ' )
WRI TE l i _l un ( ' UTI LI ZZO RI D_ASSE: ' , vb_r i d, NL)
I F wb_det _col l [ vi _col l _i dx] THEN
WRI TE l i _l un ( ' Moni t or on : ' , DATE, NL)
WRI TE l i _l un ( ' Cycl e n=' , vi _ci cl o, NL)
WRI TE l i _l un ( ' Measur ed cycl e t i me: ' , vi _t empoci cl oi nsec, ' sec. ' , NL)
WRI TE l i _l un ( NL)
FOR l i _i : = 1 TO 6 DO
WRI TE l i _l un ( ' COLL_DETECT ax ' , l i _i , ' = ' ,
$ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _det ect , l i _i ] , NL)
ENDFOR
WRI TE l i _l un ( NL)
WRI TE l i _l un ( ' Col l i si ons r educt i on: ' , vi _per _mi n, ' % TYPE: ' ,
$COLL_TYPE, NL)
FOR l i _i : = 1 TO 6 DO
WRI TE l i _l un ( ' COLL_ACTUAL ax ' , l i _i , ' = ' , $ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ $COLL_TYPE,
l i _i ] , NL)
ENDFOR
WRI TE l i _l un ( NL)
ELSE
I F vb_col l _col d = TRUE THEN
WRI TE l i _l un ( ' Moni t or on : ' , DATE, NL)
WRI TE l i _l un ( ' Cycl e n=' , vi _ci cl o, NL)
WRI TE l i _l un ( ' Measur ed cycl e t i me: ' , vi _t empoci cl oi nsec, ' sec. ' , NL)
WRI TE l i _l un ( NL)
FOR l i _i : = 1 TO 6 DO
WRI TE l i _l un ( ' col l _f r edde ax' , l i _i , ' = ' , wi _col l _col d[ vi _col l _i dx,
l i _i ] , NL)
ENDFOR
WRI TE l i _l un ( NL)
ENDI F
ENDI F
I F wb_det _col l [ vi _col l _i dx] = FALSE THEN
FOR l i _i : = 1 TO 6 DO
WRI TE l i _l un ( wi _pr ev_col l [ l i _i ] )
ENDFOR
WRI TE l i _l un ( NL)
WRI TE l i _l un ( ' COLLI SI ON ' , ' COLL_USER' , vi _col l _i dx, ' NOT CALCULATED' )
WRI TE l i _l un ( NL)
ENDI F
CLOSE FI LE l i _l un
END r u_moni t or _col l i si on
- -
- - r u_r i d_asse
- -
ROUTI NE r u_r i d_asse( num_asse, per c_r i d : I NTEGER)
BEGI N
vb_r i d : = TRUE
I F $CRNT_DATA[ ki _num_ar m] . COLL_ENBL = TRUE THEN
I F ( $COLL_TYPE = 6) OR ( $COLL_TYPE = ki _col l _df l t ) THEN
I F $ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ $COLL_TYPE, num_asse] > 20 THEN
$ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ $COLL_TYPE, num_asse] : = $ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ $COLL_TYPE,
num_asse] - ROUND( $ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ $COLL_TYPE, num_asse] * per c_r i d DI V 100)
ENDI F
Collision Detection (optional)
16-22
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
ENDI F
ENDI F
END r u_r i d_asse
- -
- - r u_agg_col l _col d
- -
ROUTI NE r u_agg_col l _col d
VAR l i _i : I NTEGER
BEGI N
I F wb_det _col l [ vi _col l _i dx] = TRUE THEN
FOR l i _i : = 1 TO 6 DO
I F $ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _det ect , l i _i ] < wi _col l _col d[ vi _col l _i dx, l i _i ]
THEN
wi _col l _col d[ vi _col l _i dx, l i _i ] : = ROUND( $ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _det ect ,
l i _i ] )
ws_comment o[ 6] : = ' Updat ed col d col l i si ons'
ENDI F
I F $ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _det ect , l i _i ] > wi _col l _col d[ vi _col l _i dx, l i _i ]
+ 16 THEN
wi _col l _col d[ vi _col l _i dx, l i _i ] += 2
ws_comment o[ 6] : = ' Updat ed col d col l i si ons'
ENDI F
ENDFOR
ENDI F
END r u_agg_col l _col d

- -
- - r u_swap_col l i si on
- -
ROUTI NE r u_swap_col l i si on
VAR l i _i b : I NTEGER
l i _r i d : I NTEGER
BEGI N
I F wb_det _col l _col d[ vi _col l _i dx] = FALSE THEN
RETURN
ENDI F
I F ( vb_t i _out = TRUE) OR $SDOUT[ ki _sdout _al l ar me_col l i si on] THEN
FOR l i _i b : = 1 TO 6 DO
l i _r i d : = wi _col l _col d[ vi _col l _i dx, l i _i b] * 20 DI V 100
wi _pr ev_col l [ l i _i b] : = $ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _basse, l i _i b]
$ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _basse, l i _i b] : = ROUND( wi _col l _col d[ vi _col l _i dx,
l i _i b] - l i _r i d)
wi _col l _hot [ vi _col l _i dx, l i _i b] : = wi _col l _col d[ vi _col l _i dx, l i _i b]
ENDFOR
$COLL_TYPE : = ki _col l _basse
vb_col l _col d : = TRUE
ws_comment o[ 7] : = ' Col l i si ons swapped t o col d'
ENDI F
vb_t i _out : = FALSE
END r u_swap_col l i si on
- -
Collision Detection (optional)
16-23
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
- -
- - r u_l eggi
- -
ROUTI NE r u_l eggi
VAR t i pocol l : I NTEGER
BEGI N

WRI TE LUN_TP ( NL, ' Col l i si on enabl ed: ' , $CRNT_DATA[ ki _num_ar m] . COLL_ENBL, NL)
WRI TE LUN_TP ( ' UTI LI ZZO RI D_ASSE: ' , vb_r i d, NL)

t i pocol l : = $COLL_TYPE

WRI TE LUN_TP ( ' Col l i si on t ype: ' , t i pocol l , vi _col l _i dx, NL)

WRI TE LUN_TP ( ' Thr eshol d axi s 1: ' ,
$ARM_DATA[ ki _num_ar m] . ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ t i pocol l , 1] , NL)
WRI TE LUN_TP ( ' Thr eshol d axi s 2: ' ,
$ARM_DATA[ ki _num_ar m] . ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ t i pocol l , 2] , NL)
WRI TE LUN_TP ( ' Thr eshol d axi s 3: ' ,
$ARM_DATA[ ki _num_ar m] . ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ t i pocol l , 3] , NL)
WRI TE LUN_TP ( ' Thr eshol d axi s 4: ' ,
$ARM_DATA[ ki _num_ar m] . ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ t i pocol l , 4] , NL)
WRI TE LUN_TP ( ' Thr eshol d axi s 5: ' ,
$ARM_DATA[ ki _num_ar m] . ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ t i pocol l , 5] , NL)
WRI TE LUN_TP ( ' Thr eshol d axi s 6: ' ,
$ARM_DATA[ ki _num_ar m] . ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ t i pocol l , 6] , NL)

END r u_l eggi
- -
- - r u_col l i si on_l ow
- -
ROUTI NE r u_col l i si on_l ow
BEGI N
- - Col l i si on al ways act i ve, f or saf et y
$COLL_TYPE : = ki _col l _df l t
$ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _df l t , 1] : = 40
$ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _df l t , 2] : = 30
$ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _df l t , 3] : = 30
$ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _df l t , 4] : = 30
$ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _df l t , 5] : = 30
$ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _df l t , 6] : = 25
$CRNT_DATA[ ki _num_ar m] . COLL_ENBL : = TRUE
END r u_col l i si on_l ow

- -
- - r u_col l i si on_st ar t : st ar t f unct i on
- -
- - ROUTI NE r u_col l i si on_st ar t ( ai _col l , ai _t empo : I NTEGER)
ROUTI NE r u_col l i si on_st ar t ( ai _col l : I NTEGER)
VAR l i _r i d, l i _i : I NTEGER
BEGI N
Collision Detection (optional)
16-24
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108

vi _col l _i dx : = ai _col l

r u_check_var
I F PROG_STATE( ' col l i si on' ) > 0 THEN
SYS_CALL( ' pd' , ' col l i si on' )
ENDI F
I F $SDOUT[ ki _sdout _sel _manu] = OFF THEN
SYS_CALL( ' pa' , ' col l i si on' )
ENDI F
I F ( $GEN_OVR = 100) AND ( vb_st andby = FALSE) AND ( wb_det _col l [ vi _col l _i dx] =
TRUE) AND ( wb_det _col l _col d[ vi _col l _i dx] = TRUE) AND ( $SDOUT[ ki _sdout _sel _manu] =
OFF) THEN
- - War mcol l i si on enabl ed on COLL_ACTUAL and new col l i si ons cal cul at ed
ws_comment o[ 2] : = ' ROBOT COLLI SI ON HOT ACTI VATED'
FOR l i _i : = 1 TO 6 DO
l i _r i d : = wi _col l _hot [ vi _col l _i dx, l i _i ] * vi _per _mi n DI V 100
$ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _act ual , l i _i ] : = ROUND( wi _col l _hot [ vi _col l _i dx,
l i _i ] - l i _r i d)
ENDFOR
$COLL_TYPE : = ki _col l _act ual
ARM_COLL_THRS( ki _num_ar m, ki _col l _det ect , 1, vb_syst em_per cent )
$CRNT_DATA[ ki _num_ar m] . COLL_ENBL : = TRUE
vb_col l _col d : = FALSE
wb_det _col l [ vi _col l _i dx] : = TRUE
ELSE
- - Col d col l i si on act i vat ed i f an er r or occur r ed i n t he pr evi ous cycl e, and
- - war mcol l i si on cal cul at ed
ws_comment o[ 3] : = ' GEN_OVR < 100 or TI ME_OUT ROBOT COLLI SI ON COLD ACTI VATED'
I F wb_det _col l _col d[ vi _col l _i dx] = TRUE THEN
FOR l i _i : = 1 TO 6 DO
l i _r i d : = wi _col l _col d[ vi _col l _i dx, l i _i ] * 20 DI V 100
$ARM_SENSI TI VI TY[ ki _col l _basse, l i _i ] : = ROUND( wi _col l _col d[ vi _col l _i dx,
l i _i ] - l i _r i d)
ENDFOR
$COLL_TYPE : = ki _col l _basse
$CRNT_DATA[ ki _num_ar m] . COLL_ENBL : = TRUE
ELSE
r u_col l i si on_l ow
ws_comment o[ 5] : = ' Teachi ng COLL_COLD, l ow col l i si ons act i vat ed'
ENDI F
I F ( $GEN_OVR = 100) AND ( $SDOUT[ ki _sdout _sel _manu] = OFF) THEN
ws_comment o[ 4] : = ' Col l i si on aut ot each '
ARM_COLL_THRS( ki _num_ar m, ki _col l _det ect , 1, vb_syst em_per cent )
wb_det _col l [ vi _col l _i dx] : = TRUE
ELSE
wb_det _col l [ vi _col l _i dx] : = FALSE
ENDI F
vb_col l _col d : = TRUE
ENDI F
vb_st ar t : = TRUE
$TI MER[ ki _t i mer _t empo_ci cl o] : = 0
END r u_col l i si on_st ar t
- -
- - r u_col l i si on_end: end f unct i on
Collision Detection (optional)
16-25
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
- -

ROUTI NE r u_col l i si on_end
BEGI N
I F VAR_UNI NI T( vi _col l _i dx) THEN
RETURN
ENDI F

vi _t empoci cl oi nsec : = $TI MER[ ki _t i mer _t empo_ci cl o] DI V 1000

ARM_COLL_THRS( ki _num_ar m, ki _col l _det ect , 0, vb_syst em_per cent )

I F vb_st ar t = FALSE THEN
RETURN
ENDI F

vb_st ar t : = FALSE

I F VAR_UNI NI T( vi _numci cl i ) THEN
vi _numci cl i : = 0
ENDI F

I F VAR_UNI NI T( vi _ci cl o) THEN
vi _ci cl o : = 0
ENDI F

I F VAR_UNI NI T( vi _vt _b) THEN
vi _vt _b : = 1
ENDI F

I F wb_det _col l [ vi _col l _i dx] THEN
WHI LE PROG_STATE( ' col l i si on' ) > 0 DO
DELAY 50
ENDWHI LE
vi _vt _b += 1
ENDI F
vi _ci cl o += 1
vi _numci cl i += 1

I F vi _numci cl i > ki _max_ci cl i THEN
I F FL_STATE( ks_moni t or _f i l e_name) THEN
SYS_CALL( ' f d' , ks_ol d_moni t or _f i l e_name)
SYS_CALL( ' f r ' , ks_moni t or _f i l e_name, ks_ol d_moni t or _f i l e_name)
ENDI F
DELAY 300
vi _numci cl i : = 0
ENDI F

- - Recor di ng l ast cycl e t i mer
vi _dat a_f i ne : = CLOCK

- - Checki ng col l i si on cal cul at i on
r u_check_col l
- - Updat i ng col d col l i si ons i f l ower val ues
Collision Detection (optional)
16-26
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
r u_agg_col l _col d

- - Recor di ng cal cul at ed col l i si ons val ues i n t he moni t or
r u_moni t or _col l i si on

r u_col l i si on_l ow

END r u_col l i si on_end

- -
- - MAI N
- -
BEGI N
vb_comm: = FALSE
vb_st ar t : = FALSE

- - Robot Al ar mcondi t i on
CONDI TI ON[ ki _cond_check_al l ar m] :
WHEN $SDOUT[ ki _sdout _dr i ve_on] - OR ( $TI MER[ ki _t i mer _t i me_out ] >
ki _t empo_at t i va_col l _col d) DO
wb_det _col l [ vi _col l _i dx] : = FALSE
r u_swap_col l i si on
WHEN vb_st ar t = FALSE DO
ENDCONDI TI ON

- - Not movi ng r obot condi t i on
CONDI TI ON[ ki _cond_t i me_out ] :
WHEN $CRNT_DATA[ ki _num_ar m] . MOVE_STATE <= ki _no_move DO
$TI MER[ ki _t i mer _t i me_out ] : = 0
vb_t i _out : = TRUE
ENABLE CONDI TI ON[ ki _cond_r ob_move]
WHEN vb_st ar t = FALSE DO
ENDCONDI TI ON

- - Movi ng r obot condi t i on
CONDI TI ON[ ki _cond_r ob_move] :
WHEN $CRNT_DATA[ ki _num_ar m] . MOVE_STATE > ki _no_move DO
vb_t i _out : = FALSE
ENABLE CONDI TI ON[ ki _cond_t i me_out ]
WHEN $TI MER[ ki _t i mer _t i me_out ] > ki _t empo_t i me_out DO
vi _vt _a : = 15
WHEN vb_st ar t = FALSE DO
ENDCONDI TI ON

- - Robot i n St andby st at e Condi t i on decl ar at i on
CONDI TI ON[ ki _cond_r ob_st op] :
WHEN $SDOUT[ ki _sdout _move_esec] - AND ( $SDOUT[ ki _sdout _st andby] = OFF) OR
$SDOUT[ ki _sdout _st andby] + AND $SDOUT[ ki _sdout _move_esec] OR
( $TI MER[ ki _t i mer _t i me_out ] > ki _t empo_at t i va_col l _col d) AND ( vb_t i _out = TRUE) DO
wb_det _col l [ vi _col l _i dx] : = FALSE
WHEN $GEN_OVR < 100 DO
vb_comm: = TRUE
wb_det _col l [ vi _col l _i dx] : = FALSE
WHEN vb_st ar t = FALSE DO
ENDCONDI TI ON
WAI T FOR vb_st ar t
Collision Detection (optional)
16-27
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
ENABLE CONDI TI ON[ ki _cond_check_al l ar m]
ENABLE CONDI TI ON[ ki _cond_t i me_out ]
ENABLE CONDI TI ON[ ki _cond_r ob_st op]
WAI T FOR vb_st ar t = OFF
I F vb_commTHEN
ws_comment o[ 8] : = ' ROBOT I N TI ME_OUT, det ect i on f ai l ed '
ENDI F
I F $GEN_OVR < 100 THEN
ws_comment o[ 8] : = ' $GEN_OVR < 100, det ect i on f ai l ed '
ENDI F
I F vb_save OR ( vi _vt _b > 100) THEN
SYS_CALL( ' MS' , ' UD: \ \ COLLI SI ON' , ' Y' )
vb_save : = FALSE
vi _vt _b : = 0
ENDI F
DELAY 300
END col l i si on
Collision Detection (optional)
16-28
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
16.8.5 Managing " collision detected" event
Simply as an example, a program segment is given that manages the "collision
detected" event 197 .
PROGRAM col l t ouch
VAR pnt 0006p, pnt 0007p, pnt 0008p: POSI TI ON
pnt 0001p, pnt 0002p, pnt 0003p, pnt 0004p, pnt 0005p: POSI TI ON
BEGI N
CONDI TI ON[ 1] :
WHEN EVENT 94 DO
UNLOCK - - r eset f or
RESUME - - next r est ar t
.
.
.
ENDCONDI TI ON
CONDI TI ON[ 2] NODI SABLE:
WHEN EVENT 197 DO
LOCK - - l ocks t he machi ne
CANCEL CURRENT - - cancel s t he cur r ent mot i on
.
.
.
ENDCONDI TI ON
.
.
.
ENABLE CONDI TI ON[ 1]
ENABLE CONDI TI ON[ 2]
$COLL_TYPE: =COLL_USER1
$COLL_EFFECT: =2
$CRNT_DATA[ 1] . COLL_ENBL: =TRUE
CYCLE
MOVE TO . . .
.
.
.
END col l t ouch
Collision Detection (optional)
16-29
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
Collision Detection (optional)
16-30
pr-0-0-gpr_06.fm
00/0108
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-1
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
17. USE OF POSITIONERS
MANAGED BY C4G
17.1 Introduction
This chapter is addressed to the installers and maintenance engineers of the automated
cell, to supply them with the use procedures and the information needed for the
Controller software configuration so to obtain the correct management of the positioner
equipped with robot external axes.
In particular the need is underlined to carry out the positioner configuration customising
when this is not a standard product.
The positioners are divided into families, and a paragraph is dedicated to each of them.
The procedures and conventions contained in the following paragraphs are very
important to ensure the consistency of the installation and above all the correct
functioning of the system when, for example, the cooperative motion is used, i.e. the
enslavement of a robot in the position of the part to be processed mounted on the
positioner.
In any case, even with a standard positioner, the radius of the part overall
dimensions always has to be defined.
It is the responsibility of the positioner designer to check and guarantee that the
unit operates in conformity with the relevant standards. In particular it must be
verified that in the following situations:
normal use (Automatic/Programming),
emergency stop,
safety braking,
Hold,
Drive off,
impact on any mechanical pads
the unit behaves in a manner that complies with current safety standards.
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-2
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
17.2 Summary
The positioners described herein are grouped as follows:
Positioners with 1 rotating axis type MP, PTDO, PTDV, TR3000/6000
PTORB - Positioner with 2 perpendicular axes
Positioners with 2 non perpendicular axes, type PTORB-alfa
Integrated robot positioning axes
The following indications are contained for each of the above topics:
definition mode of base and flange reference systems,
how to execute the calibration and
characteristic parameters for the positioner kinematic description.
17.3 General Conventions
Conventions regarding axis rotation and mechanical location of points P1, P2 and P3 (to
calculate cooperated motion) are described, to be used for positioner models managing
two axes.
These conventions acquire importance when a cooperative motion is to be executed,
i.e. to enslave a robot to the position of the part mounted on the positioner: if they are
not followed it will not be possible to correctly measure the positioner base position by
means of the TO_SET program (see Cap. TO_SET Program).
Axis rotation directions
Convention for the mechanical positioning of points P1, P2 and P3
17.3.1 Axis rotation directions
In other words they have to follow the right-hand rule referring to the direction indicated
The following subjects:
USE of the TP4i Teach Pendant (use of the external axes configuration
software) and
USE of the TO_SET program (calculation of positioner base position),
are dealt with respectively:
in the Use of the C4G Control Unit Manual, in the paragraph Setup Page, and
in this manual, Cap. TO_SET Program
For special conventions and specifications of each positioner, see the relevant
paragraph for that particular model or family.
The directions of the positioner axis rotations cannot be chosen at will: they have
to strictly follow the convention in which the axes have a positive anticlockwise
direction (in relation to the rotation axis)..
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-3
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
in Fig. 17.1 in correspondence to the axes: pointing the thumb of the right hand in the
direction of the dashed line arrow (that represents each axis), the fingers are to close in
the positive direction of the rotating axis. For this description, the orbital positioner has
been chosen because it is particularly representative.
17.3.2 Convention for the mechanical positioning of points P1,
P2 and P3
The references for points P1, P2, P3 described in the Cap. TO_SET Program to
calculate the base of the positioners ($BASE if the positioner is an independent arm or
$AUX_BASE if it is a group of auxiliary axes) are to be mechanically positioned
according to the following convention (see . Fig. 17.1):
P1 and P3 are to be chosen along the Y
flange
axis, with positive direction from P1
to P3 (P1 in the negative part of Y
flange
and P3 in the positive part);
The origin of the flange reference O
flange
is to coincide with the mean point of
segment P1-P3;
P2 is to be chosen so that the segment between O
flange
and P2 is perpendicular to
P1-P3.
Fig. 17.1 - Mechanical positioning of P1, P2 and P3
1. axis 1
2. axis 2
X
b
, Y
b
, Z
b
, O
b
=X
base
, Y
base
, Z
base
, O
base
X
f,
Y
f
, Z
f,
O
f
=X
flange
, Y
flange
, Z
flange
, O
flange
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-4
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
17.4 Programming override value calculation
To comply with the safety standards in force for robots and positioners, a configuration
tool is provided on the TP4i/WiTP Teach Pendant (SETUP page, AUX_AXES
sub-page). This calculates the speed value in manual mode.
The following formula is used:
where:
250 =maximum speed allowed as per standard [mm/s]
955 =numeric conversion factor
Rt =motor transmission ratio [Mt/axt]
Vm =motor maximum speed [Rpm]
r =part overall dimension radius [mm]
17.5 Positioners with 1 rotating axis type MP,
PTDO, PTDV, TR3000/6000
17.5.1 Definition of the reference system
The reference system for the lathe positioner flange (bearing plate) is defined according
to the following conventions (see Fig. 17.2):
the flange reference system origin (O
flange
) lays on the surface of the flange
coinciding with the positioner axis rotation centre;
the Z
flange
axis is to be perpendicular to the flange surface with outward direction.
MAXIMUM PROGRAMMING SPEED
It is very important that the calculation is made with extreme accuracy, so as to
meet the requirements of current safety standards. If parts are machined that
have very different dimensions, the worst case is to be used for the calculation
(part maximum overall dimensions).
The override value is inserted with the configuration tool.
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-5
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
Fig. 17.2 - Definition of the reference system
1 axis 1
X
f
, Y
f
=X
flange
, Y
flange
Note the convention that concerns points P1, P2, P3 described in the Cap. TO_SET
Program for the $BASE (or $AUX_BASE) calculation of the positioners.
Note also how the axis has an anticlockwise direction of rotation to comply with the
right-hand rule convention (see Axis rotation directions).
17.5.2 Calibration
The lathe positioner does not require special rules for the calibration position.
17.5.3 Kinematic description
For these types of positioners no value has to be inserted regarding the length of the
axes.
On the other hand, when programming, it is necessary to calculate the speed to be
attributed to the positioner axis, according to the dimension of the part that is mounted
on the bearing plate, so that the maximum tangential speed does not exceed 250 mm/s
(see standards in force). Therefore it is necessary first of all to measure the maximum
radius r of the part to be machined, as indicated in Fig. 17.3.
If, operating with the Teach Pendant, the controlled axis moves in the opposite
direction to this rule, the transmission ratio sign must be changed using the
TP4i/WiTP Teach Pendant
To configure these positioners, see the USE of C4G Control Unit Manual, Setup
Page, paragraph AUX_AXES.
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-6
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
Fig. 17.3 - Part maximum radius measurement
1. Part to be machined
2. Lathe bearing plate
Next, the configuration software, on the TP4i/WiTP Teach Pendant, calculates the
manual mode speed value.
A table summarising the mechanical data to be entered is shown below, assuming that
the positioner is axis 7.
17.6 PTORB - Positioner with 2 perpendicular
axes
Positioner with two tilting-rotating axes
Positioner with two axes in "L" arrangement
17.6.1 Positioner with two tilting-rotating axes
17.6.1.1 Definition of the reference system
The positioner base reference system is defined by the following conventions (see
Fig. 17.4):
For very long lathes, it is possible to mount the robot on an SCP slide or CRP
column integrated axis; in this case the integrated axis will be axis 7, whereas the
lathe will become axis 8
OPTION AXIS VALUE
Axis length [mm] 7 /
Type of axis 7 ROTATING
Axis offset [mm] 7 /
Programmed speed override 7 X
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-7
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
the origin of the positioner base reference system (O
base
) lays on the bearing
surface (typically the floor);
the Z
base
axis is perpendicular to the bearing surface and in upward direction;
the X
base
axis lays on the bearing surface with direction parallel to the positioner
first rotation axis;
the Y
base
axis is therefore on the resting surface perpendicular to the positioner first
rotation axis.
The positioner flange reference system is defined according to these conventions (see
Fig. 17.4):
the origin of the flange reference system (O
flange
) lays on the flange surface that
coincides with the centre of rotation of the positioner second axis;
the Z
flange
axis is perpendicular to the flange surface with outward direction.
17.6.1.2 Calibration
The calibration conventions are the following:
the first axis is to calibrate so that the Z
flange
axis is aligned to Z
base
.
the second axis is to calibrate with all the flange reference axes parallel to the
corresponding axes of the base reference; in particular Y
flange
is to be parallel to
Y
base
and have the same direction.
Also the convention should be borne in mind that concerns points P1, P2, P3 described
in the Cap. TO_SET Program to calculate $BASE (or $AUX_BASE) of the positioners
(see Fig. 17.4).
Fig. 17.4 - Definition of the reference system
1. axis 1
2. axis 2
X
f
, Y
f
=X
flange
, Y
flange
Xb, Y
b
=X
base
, Y
base
Both of these conditions are important: an approximation in relation to one of
these will jeopardise the machine precision during cooperative motion (the robot
does not hold the position on the part).
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-8
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
17.6.1.3 Kinematic description
The parameters required for the correct kinematic description of the positioner (length
of axes) are indicated in Fig. 17.5. This shows a generic positioner indicating the
dimensions that distinguish it and the PDL2 variables that contain the parameters. Note
that the model requires that axes 1 and 2 intersect (there must be no offset).
It is also necessary to calculate the speed to be attributed to the two positioner axes
being programmed, according to the dimension of the part that is mounted on the
bearing plate, so that the maximum tangential speed does not exceed the set value of
250 mm/s. Therefore it is necessary to first measure the maximum radii r1 and r2 of the
part to be machined, as indicated in Fig. 17.5.
Fig. 17.5 - Parameters for the positioner kinematic description
1. axis 1
2. axis 2
3. part to be machined
$AX_LEN[ax_logic
1
] =L
1
$AX_OFST[ax_logic
2
] =L
2
For example, for positioner formed by auxiliary axes 7 and 8:
ax_logic
1
=7 e ax_logic
2
=8
Next, the configuration software, on the TP4i/WiTP Teach Pendant, calculates the
manual mode speed value.
Two tables follow, summarising the useful mechanical data, assuming that the
positioner is handled with auxiliary axes 7 and 8 respectively.
To configure these positioners, see the USE of C4G Control Unit Manual, Setup
Page, paragraph AUX_AXES.
If the part has overall dimensions that are less than the diameter of the bearing
plate, r2 is to be equal to the radius of the bearing plate. This is to always consider
the worst case of part maximum overall dimensions or of the mechanical
structure of the positioner in motion.
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-9
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
17.6.2 Positioner with two axes in " L" arrangement
17.6.2.1 Definition of the reference system
As can be noted, the positioner base reference system is in an unusual position in
relation to the other positioners, that is to say, its origin does not lay on the bearing
surface but is displaced in correspondence to axis 2 (seen from above). This happens
because the software uses the same mathematic model of the tilting-rotating positioner
that does not support this type of offset.
The positioner base reference system is defined according to these conventions (see
Fig. 17.6):
The origin of the positioner base reference system (O
base
) lays on the level of the
bearing surface, (typically the floor) on the extension of rotation axis 2;
the Z
base
axis is perpendicular to the bearing surface and in upward direction;
the X
base
axis lays on the bearing surface with direction parallel to the first rotation
axis of the positioner;
the Y
base
axis is therefore on the bearing surface in perpendicular direction to the
first rotation axis of the positioner.
The positioner flange reference system is defined according to the following conventions
(see Fig. 17.6):
the origin of the flange reference system (O
flange
) lays on the surface of the flange
to coincide with the centre of rotation of the positioner second axis;
the Z
flange
axis is perpendicular to the flange surface with outward direction.
17.6.2.1.1 Calibration
The conventions for the calibration are as follows:
The first axis is to be calibrated so that the Z
flange
axis is aligned to Z
base
;
OPTION AXIS VALUE
Axis length [mm] 7 L
1
Axis type 7 ROTATING
Axis offset [mm] 7 /
Program speed override 7 X
1
OPTION AXIS VALUE
Axis length [mm] 8 /
Axis type 8 ROTATING
Axis offset [mm] 8 L
2
Program speed override 8 X
2
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-10
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
The second axis is to calibrate with all the flange reference axes parallel to the
corresponding base reference; in particular Y
flange
is to be parallel to Y
base
and
have the same direction.
Also the convention is to be borne in mind that concerns points P1, P2, P3 described in
Cap. TO_SET Program to calculate the $BASE (or $AUX_BASE) of the positioners (see
Fig. 17.6).
Fig. 17.6 - Definition of the reference system
1. axis 1
2. axis 2
X
b
, Y
b
, Z
b
, O
b
=X
base
, Y
base
, Z
base
, O
base
X
f
, Y
f
, Z
f
, O
f
=X
flange
, Y
flange
, Z
flange
, O
flange
17.6.2.2 Kinematic description
The parameters required for the correct kinematic description of the positioner (length
of axes) are indicated in Fig. 17.7. They show a generic positioner with the dimensions
that distinguish it and the PDL2 variables that contain the parameters. As can be seen,
Both of these conditions are important: an approximation in relation to one of
these will jeopardise the machine precision during cooperative motion (the robot
does not hold the position on the part.).
To configure these positioners, see the USE of C4G Control Unit Manual, Setup
Page, paragraph AUX_AXES.
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-11
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
a length of the arm that carries axis 2 is not available, but only the two heights; this is
possible because the positioner base reference system is centred on rotation axis 2 (see
Fig. 17.7). ). Note also that the value for L2 is to be negative to indicate that the flange
(axis 2) is lowered in relation to axis 1.
It is also necessary to calculate the speed to be attributed to the two positioner axes
being programmed, according to the size of the part mounted on the bearing plate, so
that the maximum tangential speed does not exceed the set speed of 250 mm/s. To this
purpose it is necessary first of all to measure the maximum r1 and r2 radii of the part to
be machined, as indicated in Fig. 17.7.
Fig. 17.7 - Parameters for the kinematic description of the
positioner
1. axis 1
2. axis 2
3. part to be machined
$AX_LEN[ax_logic
1
] =L
1
$AX_OFST[ax_logic
2
] =-L
2
For example, for a positioner formed by auxiliary axes 7 and 8:
ax_logic
1
=7 e ax_logic
2
=8
Next, the configuration software, on the TP4i/WiTP Teach Pendant, calculates the
manual mode speed value.
Two tables follow that summarise the useful mechanical data, assuming that the
positioner is handled with auxiliary axes 7 and 8 respectively.
If the part has overall dimensions that are less than the diameter of the bearing
plate, r2 is to be equal to the radius of the bearing plate; in the same way for r1 a
minimum value is to be used equal to r1m to take into consideration the
mechanical structure of axis 7. This is to always consider the worst case of part
maximum overall dimensions or of the mechanical structure of the positioner in
motion
OPTION AXIS VALUE
Axis length [mm] 7 L
1
Axis type 7 ROTATING
Axis offset [mm] 7 /
Program speed override 7 X
1
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-12
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
17.7 Positioners with 2 non perpendicular axes,
type PTORB-alfa
17.7.1 Definition of the reference system
The positioner base reference system is defined according to the following conventions
(see. ):
The origin of the positioner base reference system (O
base
) lays on the bearing
surface(typically the floor);
the Z
base
axis is perpendicular to the bearing surface and in upward direction;
the X
base
axis lays on the bearing surface and is perpendicular to the two axes of
the positioner;
the Y
base
axis consequently results with the direction indicated in .
The positioner flange reference system is defined according to the following conventions
(see ):
The origin of the flange reference system (O
flange
) lays on the flange surface
coinciding with the centre of rotation of the positioner second axis;
the Z
flange
axis is perpendicular to the flange surface with outward direction.
OPTION AXIS VALUE
Axis length [mm] 8 /
Axis type 8 ROTATING
Axis offset [mm] 8 -L
2
Program speed override 8 X
2
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-13
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
Fig. 17.8 - Definition of the reference systems
1. axis 1
2. axis 2
X
b
, Y
b
, Z
b
, O
b
=X
base
, Y
base
, Z
base
, O
base
X
f
, Y
f,
Z
f
, O
f
=X
flange
, Y
flange
, Z
flange
, O
flange
17.7.2 Calibration
The conventions for the calibration are as follows:
the first axis is to be calibrated so that the Z
flange
axis is parallel to Z
base
;
the second axis is to calibrate with all the flange reference axes parallel to the
corresponding ones of the base reference; in particular Y
flange
is to be parallel to
Y
base
and have the same direction.
Also the convention is to be borne in mind that concerns points P1, P2, P3 described in
the Cap. TO_SET Program to calculate the $BASE (or $AUX_BASE) of the positioners
(see Fig. 17.8).
17.7.3 Kinematic description
Both of these conditions are important: an approximation in relation to one of
these will jeopardise the machine precision during cooperative motion (the robot
does not hold the position on the part).
To configure these positioners, see the USE of C4G Control Unit Manual, Setup
Page, paragraph AUX_AXES.
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-14
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
The parameters required for the correct kinematic description of the positioner (length
of axes and angles) are shown in the Fig. 17.9. It illustrates a generic positioner
indicating the dimensions that distinguish it and the PDL2 variables that contain the
parameters.
It is also necessary to calculate the speed to be attributed to the two positioner axes
being programmed, according to the dimension of the part that is mounted on the
bearing plate, so that the maximum tangential speed does not exceed 250 mm/s.
Therefore it is necessary first of all to measure the maximum radii r1 and r2 of the part
to be machined, as indicated in the following Fig. 17.9.
Fig. 17.9 - Parameters for the kinematic description of the
positioner
1. part to be machined
$AX_LEN[ax_logic
1
] =L
1
$AX_LEN[ax_logic
2
] =L
3
$AX_OFST[ax_logic
1
] =alpha, with alpha that is not 90
$AX_OFST[ax_logic
2
] =L
2
For example, for a positioner formed by auxiliary axes 7 and 8:
ax_logic
1
=7 e ax_logic
2
=8
Next, the configuration software, on the TP4i/WiTP Teach Pendant, calculates the
manual mode speed value.
Two tables follow, summarising the useful mechanical data, assuming that the
positioner is handled with auxiliary axes 7 and 8 respectively.
If the part has overall dimensions that are less than the diameter of the bearing
plate, r2 is to be equal to the radius of the bearing plate r2m; in the same way for
r1 a minimum value is to be used equal to r1m to take into consideration the
mechanical structure of axis 7. This is to always consider the worst case of part
maximum overall dimensions or of the mechanical structure of the positioner in
motion..
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-15
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
17.8 Integrated robot positioning axes
Integrated slide
Integrated rotating column
Three linear axes portal
Two linear axes Portal
Integrated trans-rotational Column
17.8.1 Integrated slide
Regarding the configuration of a robot resting on a linear slide handled by an auxiliary
axis.
By integrated motion it is intended that the calculation of the TCP position takes into
account the position of the slide (only X axis). In other words, the slide is integrated in
the direct kinematics of the system of axes.
This has two practical effects:
The Cartesian positions (POSITION) are defined in the cell space regardless of the
linear slide axis position and therefore moving only the slide will change the
Cartesian position;
Manually moving the slide (jog) in a Cartesian reference (for example jog BASE),
the TCP position remains unchanged due to the displacement of the robot axes
that offset the displacement.
OPTION AXIS VALUE
Axis length [mm] 7 L
1
Axis type 7 ROTATING
Axis offset [mm] 7 *
Program speed override 7 X
1
Note that the absolute value of the alpha angle is to be inserted even if the
measurement unit of the axis offset is in millimetres.
OPTION AXIS VALUE
Axis length [mm] 8 L
3
Axis type 8 ROTATING
Axis offset [mm] 8 L
2
Program speed override 8 X
2
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-16
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
17.8.1.1 Definition of the reference system
The integrated slide base reference system is defined according to these conventions
(see Fig. 17.10):
The origin of the slide base reference system (O
base
) lays on the bearing surface
(typically the floor);
the Z
base
axis is perpendicular to the bearing surface and in upward direction;
the X
base
axis lays on the bearing surface and orientated in the direction of the
positive stroke;
the Y
base
axis consequently results with the direction indicated in Fig. 17.10.
The Z axis reference of the $BASE variable to the slide is not managed and therefore
this remains linked to the position of the robot base.
On the slide there is the mounting flange of the robot base that can only be positioned
standing with the base always perpendicular to the slide motion axis.
Vice-versa 4 robot base orientation positions are allowed (at 90 intervals ) in relation
to the slide base (see Fig. 17.12).
Fig. 17.10 - Definition of the reference system
1. slide base reference
2. robot base
X
bs
, Y
bs
, Z
bs
=X
base_slide
, Y
base_slide
, Z
base_slide
X
br
, Y
br
, Z
br
=X
base_robot
, Y
base_robot
, Z
base_robot
17.8.1.2 Calibration
The slide calibration position is fixed close to the negative limit of the stroke and marked
with a zero notch.
On the Teach Pendant the linear axis can be moved in Cartesian mode, using the
7+ and 7- keys and it is not possible to enable or disable the slide integration in
real time (a Controller restart is needed).
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-17
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
Since this is an integrated axis it is not treated as a positioner for the part to be machined
and therefore it is not necessary to pick up points P1, P2 and P3 described in the
Cap. TO_SET Program.
17.8.1.3 Kinematic description
The parameters needed for the correct kinematic description of the integrated slide are
indicated in Fig. 17.11.
Next, the configuration software, on the TP4i/WiTP Teach Pendant, calculates the
manual mode speed value.
A table follows summarising the useful mechanical data, bearing in mind that it is
mandatory that the integrated slide is handled with auxiliary axis 7.
Fig. 17.11 - Parameters for the kinematic description of the
integrated slide
L =slide useful stroke
X
bs
, Y
bs
, Z
bs
=X
slide_base
, Y
slide_base
, Z
slide_base
Besides the L and H geometrical data indicated above, for the complete kinematic
description of the integrated slide also the assembly angle is to be defined:
180 rotation ==>X
robot_base
in opposite direction to X
slide_base
;
0 rotation ==>X
robot_base
in the direction of X
slide_base
;
To configure these positioners, see the USE of C4G Control Unit Manual, Setup
Page, paragraph AUX_AXES.
OPTION AXIS VALUE
Axis length [mm] 7 L
Axis type 7 TRANSLATING
Axis offset [mm] 7 /
Program speed override 7 X
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-18
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
270 rotation ==>X
robot_base
in opposite direction to Y
slide_base
;
90 rotation ==>X
robot_base
in the direction of Y
slide_base
;
Fig. 17.12 - Assembly angle
X
bs
, Y
bs
=X
slide_base
, Y
slide_base
X
br
, Y
br
=X
robot_base
, Y
robot_base
17.8.2 Integrated rotating column
Regarding the configuration of a robot resting on or hanging from a lever on the rotating
column handled by an auxiliary axis .
By integrated motion it is intended that the calculation of the TCP position takes into
account the position of the column. In other words, the column is integrated in the direct
kinematics of the system of axes.
This has two practical effects:
The Cartesian positions (POSITION) are defined in the cell space regardless of the
rotating column axis position and therefore moving only the column will change the
Cartesian position;
Manually moving the column (jog) in a Cartesian reference (for example jog
BASE), the TCP position remains unchanged due to the displacement of the robot
axes that offset the lever displacement ;
17.8.2.1 Definition of the reference system
The integrated column base reference system (defined by variable $BASE) is defined
according to the following conventions (see Fig. 17.13):
The origin of the column base reference system (O
base
) lays on the bearing surface
(typically the floor);
the Z
base
axis is perpendicular to the bearing surface and in upward direction;
the X
base
axis lays on the resting surface and is oriented in the direction of the robot
cantilever in calibration position (see Fig. 17.13);
On the Teach Pendant the rotating axis can be moved in Cartesian mode, using
the 7+ and 7- keys and it is not possible to enable or disenable the column
integration in real time.
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-19
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
the Y
base
axis consequently results with the direction indicated in Fig. 17.13.
On the cantilever (lever) there is the mounting flange of the robot base that can be
arranged in two positions only: either hanging on the lever (see Fig. 17.13) or resting on
the lever (robot standing). Therefore the robot base has to be always perpendicular to
the column rotating axis.
Vice-versa 4 robot base orientation positions are allowed (at 90 intervals) in relation to
the column base, and also the positive rotation direction can be selected at will.
Fig. 17.13 - Definition of the reference system
1. column rotation
2. column base reference
3. robot base
X
b
, Y
b
, Z
b
=X
base
, Y
base
, Z
base
17.8.2.2 Calibration
The column calibration position is determined half way along the useful stroke and
marked by a zero notch.
As this is an integrated axis it is not treated as a positioner of the part to be machined
and therefore it is not necessary to find points P1, P2 and P3 described in the
Cap. TO_SET Program.
17.8.2.3 Kinematic description
The parameters needed for the column correct kinematic description are indicated in
Fig. 17.14.
It is also necessary to calculate the rotation speed to be attributed to the column being
programmed, so that the maximum tangential speed does not exceed the value of 250
mm/s (see standard in force). Therefore, first of all radius r has to be measured with
maximum robot extension, complete with tool mounted on the flange, as indicated in
Fig. 17.14.
Next, the configuration software, on the TP4i/WiTP Teach Pendant, calculates the
manual mode speed value.
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-20
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
Fig. 17.14 - Parameters for the kinematic description of the
integrated column - 1
1. column right-hand rotation
R =column radius
H =column height
X
b
, Y
b
, Z
b
=X
base
, Y
base
, Z
base
The axis is right-hand: if it is not, change the sign of the transmission ratio.
A table follows, summarising the useful mechanical data, taking into account that it is
mandatory that the integrated column is handled with auxiliary axis 7.
Besides the R and H geometrical data indicated above, for the complete kinematic
description of the integrated column, the following Boolean data also has to be defined :
an UpDown bit that indicates whether the robot is placed facing upward (TRUE) or
if it is overturned (FALSE) (as in Fig. 17.14);
two Boolean values that indicate how the robot base is oriented in relation to the
column base (this convention has been kept identical to that required for the
integrated slide, to have compatibility); in particular the convention is as follows
(see Fig. 17.15):
180 rotation - X
robot_base
in opposite direction to X
column_base
;
0 rotation - X
robot_base
in the direction of X
column_base
;
270rotation - X
robot_base
in opposite direction to Y
column_base
;
90rotation - X
robot_base
in the direction of Y
column_base
;
OPTION AXIS VALUE
(7) Axis length [mm] 7 R
(13) Axis type 7 ROTATING
(15) Axis offset [mm] 7 H
(18) Program speed override 7 X
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-21
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
Fig. 17.15 - Parameters for the kinematic description of the
integrated column - 2
X
bc
, Y
bc
=X
column_base
, Y
column_base

X
br
, Y
br
=X
robot_base
Y
robot_base
17.8.3 Three linear axes portal
The current section describes the configuration of a robot mounted on a portal
composed by three integrated linear auxiliary axes.
Integrated motion means that the TCP position calculation takes into account the portal
position (thus the three X, Y and Z axes positions) besides the robot configuration; this
implies that the portal is integrated in the direct kinematic of the axes system.
This configuration causes the following effects:
the cartesian positions (POSITION) are defined inside the cell area, independently
of the position of the portal axes, so even if the portal axes only are moved, the
cartesian position is anyway modified;
jogging (J OG) the portal axes in a cartesian reference system (e.g. BASE
referenced J OG), the TCP position is not modified, due to the robot axes
movements which compensate the portal motion.
17.8.3.1 Definition of the reference system
The base reference system of the Integrated 3 linear axes Portal is defined according to
the following conventions (see Fig. 17.16):
the origin of the reference system of the Portal Base (O
base
) lays on the bearing
surface;
From the Teach Pendant, the linear axes can be moved in cartesian mode, using
AUX A - AUX B keys (by selecting the desired axes two-by-two).
It is also allowed to move the portal by means of the JPAD keys, where each
couple of keys allows to move one of the portal axes.
For further information related to AUX A - AUX B and JPAD keys, please refer to
Use of the C4G Control Unit manual - par. 6.2.1.2 Black Keys - Chap. 6 Use of the
Teach Pendant
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-22
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
Z
base
axis is perpendicular to the bearing surface, exiting from it and oriented
according to the Z axis positive stroke;
X
base
lays on the bearing surface and is oriented according to the X axis positive
stroke;
Y
base
consequently results.
The mounting flange of the robot base is on the portal.
It is possible to configure the mounting angle of the robot base.
It is also possible to configure the axis type (X, Y e Z) for each one of the three portal
axes (please note that the first one must be axis 7 and the next axes are in sequence).
Fig. 17.16 - Definition of the reference systems
17.8.3.2 Calibration
The calibration position of the Portal, is usually defined close to the negative stroke of
each auxiliary axis, marked with a zero notch.
17.8.3.3 Kinematic description
The parameters needed for the 3 linear axes Portal kinematic description are indicated
in Fig. 17.7.
Then, the configuration software available on the Teach Pendant calculates the manual
mode speed value.
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-23
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
A table follows, summarising the useful mechanical data, taking into account that it is
mandatory that the first axis of the Portal is number 7 and the next ones are in
sequence.
Fig. 17.17 - Parameters for the kinematic description of the 3 linear
axes Portal
Besides the geometrical data indicated above, for the complete kinematic description of
To configure the 3 linear axes Portal, please also refer to the Use of the C4G Control
Unit manual, par. AUX_AXES .
OPTION AXIS VALUE
Axis length [mm] 7 L1
Axis type [Tras/Rot] 7 TRANSLATING
Axis offset [mm] 7 H
Axis type [Coord] 7 [X,Y,Z]
Axis length [mm] 8 L2
Axis type [Tras/Rot] 8 TRANSLATING
Axis type [Coord] 8 [X,Y,Z]
Axis length [mm] 9 L3
Axis type [Tras/Rot] 9 TRANSLATING
Axis type [Coord] 9 [X,Y,Z]
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-24
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
the 3 linear axes Portal, also the assembly angle of the robot base on the portal flange
is to be defined.
17.8.4 Two linear axes Portal
The current section describes the configuration of a robot mounted on a portal
composed by two integrated linear auxiliary axes.
Integrated motion means that the TCP position calculation takes into account the portal
position (thus the two XY, XZ and YZ axes positions) besides the robot configuration;
this implies that the portal is integrated in the direct kinematic of the axes system.
This configuration causes the following effects:
the cartesian positions (POSITION) are defined inside the cell area, independently
of the position of the portal axes, so even if the portal axes only are moved, the
cartesian position is anyway modified;
jogging (J OG) the portal axes in a cartesian reference system (e.g. BASE
referenced J OG), the TCP position is not modified, due to the robot axes
movements which compensate the portal motion.
17.8.4.1 Definition of the reference system
The base reference system of the Integrated 2 linear axes Portal is defined according to
the following conventions (see Fig. 17.18):
the origin of the reference system of the Portal Base (O
base
) lays on the bearing
surface;
Z
base
axis is perpendicular to the bearing surface, exiting from it and oriented
according to the Z axis positive stroke;
Y
base
lays on the bearing surface and is oriented according to the Y axis positive
stroke;
X
base
consequently results.
The mounting flange of the robot base is on the portal.
It is possible to configure the mounting angle of the robot base.
It is also possible to configure the axis type (X, Y e Z) for each one of the two Portal axes
(please note that the first one must be axis 7 and the next one is in sequence).
From the Teach Pendant, the linear axes can be moved in cartesian mode, using
AUX A - AUX B keys (by selecting the desired axes two-by-two).
For further information related to AUX A - AUX B and JPAD keys, please refer to
Use of the C4G Control Unit manual - par. 6.2.1.2 Black Keys - Chap. 6 Use of the
Teach Pendant
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-25
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
Fig. 17.18 - Definition of the reference system
17.8.4.2 Calibration
The calibration position of the Portal, is usually defined close to the negative stroke of
each auxiliary axis, marked with a zero notch.
17.8.4.3 Kinematic description
The parameters needed for the 2 linear axes Portal kinematic description are indicated
in Fig. 17.19.
Then, the configuration software available on the Teach Pendant calculates the manual
mode speed value.
A table follows, summarising the useful mechanical data, taking into account that it is
mandatory that the first axis of the Portal is number 7 and the next one is in sequence.
To configure the 2 linear axes Portal, please also refer to the Use of the C4G Control
Unit manual, par. AUX_AXES .
OPTION AXIS VALUE
Axis length [mm] 7 L1
Axis type [Tras/Rot] 7 TRANSLATING
Axis offset [mm] 7 H
Axis type [Coord] 7 [X,Y,Z]
Axis length [mm] 8 L2
Axis type [Tras/Rot] 8 TRANSLATING
Axis type [Coord] 8 [X,Y,Z]
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-26
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
Fig. 17.19 - Parameters for the kinematic description of the 2 linear
axes Portal
Besides the geometrical data indicated above, for the complete kinematic description of
the 2 linear axes Portal, also the assembly angle of the robot base on the Portal flange
is to be defined.
17.8.5 Integrated trans-rotational Column
The current section describes the configuration of a robot bearing on or hanging from a
lever on the rotating column, handled by an auxiliary axis which is, in turn, bearing on a
linear rail handled by a second auxiliary axis.
Integrated motion means that the TCP position calculation takes into account both the
column position and the position of the rail the column is bearing on, besides the robot
configuration; this implies that the trans-rotational column is integrated in the direct
kinematic of the axes system.
This configuration causes the following effects:
the cartesian positions (POSITION) are defined inside the cell area, independently
of the position of both the column axis and the rail axis, so even if the column axis
only is moved, the cartesian position is anyway modified;
jogging (J OG) the column axis in a cartesian reference system (e.g. BASE
referenced J OG), the TCP position is not modified, due to the robot axes
movements which compensate the column motion.
17.8.5.1 Definition of the reference system
The base reference system of the Trans-rotational Column is defined according to the
following conventions (see Fig. 17.20):
the origin of the reference system of the trans-rotational Column Base (O
base
) lays
on the bearing surface (which usually is the floor);
Z
base
axis is perpendicular to the bearing surface, exiting from it and oriented
upwards;
From the Teach Pendant, the rotational axis and the translational one of the rail,
can be moved in cartesian mode, using AUX A - AUX B keys.
For further information related to AUX A - AUX B and JPAD keys, please refer to
Use of the C4G Control Unit manual - par. 6.2.1.2 Black Keys - Chap. 6 Use of the
Teach Pendant
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-27
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
X
base
lays on the bearing surface and is oriented according to the rail axis positive
stroke;
Y
base
consequently results, having the direction shown in Fig. 17.20.
On the cantilever (lever) there is the mounting flange of the robot base that can be
arranged in two positions only: either hanging on the lever (see Fig. 17.20) or bearing
on the lever (robot standing). Therefore the robot base has to be always perpendicular
to the column rotating axis.
Vice-versa 4 robot base orientation positions are allowed (at 90 intervals) in relation to
the column base. Furthermore, it is also allowed to select the mounting angle of the
column base on the rail flange ( angle shown in Fig. 17.21), as well as the offset
between the rail flange and the column base (H1 in Fig. 17.21).
Fig. 17.20 - Definition of the reference system
17.8.5.2 Calibration
The Column calibration position is defined at mid-stroke, marked with a zero notch; the
Rail calibration position is usually defined close to the negative stroke of the auxiliary
axis, marked with its zero notch.
17.8.5.3 Kinematic description
The parameters needed for the Integrated trans-rotational Column complete kinematic
description are indicated in Fig. 17.21.
It is also necessary to calculate the rotational speed to be set for the Column while in
PROGR mode, so that the maximum tangential speed does not exceed the value of
250 mm/s (see standard in force). Therefore, first of all radius r has to be measured with
maximum robot extension, equipped with the tool mounted on the flange, as indicated
in Fig. 17.21.
Then, the configuration software available on the Teach Pendant calculates the manual
mode speed value.
Use of Positioners managed by C4G
17-28
hs-0-0-mot_04.fm
00/0708
A table follows, summarising the useful mechanical data, taking into account that it is
mandatory that the first axis of the Integrated trans-rotational Column is number 7 and
it is the linear axis of the Rail (the translating axis).
Fig. 17.21 - Parameters for the kinematic description of the
Integrated Trans-rotational Column
Besides the geometrical data indicated above (H2 to describe the Column height and R
to describe its Radius), for the complete kinematic description of theTrans-rotational
Column, also the following parameters have to be defined:
an UpDown bit that indicates whether the robot is placed facing upward (TRUE) or
if it is overturned (FALSE);
a Robot Mounting Angle value that indicates how the Robot base is oriented in
relation to the Column base; in particular the convention is as follows:
180 rotation - X
robot_base
in opposite direction to X
column_base
;
0 rotation - X
robot_base
in the direction of X
column_base
;
270rotation - X
robot_base
in opposite direction to Y
column_base
;
90rotation - X
robot_base
in the direction of Y
column_base
.
To configure the Trans-rotational Column, please also refer to the Use of the C4G
Control Unit manual, par. AUX_AXES .
OPTION AXIS VALUE
Axis length [mm] 7 L
Axis type [Tras/Rot] 7 TRANSLATING
Axis offset [mm] 7 H1
Axis length [mm] 8 R
Axis type [Tras/Rot] 8 ROTATIONAL
Axis offset [mm] 8 H2
TO_SET Program
18-1
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
18. TO_SET PROGRAM
18.1 Introduction
TO_SET is an environment to calculate the positioner $TOOL, $UFRAME, $AUX_BASE
values and to configure the Conveyor, in a guided and automatic manner. It is also used
to activate and execute the Payload identification (optional function) procedure.
The most important characteristics are the following:
It is completely organised in menus, and guides the operator to perform the
required steps, it displays error messages or simple "warnings"
All the messages are in 6 languages (English, Italian, French, German, Spanish,
Portuguese): when called up, TO_SET assumes the language that is currently set
in the C4G Control Unit.
It uses only the Teach Pendant with dedicated screen.
It occupies approx. 180 Kbytes in UD: and 200 Kbytes in Execution memory
This chapter contains detailed information on the following subjects:
TO_SET Activation
First screen page of TO_SET
TOOL automatic calculation
REMOTE TOOL Automatic Calculation
UFRAME automatic calculation
REMOTE UFRAME automatic calculation
Payload identification (optional function)
BASE automatic calculation for POSITIONERS (optional)
CONVEYOR TRACKING installation and configuration (optional service)
As from version 2.20 of the System Software, the TO_SET program can only be
executed on the TP4i/WiTP teach pendant . Therefore all the descriptions that
follow in this chapter refer to the TP4i/WiTP teach pendant only.
TO_SET Program
18-2
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
18.2 Activation
TO_SET is supplied on CD in01/1107 the system configuration TOOL directory and
requires these files:
TO_INST.COD (for the TO_SET installation)
TO_SET.ZIP (contains all the files needed by TO_SET)
To use it, just select the SETUP Page on the TP4i/WiTP teach pendant (see USE of
C4G Control Unit manual, Chap. USE OF THE TEACH PENDANT ) and choose
ToolFrame environment (see Fig. 18.1 - Access to the TO_SET program).
Fig. 18.1 - Access to the TO_SET program
If it should be necessary to reinstall TO_SET, there are two ways it can be done:
From TP4i/WiTP Teach Pendant
From WinC4G on Personal Computer
18.2.1 From TP4i/WiTP Teach Pendant
To reinstall TO_SET from TP4i/WiTP follow the procedure described below:
a. Select the SETUP Page and choose the Install function
As from version 2.20 of the System Software TO_SET is always present on the
Control Unit.
TO_SET Program
18-3
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
b. Select the device containing the TO_SET files
c. Select the TO_SET program
d. Confirm with ENTER
18.2.2 From WinC4G on Personal Computer
To reinstall TO_SET from a Personal Computer that has the WinC4G program installed,
TO_SET Program
18-4
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
follow the procedure described below:
a. select the directory containing the TO_SET files
b. from the WinC4G terminal, send the FilerUtilityInstall TO_INST.COD command
18.3 First screen page of TO_SET
In Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0, the MAIN MENU is displayed.
TO_SET is presented in this way, as soon as it is activated.
Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0
The screen page contains the following information:
The following detailed description illustrates the available procedures, specifically:
TOOL automatic calculation
REMOTE TOOL Automatic Calculation
UFRAME automatic calculation
TO_SET 3.02x: program name + version number
Ov:100: the value of $GEN_OVR
Ar: 1: the number of the selected ARM
Ty: Tol: type of selected movement
Using the function keys F1..F6 one of the items displayed can be selected
TOOL (F1): TOOL automatic calculation
UFRAME (F2): UFRAME automatic calculation
POSITIONER (F3): Base automatic calculation for POSITIONERS
CONVEYOR (F4): CONVEYOR installation and configuration
Exit TO_SET (F6): end of TO_SET program
After exiting from the tool it is asked if the tool is to be deleted from UD.
TO_SET Program
18-5
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
REMOTE UFRAME automatic calculation
Payload identification (optional function)
BASE automatic calculation for POSITIONERS (optional)
CONVEYOR TRACKING installation and configuration (optional service)
18.4 TOOL automatic calculation
Press key F1 of the main TO_SET menu (see Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0). to enter this
environment. Here it is possible to define the dimensions of the work tool mounted on
the robot flange. The precision of the calculation is the same as the robot, used as a
measuring instrument.
Detailed information is given on the following:
Tools needed
General characteristics
Procedure
18.4.1 Tools needed
18.4.1.1 Calibrated tool
This is a calibrated tool with known X, Y, Z measurements that will be mounted on the
robot flange for the acquisition of the reference position. As an alternative an identified
point on the work tool can be used, for which the distance from the robot flange centre
must be known and precise.
Taking as an example a Smart NH3, the calibrated tool may be :
measurement: 117 [mm]
In this case the calibrated tool is to be mounted on the robot flange in X_tool direction
and the values to be declared are : X=150, Y=0, Z=-8.
Fig. 18.3 - SMART NH3 - Calibrated tool
TO_SET Program
18-6
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
For any further information regarding the calibrated tool, see the Robot Technical
Specifications Manual.
18.4.1.2 Reference point (or master cube)
It is most important to identify a physical reference point in the environment surrounding
the robot, so as to bring the robot TCP on to this point: once with the Tool Master then
with the measuring tool. For this purpose a MASTER CUBE has been designed with a
mobile tip that when fixed in zero position can be used as the REFERENCE POINT.
The cube (or any other point taken as reference) MUST BE IN A FIXED AND STABLE
POSITION, easily accessible by the robot and positioned on the FLOOR ( if the robot is
on the floor), on the WALL (if the robot is on the wall), on the CEILING (if the robot is
suspended from the ceiling).
18.4.2 General characteristics
The TOOL MASTER can be mounted in Z_tool or in X_tool.
Position B is made possible by a threaded precision hole on the robot flange. In
this way it is possible to have the measuring tool mounted on the flange and at the
same time the tool master screwed on the flange in X_tool direction.
Possibility to calculate the tool with the robot on the FLOOR, on the WALL or
hanging from the CEILING , taking care to position the cube (or any other point
taken as reference) on the FLOOR ( if the robot is on the floor), on the WALL (if the
robot is on the wall), on the CEILING (if the robot is suspended from the ceiling).
All the robot positions on the reference, whether with tool master or with measuring
tool, are not rigid: the operator can position the TCP on the reference as desired,
according to requirements.
Possibility to calculate the tool relocation as to the robot flange centre (X, Y, Z
Tool) with three reset Euler angles (orientation nil).
Possibility to calculate (besides X, Y, Z Tool) also the rotations around X_tool and
Y_tool (<A>: Euler 1 and <E>: Euler 2) so as to fix the new Z_tool on the tool, in
the required direction and sense (see also Tool orientation calculation).
Possibility to calculate (besides X, Y, Z, A, E Tool) also the rotation around the new
Z_tool (<R>: Euler 3), so as to fix for a certain " tool plane" the direction and
sense of the X_tool and Y_Tool , rotating around the new Z_tool (see also
Tool orientation calculation).
Detailed descriptions are given below, dealing with the following subjects:
Tool orientation calculation
How to identify the "dummy reference system"
18.4.2.1 Tool orientation calculation
After calculating the dimensions of the tool to be measured (X, Y, Z Tool), with TO_SET
an orientation (A, E, R Tool) can also be fixed to the new TCP
To fix the orientation on the new TCP a known reference system is necessary.
TO_SET has defined this reference system on the "reference point" .
The "dummy reference system" is created by TO_SET when the robot is brought on
TO_SET Program
18-7
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
to the "reference point" with TOOL MASTER (Complete procedure ) and will be
assumed by the new TCP every time the robot is brought to the "reference point" with
"TOOL TO BE MEASURED" to calculate the orientation.
18.4.2.2 How to identify the " dummy reference system"
It is advised (with values of $BASE =0) to make positive and negative movements in
BASE for axis 1 (X_base), axis 2 (Y_base) and axis 3 (Z_base) .
Knowing that X_rifer =-X_base; Y_rifer =Y_base; Z_rifer =-Z_base, it is easy to identify
the direction and the sense of the "dummy reference system".
Z_tool (calculation of <A>: Euler 1; <E> Euler 2). See Fig. 18.12 - Screen page
1.8.
To associate the new Z_tool to the new TCP , it is necessary to position the new
TCP (rotating the TOOL of axes 4 and 5) until the directions of the tool that is to
assume the new Z_tool coincide with the direction and sense of Z_rifer.
Example :
Supposing that the tool is a welding torch, to obtain the new Z_tool coming out
from the torch, the torch has to be brought in perpendicular to the reference
system (the same direction as Z_rifer), so that Z_rifer is assumed as Z_tool
coming out from the torch.
X_tool and Y_tool (calculation <R>: Euler 3). See Fig. 18.13 - Screen page 1.9.
To associate the new X_tool and Y_tool to the new TCP of the tool, position the
new TCP (rotating in TOOL of axis 6) until the directions of the tool that is to
assume the new X_tool and Y_tool coincide with the direction and sense of
X_rifer and Y_rifer respectively.
Example:
Supposing that the tool is a welding torch, to obtain the new X_tool orientated
according to the "torch plane" identified between the torch and the mounting
bracket, this plane has to be oriented until it coincides with X_rifer direction, so
that X_rifer is assumed as X_tool, associated to the "torch plane". The same is
valid when referring to the Y_tool.
18.4.3 Procedure
To access the procedure, press key F1 in Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0.
If the TOOL command is sent (pressing key F1) a second screen is shown that asks
the user to select either local tool or remote tool :
TO_SET Program
18-8
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.4 - Screen page 1.0
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.5 - Screen page 1.1
At this point the table that contains all the tools that already exist is scanned to check
which of these conditions applies:
The tool number entered corresponds to an empty position in the table, therefore
the tool calculation proceeds with one of the two methods (Fig. 18.6 - Screen page
1.2)
The tool entered already exists in the table , therefore the measurement and the
method previously used for the calculation are displayed (Fig. 18.7 - Screen page
1.3).
As can be seen, in the same file there may be tools calculated with the standard method
(without acquired positions) and tools calculated with the new procedure that also
associates the acquired positions to the tool measurement , it will therefore be the task
of the user to ascertain that the file tt_tool1.var in UD: is the correct one, containing the
<F1>: executes LOCAL TOOL ; a second screen page is accessed
(Fig. 18.5 - Screen page 1.1) that asks the user to insert the
number of the tool to be measured or checked
<F2>: executes REMOTE TOOL(see. par REMOTE TOOL Automatic
Calculation)
<F6>: returns to main menu (see Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-9
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
tool to be checked.
Fig. 18.6 - Screen page 1.2
Accepted commands:
If the Tool already exists in the table, Fig. 18.7 - Screen page 1.3 is shown.
Fig. 18.7 - Screen page 1.3
Accepted commands:
<F1>: executes Tool calculation with standard method- Complete
procedure; access given to screen page 1.4 (in Fig. 18.8 - Screen
page 1.4)
<F2>: executes Tool verification with standard method - Partial
procedure; access given to screen page 1.6 (in Fig. 18.10
- Screen page 1.6)
<F3>: executes Tool Calculation with "4 points method" - Complete
procedure; access given to screen page 1.17 (in Fig. 18.21
- Screen page 1.17)
<F4>: activates the Payload identification (optional function)
<F6>: returns to main menu (see Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-10
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
The following description gives details of each possible procedure for the Local Tool :
Tool calculation with standard method- Complete procedure
Tool Calculation with "4 points method" - Complete procedure
Tool verification with standard method - Partial procedure
Payload identification (optional function)
18.4.4 Tool calculation with standard method- Complete
procedure
The procedure is accessed by pressing key F1, Fig. 18.6 - Screen page 1.2.
When to execute the procedure:
The complete procedure can be used to store in UD: the scan result position and the
declared tool master values in TO_SET.VAR .
This procedure only has to be executed once. All the subsequent calculations of a tool
mounted on the robot flange will only require the Partial procedure (F2 from screen
page 1.2 of Fig. 18.6 - Screen page 1.2).
Fig. 18.8 - Screen page 1.4
Calls the attention of the operator to the Tool Master measurements. It displays them
<F1>: tool verification; there are two possibilities:
when the standard method is used access is given to partial procedure
screen page 1.6 (in Fig. 18.10 - Screen page 1.6),
when the 4-points method is used , access is given to screen page 1.17 (in
Fig. 18.21 - Screen page 1.17)
<F2>: executes a new calculation then returns to screen page 1.2 (in Fig. 18.6 - Screen
page 1.2)
<F3>: passes to the execution of Payload identification (optional function)
<F6>: returns to main menu (see Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
If it is the very first time that an automatic calculation of the tool is executed;
If the reference point or the robot has been moved;
If the robot has been recalibrated.
TO_SET Program
18-11
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
and allows modification, if necessary.
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.9 - Screen page 1.5
Asks to take the TCP in the Tool Master on the reference, with the relevant
measurements correctly defined (Fig. 18.8 - Screen page 1.4).The robot may be in any
position: the operator can position the TCP on the reference as preferred, according to
requirements.
At this moment it is advisable to move in TOOL of axes 4, 5, 6 to check the dimensions
of the tool master and the robot calibration.
Accepted commands:
18.4.5 Tool verification with standard method - Partial procedure
To have access to this procedure press key F1 from Fig. 18.7 - Screen page 1.3 or key
F3 from Fig. 18.6 - Screen page 1.2.
When to execute:
With the partial procedure the measurements of the tool mounted on the robot flange
can be calculated . It is only possible to calculate the relocations (X,Y,Z); or continue in
the calculation of the rotations (<A>: Euler 1; <E>: Euler 2) and lastly it is possible to
calculate the rotation around the new Z- tool (<R>: Euler 3).
<F1>: continues the procedure (see Fig. 18.9 - Screen page 1.5)
<F2>: changes tool master values (see Fig. 18.17 - Screen page 1.13)
<F6>: returns to main menu (see Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
<F1>: to be pressed when the robot is on the point; continues
procedure (Fig. 18.10 - Screen page 1.6)
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
Only if the Complete procedure has been executed at least once.
TO_SET Program
18-12
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.10 - Screen page 1.6
Asks to bring the TCP to the tool to be measured on the reference point.
The robot may be in any position: the operator can position the TCP on the reference
as preferred, according to requirements.
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.11 - Screen page 1.7
Displays the $TOOL calculated values (XYZ relocations and AER orientations).
It is then possible to move axes 4,5,6 in TOOL to check that the new TCP does not
move on the reference (movements of approx. 3 millimetres are accepted).
If this is not so, check:
robot calibration;
tool master dimensions declared in the Complete procedure ;
position of the reference point (not changed as to the Complete procedure ). After
checking, repeat the procedure (Complete or Partial).
Accepted commands:
<F1>: to be pressed when the robot is on the point; continues
procedure (Fig. 18.11 - Screen page 1.7)
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-13
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.12 - Screen page 1.8
The operator has to position the Z_TOOL (positive sense ) of the tool parallel to a drive
shaft of the robot BASE . To choose the required direction just press one of the function
keys (F2..F4) and then F1 to accept the measurement.
If the tool axes are parallel to the flange reference set of three ($TOOL(0)), it is best to
bring the robot to calibration position; the advantage of this operation is that it brings all
three tool axes parallel to those of the BASE with no further movements of the robot.
To complete the orientation calculation the operator only has to use the appropriate
function keys to select to which BASE drive shafts the Z_TOOL and then the X_TOOL
are parallel.
Check that the new orientation is that actually wished for, and if necessary repeat the
procedure ( <F3>from screen page 1.9 in Fig. 18.13 - Screen page 1.9).
Accepted commands:
<F1>: continues the procedure (Fig. 18.12 - Screen page 1.8)
<F2>: saves calculated values (Fig. 18.16 - Screen page 1.12 or
remains Fig. 18.11 - Screen page 1.7)
<F3>: repeats procedure: (returns to Fig. 18.10 - Screen page 1.6)
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0).
See paragraph on Tool orientation calculation.
<F1>: to be pressed when orientation has been completed; continues
procedure (Fig. 18.13 - Screen page 1.9)
<F2>: directs the Z_TOOL in relation to +X_BASE or -X_BASE
<F3>: directs the Z_TOOL in relation to +Y_BASE or -Y_BASE
<F4>: directs the Z_TOOL in relation to +Z_BASE or -Z_BASE
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0).
TO_SET Program
18-14
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.13 - Screen page 1.9
Displays the $TOOL calculated values (XYZ relocations and AER orientations).
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.14 - Screen page 1.10
The operator has to direct the X_TOOL (positive sense) of the tool parallel to one of the
drive shafts of the robot BASE (the axis selected in the previous step is no longer
available). To choose the desired direction just press one of the function keys (F2..F5)
and then F1.
Check that the new orientation is that actually required, and if necessary repeat the
procedure ( <F3>from screen page 1.11 in Fig. 18.15 - Screen page 1.11).
Accepted commands:
<F1>: continues the procedure (Fig. 18.14 - Screen page 1.10)
<F2>: saves calculated values (Fig. 18.16 - Screen page 1.12 or remains in
Fig. 18.13 - Screen page 1.9)
<F3>: repeats the procedure; (returns to Fig. 18.12 - Screen page 1.8)
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0).
<F1>: to be pressed when orientation has been completed; continues
procedure (Fig. 18.13 - Screen page 1.9)
<F2>: directs the X_TOOL in relation to +X_BASE
TO_SET Program
18-15
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.15 - Screen page 1.11
Displays the $TOOL calculated values (XYZ relocations and AER orientations).
Accepted commands:
After every Save operation, if there are already Euler angles in the table, the following
screen page is displayed:
Fig. 18.16 - Screen page 1.12
This displays the $TOOL calculated values (XYZ relocations and AER orientations) and
warns that there are already Euler angles in the table . It is asked if they are to be kept
(F1) or to be overwritten with the new values (F2). This makes it possible to keep the
Euler angles if it is only required to recalculate the tool relocations.
<F3>: directs the X_TOOL in relation to -X_BASE
<F4>: directs the X_TOOL in relation to +Y_BASE
<F5>: directs the X_TOOL in relation to -Y_BASE
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0).
<F1>: returns to Fig. 18.6 - Screen page 1.2
<F2>: saves calculated values (Fig. 18.16 - Screen page 1.12 or
remains in Fig. 18.15 - Screen page 1.11)
<F3>: repeats the procedure (returns to Fig. 18.14 - Screen page 1.10)
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0).
TO_SET Program
18-16
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.17 - Screen page 1.13 displays the TOOL MASTER values (XYZ relocations)
and allows their modification.
Fig. 18.17 - Screen page 1.13
Accepted commands:
The screen page in Fig. 18.18 - Screen page 1.14 displays whether a Partial procedure
has been requested without ever having executed a Complete procedure. This means
that the master reference position is missing (check TO_SET.VAR).
If the answer is OK, the system returns to the screen page shown in Fig. 18.9 - Screen
page 1.5.
Fig. 18.18 - Screen page 1.14
Accepted commands:
The screen page in Fig. 18.19 - Screen page 1.15 displays whether the SAVE
procedure for the calculated values has been omitted.
<esc>: to omit the insertion of each separate value
<F1>: returns to Fig. 18.6 - Screen page 1.2
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-17
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.19 - Screen page 1.15
Accepted commands:
18.4.6 Tool Calculation with " 4 points method" - Complete
procedure
To access this procedure, press key F3 of screen page 1.2 in Fig. 18.6 - Screen page
1.2.
This procedure brings the TCP to a visible reference point within the robot working
space, with at least three different orientations and acquires the relevant positions (see
Fig. 18.20 - Points acquisition).
Fig. 18.20 - Points acquisition
1. acquisition point 3
2. acquisition point 2
3. acquisition point 1
4. reference
Follow these steps:
a. Bring the TCP on the reference point
<F1>: repeats Save
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-18
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
b. Acquire point 1
c. Bring the TCP back to the reference point with a sufficiently different orientation
as to the previous point
d. Acquire point 2
e. Execute steps c. and d. again to acquire point 3
f. If the TCP measurement is possible, the user is given an evaluation of the
acquisition procedure accuracy (and not the tool measurement precision) with the
possibility to accept the measurement supplied and continue with the orientation
calculation (step j.) or to continue with the acquisition of points with the possibility
to move the robot in Tool mode (step g.)
g. Bring the TCP back to the reference point with a sufficiently different orientation
as to the previous points
h. Acquire new point (max. 8 points )
i. Execute step f. again
j. End of points acquisition : it is possible to continue with the orientation calculation,
repeat the calculation of X, Y and Z, return to main menu.
As from the acquisition of point 3, the tool calculation algorithm is sent, since if the
acquired points are independently linear, the three X, Y and Z coordinates are obtained
in output that permit the definition of the TCP.
As mentioned in the procedure description, together with the TCP measurement , the
user is given an evaluation of the acquisition procedure accuracy (this assesses the
standard deviation, acquired points dispersion index). The two evaluation classes may
be : imprecise measure and good measure. If the measurement is imprecise it is
necessary to continue with the acquisition of a new point, whereas the procedure is
considered completed when the measurement is good. If the acquisition of the eighth
point is reached without obtaining a good measurement of the tool, the procedure has
to be repeated from the start.
Continuing with the description of the user interface, once the tool calculation
environment is entered with the 4 points method, the following screen page is displayed:
Fig. 18.21 - Screen page 1.17
The user moves the TCP on the reference and confirms the acquisition by pressing key
TO_SET Program
18-19
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
F1 of the Teach Pendant .
It is possible to interrupt the tool calculation at any time and to return to the main menu
by pressing key F6.
For the acquisition of the next points the screen page is the same as the previous one.
As soon as a first tool measurement is ready, a screen page is shown to inform the user
that as from this moment it is possible to move in TOOL reference.
Continuing, the following situations may take place:
If the calculation algorithm returns an imprecise tool measurement the following
screen page is shown (Fig. 18.22 - Screen page 1.19a):
Fig. 18.22 - Screen page 1.19a
Accepted commands:
If the calculation algorithm returns a tool good measurement the following screen
page is shown (Fig. 18.23 - Screen page 1.19b):
Fig. 18.23 - Screen page 1.19b
<F1>: continues to acquire a new point (Fig. 18.21 - Screen page 1.17)
<F2>:
accepts the calculated tool and continues according to the mode
described in Fig. 18.11 - Screen page 1.7 (the calculation
procedure for the Euler angles remains unchanged ), bearing in
mind that the calculated tool is not precise!
TO_SET Program
18-20
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
If F1 is pressed , the calculated TCP coordinates are displayed and from this point
onwards the user proceeds according to the modes described in Fig. 18.11
- Screen page 1.7.
If the user has acquired 8 points and the algorithm has not been able to calculate
the tool, even with an imprecise measurement, this means that the acquired
points are imprecise or are dependently linear (see Fig. 18.24 - Screen page
1.19c).
The more diversified the orientation of the acquired points, the better the results!
Fig. 18.24 - Screen page 1.19c
Accepted commands:
18.4.6.1 Local Tool verification with " 4 points method"
This is accessed by pressing key F1 from screen page 1.3 (Fig. 18.7 - Screen page 1.3),
Tool Verification.
This option is used to repeat a tool measurement that has already been executed and
saved in file tt_tool1.var. If the method used previously was the standard method, the
partial procedure of this method is followed (Fig. 18.10 - Screen page 1.6), whereas if
the 4 points method was used, a procedure is followed that is very similar to that already
described for a new calculation of the tool, with the additional possibility to move the
reference on the remote TCP with MOVE commands to the position stored together
with the tool measurement. In this way the measurement repeatability is improved
since the tool verification is executed acquiring the points with the same orientation
(with a very slight approximation) as those of the previous acquisition.
<F1>: repeats the calculation (see Fig. 18.21 - Screen page 1.17)
<F2>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-21
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.25 - Screen page 1.20
When the START key is pressed (with control in Drive On) the reference moves toward
the first stored position associated to that tool; the Start can be released at any time to
manually adjust the reference approach to the TCP to be measured in J og , and to
resume the movement toward the position by pressing the Start key again.
Accepted commands:
After the Move has terminated (either naturally or forced by the user) pass to the next
acquisition following the same procedure as described for the first point. If instead it is
chosen to return to the first menu , press F6.
Once the algorithm is able to calculate a tool, a screen page is displayed informing the
user that as from that moment it is possible to move in TOOL reference.
18.4.7 Payload identification (optional function)
<F1>: If the move is reached and the position is OK, press F1
<F2>:
If it is wished to force termination of the Move (either because the
TCP has already been reached or because it is considered better
to position the reference on the TCP with movements in J og),
press F2
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
Be sure that the movement is executed at the speed indicated on the Teach
Pendant!
In order to retrieve Comau Options Codes, please refer to C4G Control Unit
Technical Specifications Manual, chapter Software Options.
Press key F4 from the screen page in Fig. 18.6 - Screen page 1.2, to access this
procedure.
TO_SET Program
18-22
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
The new generation robots (N families) are fitted with a complete dynamic model on
all six axes.
Because of the model's sensitivity to the declared payload parameters, it is necessary
that the user checks in every situation the correct definition of the payload used.
An imprecision in the declaration of the payload characteristics has a negative influence
on the robot performance.
This paragraph supplies information regarding
Basic concepts regarding Payload identification
Procedure for Payload identification
Software to validate the payload.
18.4.7.1 Basic concepts
As the correct declaration of the tool dimensions (variable $TOOL) is necessary to
obtain the required precision in execution of movements in the Cartesian environment,
in the same way it is equally necessary to correctly define the payload parameters that
will have influence on the robot movements in terms of performance optimisation and
safeguarding the components.
The determination of the payload characteristics takes place using the specific
procedure.
The Payload identification procedure, running the execution from two separate
movement programs that involve the wrist axis, and, in part, axis 3 of the robot,
recalculates the values of the following system variables :
$TOOL_MASS ( in kg)
$TOOL_CENTER (x, y and z)
$TOOL_INERTIA[1..6] (it is only necessary to supply items from I1 to I6, in
kg/sq.m, since the Inertia matrix is symmetrical). The useful reference system to
define the Inertia matrix is that of the tool ($TOOL_CENTER), with origin in COG
(Centre Of Gravity).
Warning: for safety reasons it is very important that the machine is not used
before having defined the values for the payload.
The omission or a big error in the payload declaration could create potentially
hazardous situations for the users and for the fixtures
During the Payload Identification procedure also the outfitting weight (e.g.:
cable) is identified.
If it is wished to execute the procedure with outfittings present (for example
cables) that exert significant traction (for example on the wrist structure), it is
advised to remove them where possible, or in any case ensure that their presence
does not influence the results of the procedure.
For the identification, Comau does not ask for movements WITHOUT load, but
only WITH load.
TO_SET Program
18-23
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Once this has been determined, the parameters will be immediately active and
automatically stored in the specific table created by TO_SET (TT_TOOL1.var), to be
called up when executing the movement cycles, each time the same payload is used.
18.4.7.2 Procedure
The movement programs for the Payload identification are supplied by Comau
Robotics & Final Assembly in PDL2 language and differ according to the robot model,
on the basis of the robot kinematic features. Their use is strongly recommended , unless
there are physical impediments in the robot working area.
This paragraph contains the following information:
Requirements to modify Payload identification programs
Activation and execution of the Payload identification procedure
18.4.7.2.1 Requirements to modify Payload identification programs
When changing Payload identification programs be sure to:
Keep axis 3 in horizontal position
have appropriate extension of the strokes of the axes involved.
The user can intervene, reducing the movement frequency of the individual axes, move
axis 1 as desired and move axes 2 and 3 as necessary, but ALWAYS ensuring that axis
3 is horizontal to the floor.
Since any modifications made to movement programs could reduce the precision of the
Identification procedure results, upon request Comau Robotica can supply an off-line
It may be that individually the values produced by the Payload identification
procedure have a certain tolerance in relation to the actual values. In any case,
the way the dynamic model is designed, the consistency of these values is
important.
Before installation, check that the overall dimensions caused by the presence of
any fixtures installed in the robot operating area, allows the complete execution
of the programs available for the Payload identification supplied by Comau
Robotics & Final Assembly.
If there is not sufficient space, it is advised to run this procedure BEFORE the final
positioning of the robot in the cell or line; if, in spite of the limited space, it is
decided to run the procedure, the user can change the Payload identification
programs, reducing the axis strokes and/or changing the position of some of
them (for example axis 1 and 2): in any case, the variations are to be made in
compliance with the fundamental requirements needed for the modification of the
Payload identification programs (see par. 18.4.7.2.1 Requirements to modify
Payload identification programs a pag. 18-23).
The entire Payload Identification procedure is performed with the DYNAMIC
MODEL DEACTIVATED automatically by the system.
TO_SET Program
18-24
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
instrument to validate the results. See par. 18.4.7.3 Software to validate the payload a
pag. 18-33.
18.4.7.2.2 Activation and execution of the Payload identification procedure
A reminder of the steps needed to reach screen page in Fig. 18.6 - Screen page 1.2 is
given here. If these steps have already been executed, go straight to step f.
a. Enter the Filer Utility Install command, specifying TO_INST. The system will install
and activate the TO_SET program.
b. The following screen page is displayed:
select TOOL (F1)
c. this screen page is shown:
select LOCAL TOOL (F1)
d. this screen page is shown:
Press key F4 from the screen page in Fig. 18.6 - Screen page 1.2, to access this
procedure.
TO_SET Program
18-25
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
insert the number of the required tool (from 1 to 18) and press ENTER
e. this screen page is shown:
select PAYLOAD IDENTIFICATION (F4)
f. the status selector switch must be on T1 (if necessary, reposition)
g. keep the Enable device pressed on the Teach Pendant
h. press the START key to bring the robot to calibration position
TO_SET Program
18-26
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
i. if the calibration position has been reached, choose MOVE EXECUTED (F1) to go
directly to step j.
If it is not possible to reach the calibration position, the start position has to be
changed: choose CHANGE START POS (F2). The following screen page is
displayed:
i.1 Use the jog keys to bring the robot in the new start position (remember to
ALWAYS keep axis 3 parallel to the base!). Choose MOVE EXECUTED (F1): if
the system does not accept the new start position, repeat this step. When the Move
is finally executed correctly, continue with the next step.
j. this screen page is shown:
The procedure includes movements that involve axes 3, 4, 5 and 6.
TO_SET Program
18-27
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Run the verification program. If it has terminated correctly, choose TEST
FINISHED (F1). If the robot is NH4 series, a second test is suggested and therefore
this point is executed again. Otherwise pass directly to point l.
If the verification program has not terminated correctly, choose POSITION
MODIFY (F2).
k. if the choice is POSITION MODIFY (F2), to change the start point or reduce the
stroke of one or more axes, the following screen page is displayed:
k.1 to change the start position select CHANGE INITIAL POS (F1); in this case
execute the same operations as indicated in step i.1.
If instead it is wished to reduce the stroke of one or more axes, select REDUCING
MOVEMENTS (F2).
The system displays the axes involved and the corresponding selection keys:
TO_SET Program
18-28
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
k.2 Choose the axis for the stroke reduction, or select CONTINUE (F5) to return to
step j., without making any further modifications
k.3 Each time that key F1 or F2 is pressed (for positive and negative direction
respectively), the stroke of the selected axis will be reduced by a pre-defined
quantity
If the initial values are to be resumed, choose RESET INITIAL VALUES (F3).
When finished, choose CONTINUE (F5) to return to step k.2
l. this screen page is shown:
TO_SET Program
18-29
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
before starting to execute real Payload identification programs, it is advised to
warm up the robot, making movements that involve the wrist and axis 3. If it is
decided not to run an automatic warm-up, select NO (F2) and go to step m.; if it
is decided to run the automatic warm-up, select YES (F1)
l.1 set the required speed
l.2 set the status selector switch to AUTO
l.3 switch on the drives pressing DRIVE ON and press the START key
l.4 the automatic warm-up program is executed. Wait until it finishes
If HOLD is pressed, the procedure is interrupted and cannot be continued.
TO_SET Program
18-30
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
l.5 select CONTINUE (F1)
m. this screen page is shown:
set GEN_OVR at 100% then choose CONFIRM YES (F1)
n. switch off the drives by pressing DRIVE OFF
TO_SET Program
18-31
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
o. check that the status selector switch is set to AUTO
p. switch on the drives pressing DRIVE ON and press the START key
While running, the cycle number of the current program is displayed, on the
number of total cycles to be run.
q. the execution of the first movement program starts (slow). Wait for it to finish
r. select CONTINUE (F1)
TO_SET Program
18-32
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
s. if the overall dimensions, the payload and the tool structure allow the execution of
the second program at normal speed, select YES (F1), otherwise select NO (F2).
If NO (F2) is chosen, the second Identification program will be run at a slower
speed
t. switch off the drives, pressing DRIVE OFF
u. check that the status selector switch is set to AUTO
v. switch on the drives pressing DRIVE ON and press START
TO_SET Program
18-33
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
w. the execution of the second movement program starts (at normal speed). Wait for
the completion
x. switch off the drives, pressing DRIVE OFF.
The system processes the data collected during the execution of the two
movement programs. When the processing has been completed, a screen page is
shown containing the calculated values (weight, centre of weight and inertia).
Choose SAVE (F1) to save them in TT_TOOL.VAR and in the tables of the DATA
environment
This terminates the procedure and the initial choice screen page returns (Fig. 18.4
- Screen page 1.0).
To exit choose RETURN TO MENU (F6).
18.4.7.3 Software to validate the payload
Comau Robotica supplies, upon request, an off-line software tool that can check the
correctness of the values calculated by the Payload identification procedure .
This tool checks that the values obtained for the payload are within the limits set by the
static load curve of the specific robot.
TO_SET Program
18-34
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
18.5 REMOTE TOOL Automatic Calculation
This can be accessed by pressing key F2 from the screen page in Fig. 18.4 - Screen
page 1.0, i.e. from the main menu of TO_SET. In this environment the coordinates
system can be defined of a fixed tool (remote tool ) using the robot as measuring
system.
Detailed information is given for the following subjects:
Tools needed
General characteristics
18.5.1 Tools needed
18.5.1.1 Tool with known dimensions mounted on Robot Flange
A reference tool must be mounted on the flange that has known dimensions declared
in the $TOOL system variable; the coordinates will be indicated as X_rif, Y_rif and Z_rif.
It is advised to use the TOOL MASTER or CALIBRATED TOOL that was used for the
Tool automatic calculation (see paragraph TOOL automatic calculation). As an
alternative an identified tip on the work tool can be used that has a distance from the
robot flange centre that is known and precise.
18.5.2 General characteristics
In the case of the TOOL_RMT command (pressing key F2) the procedure is the same
as the Tool calculation (F1).
Whereas for the tool the reference is the robot BASE , for the remote tool it is necessary
to define the X, Y and Z references of the tool fixed on the robot flange, indicated as
Xrif, Yrif and Zrif.
At the end of the procedure, before returning to the main menu(Fig. 18.2 - Screen page
0.0), the user is asked whether the remote tool is to be kept enabled (Fig. 18.26
- Screen page 2.1)
Fig. 18.26 - Screen page 2.1
If F1 is pressed, the Remote Tool remains enabled, if F2 is pressed the start situation
is resumed.
TO_SET Program
18-35
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
18.6 UFRAME automatic calculation
This environment is entered by pressing key F2 from the main menu of TO_SET
(Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0). In this environment the new reference system can be
defined in relation to which the work positions will be learnt.. The precision of the
calculation is the same as the robot, used as a measuring tool .
Detailed information is given on these subjects:
Tools needed
General characteristics
Procedure
18.6.1 Tools needed
The following topics are described:
Tool with known dimensions mounted on Robot Flange
3 Reference Points (ORIGIN, Xpos and XYpos)
18.6.1.1 Tool with known dimensions mounted on Robot Flange
A tool must be mounted on the robot flange that has known dimensions declared in
the $TOOL system variable.
It is advised to use the TOOL MASTER or CALIBRATED TOOL that was used for the
Tool automatic calculation (see paragraph TOOL automatic calculation). As an
alternative an identified tip on the work tool can be used that has a distance from the
robot flange centre that is known and precise.
18.6.1.2 3 Reference Points (ORIGIN, Xpos and XYpos)
3 reference points have to be identified on the workpiece :
ORIGIN: where the FRAME origin will be fixed;
Xpos: X-frame direction and sense
Xypos: Y-frame direction and sense
The direction and sense of the Z-frame are always considered outgoing upwards as to
the XY-frame plane.
The $UFRAME is always calculated in relation to the robot environment that coincides
with the origin of the robot base when $BASE=0
18.6.2 General characteristics
None of the robot positions on the 3 reference points are rigid: the operator can position
the TCP on the references as preferred, according to requirements.
At the end it is possible to save the Frame calculation in the TU_FRAME table (Al
termine possibile salvare il calcolo del frame nella tabella TU_FRAME
(see Fig. 18.33).
TO_SET Program
18-36
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
18.6.3 Procedure
If the UFRAME command is entered (pressing key F1) access is obtained to a second
screen page (Fig. 18.27 - Screen page 3.0) that asks the user to select local frame or
remote frame:
Fig. 18.27 - Screen page 3.0
Another screen page is then shown (Fig. 18.28 - Screen page 3.1):
Fig. 18.28 - Screen page 3.1
This screen page (Fig. 18.28 - Screen page 3.1) calls the attention of the operator to the
values of the $TOOL variable currently declared. The values are to refer to the tool
mounted on the flange and that will be used for the FRAME calculation. The values are
displayed and they can be modified if necessary.
Accepted commands:
<F1>: continues procedure (Fig. 18.29 - Screen page 3.2)
<F2>: changes the $TOOL values (Fig. 18.34 - Screen page 3.7)
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-37
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.29 - Screen page 3.2
Asks to take the tool TCP on the ORIGIN point.
The robot may be in any position: the operator can position the TCP on the ORIGIN
point as preferred, according to requirements.
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.30 - Screen page 3.3
Asks to take the tool TCP on the Xpos point . The robot may be in any position: the
operator can position the TCP on the Xpos point as preferred, according to
requirements.
Accepted commands:
<F1>:
to be pressed when the robot is on point; continues procedure
(Fig. 18.30 - Screen page 3.3)
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
<F1>:
to be pressed when the robot is on point; continues procedure
(Fig. 18.31 - Screen page 3.4)
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-38
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.31 - Screen page 3.4
Asks to take the tool TCP on the Xypos point . The robot may be in any position: the
operator can position the TCP on the Xpos point as preferred, according to
requirements.
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.32 - Screen 3.5
Displays the $UFRAME calculated values (XYZ relocations and AER orientations). At
this time it is possible to move in USR mode (selected by key [TYP] of TP) to check
that the new origin is that desired. If it is not so, check:
Robot calibration;
$TOOL values (referred to the tool mounted on the flange);
the 3 reference points (check that the sequence required by TO_SET has been
followed)
Accepted commands:
<F1>:
to be pressed when the robot is on point; continues procedure
(Fig. 18.32 - Screen 3.5 o Fig. 18.36 - Screen page 3.9)
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-39
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.33 - Screen page 3.6
Displays the $UFRAME calculated values (XYZ relocations and AER orientations).
To save the calculated values in the TU_FRAME table.
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.34 - Screen page 3.7
Displays the $TOOL values currently declared (XYZ relocations and AER orientations)
and allows their modification.
<F1>: returns to screen page in Fig. 18.28 - Screen page 3.1
<F2>:
saves calculated values (Fig. 18.33 - Screen page 3.6 or
Fig. 18.36 - Screen page 3.9)
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TU_FRAME is available in the System Software CD, in the Configuration Tools
directory.
<esc>:
to omit the SAVE request. In this case the screen page will be
displayed in (Fig. 18.35 - Screen page 3.8)
TO_SET Program
18-40
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.35 - Screen page 3.8
Displayed if the SAVE procedure for the calculated values has been omitted .
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.36 - Screen page 3.9
Displayed if it is not possible to execute the $UFRAME calculation.
Check:
robot calibration;
the $TOOL values (referred to the tool mounted on the flange);
the 3 reference points (check that the sequence required by TO_SET has been
followed)
Accepted commands:
<esc>: to omit the insertion of each separate value
<F1>: returns to screen page in Fig. 18.36 - Screen page 3.9
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-41
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
18.7 REMOTE UFRAME automatic calculation
This environment is entered by pressing key F4 from the main menu of TO_SET
(Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0). If a remote tool is declared , the part mounted on the robot
flange becomes the REMOTE UFRAME and has its own reference system. In this
environment the new reference system can be defined in relation to which the work
positions will be learnt. The precision of the calculation is the same as robot, used as
measuring system.
Detailed information is given on these subjects:
Tools needed
General characteristics
Procedure
18.7.1 Tools needed
The following topics are described:
Tool with known dimensions mounted on the Robot Flange
3 reference points (ORIGIN, Xpos and XYpos)
18.7.1.1 Tool with known dimensions mounted on the Robot Flange
A tool must be mounted on the robot flange that has known dimensions declared in
the $TOOL system variable.
It is advised to use the TOOL MASTER or CALIBRATED TOOL that was used for the
Tool automatic calculation (see paragraph TOOL automatic calculation). As an
alternative an identified tip on the work tool can be used that has a distance from the
robot flange centre that is known and precise.
18.7.1.2 3 reference points (ORIGIN, Xpos and XYpos)
3 reference points are to be identified on the workpiece :
ORIGIN: where the FRAME origin is fixed;
Xpos: determines the X-frame direction and sense
Xypos: determines the Y-frame direction and sense
The direction and sense of the Z-frame are always considered outgoing upwards as to
the XY-frame plane.
$UFRAME is always calculated in relation to the robot environment that coincides with
the origin of the robot base when $BASE=0.
<F1>: returns to screen page in Fig. 18.28 - Screen page 3.1
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-42
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
18.7.2 General characteristics
None of the robot positions on the 3 reference points are rigid: the operator can position
the TCP on the references as preferred, according to requirements.
If EZ is present, the calculation of the frame can be saved in a table and the values
assigned to the $UFRAME through the instruction A_FRAME(x), (where x=1-18).
18.7.3 Procedure
Fig. 18.37 - Screen page 4.1
Calls the attention of the operator to the values of the $TOOL variable currently
declared. The values are to refer to the tool mounted on the flange and that will be used
for the FRAME calculation. The values are displayed and they can be modified if
necessary.
Accepted commands:
Be sure that the Remote Tool is enabled!
<F1>: continues procedure (Fig. 18.38 - Screen page 4.2)
<F2>: changes the $TOOL values (Fig. 18.43 - Screen page 4.7)
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-43
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.38 - Screen page 4.2
Asks to take the tool TCP on the ORIGIN point.
The robot may be in any position: the operator can position the TCP on the ORIGIN
point as preferred, according to requirements.
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.39 - Screen page 4.3
Asks to take the tool TCP on the Xpos point. The robot may be in any position: the
operator can position the TCP on the Xpos point as preferred, according to
requirements.
Accepted commands:
<F1>:
to be pressed when the robot is on point; continues procedure (Fig. 18.39
- Screen page 4.3)
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
<F1>:
to be pressed when the robot is on point; continues procedure (Fig. 18.40
- Screen page 4.4)
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-44
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.40 - Screen page 4.4
Asks to take the tool TCP on the Xypos point . The robot may be in any position: the
operator can position the TCP on the XYpos point as preferred, according to
requirements.
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.41 - Screen page 4.5
Displays the $UFRAME calculated values (XYZ relocations and AER orientations). At
this time it is possible to move in USR mode (selected by key [TYP] of TP) to check
that the new origin is that desired. If it is not so, check:
robot calibration;
$TOOL values (referred to the tool mounted on the flange);
the 3 reference points (check that the sequence required by TO_SET )
Accepted commands:
<F1>:
to be pressed when the robot is on point; continues procedure (Fig. 18.41
- Screen page 4.5 o Fig. 18.45 - Screen page 4.9)
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
<F1>: returns to screen page in Fig. 18.37 - Screen page 4.1
<F2>:
saves calculated values (Fig. 18.42 - Screen page 4.6 or screen
page Fig. 18.46 - Screen page 4.10)
TO_SET Program
18-45
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.42 - Screen page 4.6
Displays the $UFRAME calculated values (XYZ relocations and AER orientations).
To save the calculated values in the TU_FRAME table.
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.43 - Screen page 4.7
Displays the $TOOL values currently declared (XYZ relocations and AER orientations)
and allows the modification.
Accepted commands:
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TU_FRAME is contained in the system software CD, in the Configuration Tools
directory.
<esc>:
to omit the SAVE request. In this case the screen page will be
displayed in Fig. 18.44 - Screen page 4.8
<esc>: to omit the insertion of each separate value
TO_SET Program
18-46
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.44 - Screen page 4.8
Displayed if the SAVE procedure for the calculated values has been omitted .
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.45 - Screen page 4.9
Displayed if it is not possible to execute the $UFRAME calculation.
Check:
robot calculation;
the $TOOL values (referred to the tool mounted on the flange);
the 3 reference points (check that the sequence required by TO_SET has been
followed).
Accepted commands:
Before returning to the main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0) it is asked if the remote
tool is to be kept enabled (Fig. 18.46 - Screen page 4.10).
<F1>: returns to screen page in Fig. 18.41 - Screen page 4.5
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
<F1>: returns to screen page in Fig. 18.37 - Screen page 4.1
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-47
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.46 - Screen page 4.10
Press F1 to maintain enabled the remote tool; press F2 to restore the start situation (the
tool is the one shown in Fig. 18.37 - Screen page 4.1).
18.8 BASE automatic calculation for
POSITIONERS (optional)
This environment is entered by pressing F3 from the TO_SET main menu (see Fig. 18.2
- Screen page 0.0). In this environment the reference system of a positioner can be
defined in relation to the robot, to obtain the cooperative movement between robot and
positioner.
The precision of the calculation is the same as for the robot, used as a measuring tool.
A detailed description is given below for:
Tools required
General characteristics
18.8.1 Tools required
A detailed description is given for the following topics:
Tool of known dimensions mounted on the robot flange
3 reference points (P1, P2, P3)
18.8.1.1 Tool of known dimensions mounted on the robot flange
It is necessary that a tool of known dimensions and declared in the $TOOL system
variable has been mounted on the robot flange. It is best to use the Tool Master or
Calibrated Tool (the same used for the TOOL automatic calculation (see TOOL
automatic calculation)). As an alternative it is also possible to use a point identified on
the work tool, that has a distance from the robot flange centre that is precise and known.
18.8.1.2 3 reference points (P1, P2, P3)
The 3 reference points are always present on the COMAU positioners.
TO_SET Program
18-48
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
These may be threaded holes, to fasten the 150 mm. calibrated tool or references
stamped on the positioner.
18.8.2 General characteristics
The robot positions on the 3 points are not rigid: the operator can position the TCP
on the references at will, according to requirements.
The calculated values will be saved in UD:\SYS\ in the .C4G system file and can
be recovered using the "ConfigureLoad" command.
The positioner can be seen by the system either as an auxiliary axis or as ARM (in
the case of double arm). In the first case the axis to which the positioner is
associated must be defined.
The calculated values will be automatically assigned to the following system
variables:
For an auxiliary axis:
$ARM_DATA[n arm].AUX_BASE[n positioner]
For arm:
$ARM_DATA[n arm].BASE
Fig. 18.47 - Screen page 5.1
Calls the attention of the operator to the values of the currently declared $TOOL
variable.
The values are to refer to the tool mounted on the flange and will be used for the
calculation of $BASE or $AUX_BASE. When these values are displayed, they can be
modified if necessary.
Accepted commands:
<F1>: procedure cont. (Fig. 18.48 - Screen page 5.2)
<F2>: to change the values of $TOOL (Fig. 18.57 - Screen page 5.11)
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-49
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.48 - Screen page 5.2
Calls the attention of the operator to the values of the calibrated tool used as reference
on points P1, P2, P3. The values are displayed and can be modified if necessary.
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.49 - Screen page 5.3
To select the type of positioner for the BASE calculation.
AUX: positioner seen as auxiliary axis; ARM: positioner seen as ARM.
Accepted commands:
<F1>: procedure cont. (Fig. 18.49 - Screen page 5.3)
<F2>: to change the values of the reference calibrated tool (Fig. 18.57
- Screen page 5.11)
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
<F1>: type of ARM; cont. (Fig. 18.50 - Screen page 5.4)
<F2>: type of auxiliary axis; cont. (Fig. 18.51 - Screen page 5.5)
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-50
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.50 - Screen page 5.4
To insert the positioner ARM number (1-4).
If the ARM number entered is not acknowledged by the system, the screen page of
Fig. 18.59 - Screen page 5.13; is displayed; if it is acknowledged, the screen page of
Fig. 18.52 - Screen page 5.6 is displayed.
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.51 - Screen page 5.5
To insert the positioner number (1-4).
If the positioner number entered is not acknowledged by the system, the screen page of
Fig. 18.60 - Screen page 5.14; is displayed; if it is acknowledged, the screen page of
Fig. 18.52 - Screen page 5.6 is displayed.
Accepted commands:
<esc>: omits the insertion (returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.49 - Screen
page 5.3)
The [n arm] (to which the selected positioner is associated) assumed by TO_SET
is that displayed on the TP in the field [Ar:] at the moment when the positioner
number is inserted
TO_SET Program
18-51
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.52 - Screen page 5.6
Asks to bring the tool TCP on point P1.
The robot can assume any position: the operator can position the TCP on point P1 as
desired, according to the requirements.
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.53 - Screen page 5.7
Asks to bring the tool TCP on point P2.
The robot can assume any position: the operator can position the TCP on point P2 as
desired, according to the requirements.
Accepted commands:
<esc>: omits the insertion (returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.49 - Screen
page 5.3)
<F1>: to press when the robot is on the point; cont. (Fig. 18.53 - Screen page
5.7)
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-52
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.54 - Screen page 5.8
Asks to bring the tool TCP on point P3.
The robot can assume any position: the operator can position the TCP on point P3 as
desired, according to the requirements.
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.55 - Screen page 5.9
Displays the calculated $BASE or $AUX_BASE values (XYZ relocations and AER
orientations).
At this moment the positioner axes can be moved in J OINT selecting the ARM number
(if the positioner is an ARM), to check that the cooperating move between robot and
positioner is correct.
If it is not, check the following:
<F1>: to press when the robot is on the point; cont. (Fig. 18.54 - Screen page
5.8)
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
<F1>: to press when the robot is on the point; cont.(Fig. 18.55 - Screen page 5.9
or Fig. 18.61 - Screen page 5.15)
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-53
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
the robot calibration;
the $TOOL values (they are to refer to the tool mounted on the flange);
if there are several positioners, check that the number of the positioner is that
actually used for the calculation (Fig. 18.50 - Screen page 5.4 or Fig. 18.52
- Screen page 5.6).
the 3 reference points (check that the sequence required by TO_SET has been
respected).
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.56 - Screen page 5.10
Displayed if the SAVE request has been performed. The calculated values assigned to
the opportune system variables have been successfully saved in the .C4G system file.
Accepted commands:
<F1>: returns to screen page in Fig. 18.47 - Screen page 5.1
<F2>: saves calculated values.
Note: to perform the SAVE it is necessary to be in PROG +DRIVES OFF;
procedure cont.(Fig. 18.56 - Screen page 5.10 or Fig. 18.62 - Screen page
5.16)
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
<F1>: returns to screen page in Fig. 18.47 - Screen page 5.1
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-54
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.57 - Screen page 5.11
Displays the $TOOL values currently declared and permits their modification.
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.58 - Screen page 5.12
Displays the values of the reference calibrated tool (XYZ relocations) and permits their
modification.
Accepted commands:
<esc>: permits the omission of each separate value insertion
<esc>: permits the omission of each separate value insertion
TO_SET Program
18-55
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.59 - Screen page 5.13
Displayed if an ARM type positioner has been entered that is not acknowledged by the
system (see Fig. 18.50 - Screen page 5.4).
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.60 - Screen page 5.14
Displayed if an AUX type positioner has been entered that is not acknowledged by the
system (see Fig. 18.52 - Screen page 5.6).
Accepted commands:
<F1>: returns to screen page in Fig. 18.49 - Screen page 5.3
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
<F1>: returns to screen page in Fig. 18.49 - Screen page 5.3
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-56
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.61 - Screen page 5.15
Displayed if it is not possible to perform the $BASE calculation.
Check:
the robot calibration;
the $TOOL values (they are to refer to the tool mounted on the flange);
the declared values of the reference calibrated tool;
the 3 reference points (check that the sequence required by TO_SET has been
respected).
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.62 - Screen page 5.16
Displayed when a SAVE (from Fig. 18.55 - Screen page 5.9) has been requested but
the C4G is not in PROG +DRIVES OFF. This condition is necessary since the SAVE
operation requires the system command ConfigureSave.
Accepted commands:
<F1>: returns to screen page in Fig. 18.47 - Screen page 5.1
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
<F1>: returns to screen page in Fig. 18.55 - Screen page 5.9
<F6>: returns to main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-57
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
18.9 CONVEYOR TRACKING installation and
configuration (optional service)
This environment is entered by pressing F6 from the TO_SET main menu (see Fig. 18.2
- Screen page 0.0).
In this environment a conveyor can be installed and configured to be managed by the
C4G Control Unit, enabling the robot to reach defined positions on the conveyor while
this is moving.
For further information regarding the use of the conveyors see the Cap. Motion Control.
18.9.1 Tools required
Detailed indications are given regarding the following:
Tool of known dimensions mounted on the robot flange
3 Reference points (P1, P2, P3)
18.9.1.1 Tool of known dimensions mounted on the robot flange
It is necessary that a tool of known dimensions and declared in the $TOOL system
variable has been mounted on the robot flange.
It is best to use the Tool Master or Calibrated Tool (the same used for the TOOL
automatic calculation (see par. 18.4 TOOL automatic calculation a pag. 18-5).
As an alternative it is also possible to use a point identified on the work tool, that has a
distance from the robot flange centre that is precise and known .
18.9.1.2 3 Reference points (P1, P2, P3)
The position of the conveyor in relation to the world reference system has to be
measured.
Therefore 3 points on the conveyor have to be identified to define the reference system.
It is advised to calculate the conveyor reference system under these conditions:
conveyor in its zero position
reference system X axis aligned to the conveyor advance direction
reference system X-Y plane coinciding with the trolley plane
origin positioned in the point where the sensor detects the passing of the trolley.
TO_SET Program
18-58
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.63 - Screen page 6.0
Accepted commands:
Fig. 18.64 - Screen page 6.1
to define the number of the conveyor to be installed (1 or 2).
If the number entered is that of a conveyor already installed an error message is
returned (it has to be disabled before); otherwise it continues with the next screen page.
<F1>: to define the conveyor characteristics .
If conveyors 1 and 2 are already enabled, it returns an error message (it
has to be disabled before) otherwise the screen page in Fig. 18.64
- Screen page 6.1 is displayed
<F2>: to define the tracking windows (area where the robot is enabled to track
the part).
It is also used to define the conveyor speed and maximum acceleration.
Displays the screen page in Fig. 18.93 - Screen page 7.1
<F3>: to disable a conveyor previously installed
Displays the screen page in Fig. 18.107 - Screen page 8.1
<F6>: returns to the TO_SET main menu (Fig. 18.2 - Screen page 0.0)
TO_SET Program
18-59
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.65 - Screen page 6.2
If the C4G is configured as multiarm, the arm to be associated to the conveyor has to be
defined.
Continues with the next screen page.
If there is only one arm, the screen page is not displayed
Fig. 18.66 - Screen page 6.3
It is necessary to indicate to which DSA the conveyor encoder/resolver has been
connected.
Fig. 18.67 - Screen page 6.4
TO_SET Program
18-60
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
The physical channel where the position transducer is connected has to be indicated.
In practice it is the physical axis. Example: for a robot with 6 axes, the first physical axis
available is 7.
Continues with the next screen page
Fig. 18.68 - Screen page 6.5
Fig. 18.69 - Screen page 6.5.1
To insert the value of the conveyor transmission ratio [mm/motor rev].
<F1>: to be selected for linear conveyor. Continues with screen page of
Fig. 18.69 - Screen page 6.5.1
<F2>: to be selected for circular conveyor.
Continues with screen page of Fig. 18.80 - Screen page 6.5.2
<F3>: to be selected for slide conveyor.
Continues with screen page of Fig. 18.91 - Screen page 6.5.3
<F6>: returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.63 - Screen page 6.0
TO_SET Program
18-61
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.70 - Screen page 6.5.1.1
To calculate the reference system (frame) of the conveyor.
Fig. 18.71 - Screen page 6.5.1.2
The user has to bring the robot TCP about the first reference point, usually this point is
the position of the sensor that detects the passage of the trolley and is at the beginning
of the conveyor stroke.
<F1>: to obtain the automatic calculation using the robot as the
measuring tool.
Continues with the next screen page
<F2>: for manual entry of the conveyor reference system values.
Continues with screen page of Fig. 18.77 - Screen page 6.5.1.7
<F6>: returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.68 - Screen page 6.5
<F1>: press when the TCP is in the required position.
<F6>: returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.70 - Screen page 6.5.1.1
TO_SET Program
18-62
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.72 - Screen page 6.5.1.3
L'utente deve portare il TCP del robot a circa met corsa della direzione positiva del
conveyor, normalmente questa posizione si trova lungo la direzione di avanzamento del
conveyor.
Fig. 18.73 - Screen page 6.5.1.4
The user has to bring the robot TCP on a point of the X-Y plane; usually this plane
coincides with the trolley plane.
<F1>: press when the TCP is in the required position.
Continues with the next screen page
<F6>: returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.70 - Screen page 6.5.1.1
<F1>: press when the TCP is in the required position.
Continues with the next screen page
<F6>: returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.70 - Screen page 6.5.1.1
TO_SET Program
18-63
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.74 - Screen page 6.5.1.5
To insert the distance between the origin of the conveyor reference system previously
calculated (or inserted) and the position of the sensor. Usually this distance is zero,
because the origin coincides with the sensor position. (See reference system calculation
method, Fig. 18.71 - Screen page 6.5.1.2 - Fig. 18.72 - Screen page 6.5.1.3 - Fig. 18.73
- Screen page 6.5.1.4).
Continues with the next screen page
Fig. 18.75 - Screen page 6.5.1.5bis
If NO (F2), returns to the screen page in Fig. 18.70 - Screen page 6.5.1.1.
If YES (F1), passes to the next screen page
TO_SET Program
18-64
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.76 - Screen page 6.5.1.6
Fig. 18.77 - Screen page 6.5.1.7
To enter the X, Y, Z, A, E, R values of the conveyor reference system manually (without
automatic calculation).
Fig. 18.78 - Screen page 6.5.1.8
<F1>: saves and executes a C4G restart
<F6>: returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.70 - Screen page 6.5.1.1
TO_SET Program
18-65
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Displays the calculated value and asks for confirmation.
Fig. 18.79 - Screen page 6.5.1.9
Fig. 18.80 - Screen page 6.5.2
To insert the value of the conveyor transmission ratio [motor rev./conveyor revolutions].
Fig. 18.81 - Screen page 6.5.2.1
<F1>: saves the data entered so far, and executes a C4G restart
<F6>: returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.70 - Screen page 6.5.1.1
TO_SET Program
18-66
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
To calculate the reference system (frame) of the conveyor.
Fig. 18.82 - Screen page 6.5.2.2
The user has to bring the robot TCP about the first reference point, usually this point is
the position of the sensor that detects the passage of the trolley and is at the beginning
of the conveyor stroke.
Fig. 18.83 - Screen page 6.5.2.3
The user has to bring the robot TCP about midway along the stroke in the positive
direction of the conveyor, usually this position is along the conveyor advance direction.
<F1>: to obtain the automatic calculation using the robot as the measuring tool.
Continues with screen page of Fig. 18.82 - Screen page 6.5.2.2
<F2>: for manual entry of the conveyor reference system values.
Continues with screen page of Fig. 18.88 - Screen page 6.5.2.7
<F6>: returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.68 - Screen page 6.5
<F1>: press when the TCP is in the required position. Continues with the next
screen page
<F6>: returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.81 - Screen page 6.5.2.1
<F1>: press when the TCP is in the required position.
Continues with the next screen page
TO_SET Program
18-67
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.84 - Screen page 6.5.2.4
The user is to bring the robot TCP on a point of the X-Y plane at approximately the
conveyor end of travel; usually this plane coincides with the trolley plane.
Fig. 18.85 - Screen page 6.5.2.5
To insert the distance between the origin of the conveyor reference system previously
calculated (or inserted) and the position of the sensor.
Usually this distance is zero, because the origin coincides with the sensor position. (See
reference system calculation method Fig. 18.82 - Screen page 6.5.2.2 - Fig. 18.83
- Screen page 6.5.2.3 - Fig. 18.84 - Screen page 6.5.2.4).
<F6>: returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.81 - Screen page 6.5.2.1
<F1>: press when the TCP is in the required position.
Continues with the next screen page
<F6>: returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.81 - Screen page 6.5.2.1
TO_SET Program
18-68
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.86 - Screen page 6.5.2.5bis
Displays the calculated data and asks for confirmation
Fig. 18.87 - Screen page 6.5.2.6
Fig. 18.88 - Screen page 6.5.2.7
To enter the X, Y, Z, A, E, R values of the conveyor reference system manually (without
<F1>: saves and executes a C4G restart
<F6>: returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.81 - Screen page 6.5.2.1
TO_SET Program
18-69
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
automatic calculation).
Fig. 18.89 - Screen page 6.5.2.8
To insert the circular conveyor RADIUS value in [mm].
Fig. 18.90 - Screen page 6.5.2.9
Fig. 18.91 - Screen page 6.5.3
<F1>: saves the data entered so far, and executes a C4G restart
<F6>: returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.81 - Screen page 6.5.2.1
TO_SET Program
18-70
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
To insert the value of the conveyor transmission ratio [mm/motor rev].
Fig. 18.92 - Screen page 6.5.4
Fig. 18.93 - Screen page 7.1
To define the number of the conveyor to be configured (1 or 2).
If the number entered is that of a conveyor that is not installed an error message is
returned (it has to be installed first); otherwise it continues with the next screen page
<F1>: Indicates that the conveyor advance direction is the X+direction.
Continues with the next screen page
<F2>: Indicates that the conveyor advance direction is the X- direction.
Continues with the next screen page
<F6>: returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.68 - Screen page 6.5
TO_SET Program
18-71
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.94 - Screen page 7.2
If the C4G is configured as multiarm, the arm to be associated to the conveyor has to be
defined.
If there is only one arm, the screen page is not displayed
Fig. 18.95 - Screen page 7.3
To define the tracking windows, i.e. the area where the robot is enabled to track the part.
<F1>: automatic procedure: the robot TCP is brought on the limits of the
area to be defined (Fig. 18.96 - Screen page 7.3.1)
<F2>: manual procedure: the Cartesian positions that define the area
limits are entered manually (Fig. 18.101 - Screen page 7.3.6)
<F6>: returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.63 - Screen page 6.0
TO_SET Program
18-72
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.96 - Screen page 7.3.1
To define the left-hand limit of the conveyor tracking area
Fig. 18.97 - Screen page 7.3.2
To define the right-hand limit of the conveyor tracking area.
<F1>: press when the TCP is in the required position.
Continues with the next screen pageG
<F6>: returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.95 - Screen page 7.3
<F1>: press when the TCP is in the required position.
Continues with the next screen pageG
<F6>: returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.95 - Screen page 7.3
TO_SET Program
18-73
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.98 - Screen page 7.3.3
To enter the conveyor maximum speed.
Fig. 18.99 - Screen page 7.3.4
To enter the conveyor maximum acceleration.
Fig. 18.100- Screen page 7.3.5
<F1>: saves the acquired data and returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.64
- Screen page 6.1
<F6>: returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.95 - Screen page 7.3
TO_SET Program
18-74
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.101- Screen page 7.3.6
To define the left-hand limit of the conveyor tracking area.
In this case the value has to be entered manually (usually it is the value along X axis of
the conveyor reference frame, i.e. along the advance direction).
Fig. 18.102- Screen page 7.3.7
To define the right-hand limit of the conveyor tracking area.
In this case the value has to be entered manually (usually it is the value along X axis of
the conveyor reference frame, i.e. along the advance direction).
Fig. 18.103- Screen page 7.3.7bis
TO_SET Program
18-75
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Displays the values and asks for confirmation.
Fig. 18.104- Screen page 7.3.8
To enter the conveyor maximum speed.
Fig. 18.105- Screen page 7.3.9
To enter the conveyor maximum acceleration.
Fig. 18.106- Screen page 7.4.0
TO_SET Program
18-76
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
If there are two conveyors enabled (1 and 2), screen page n. 8.1 will be displayed
followed by screen page n. 8.2 with the indication of the conveyor number entered to be
disabled.
If only one conveyor is enabled (1 or 2), the screen page of Fig. 18.108 - Screen page
8.2, will be displayed, indicating the number of the conveyor that can be disabled.
If there is no conveyor enabled, the screen page of Fig. 18.110 - Screen page 8.4 will
be displayed.
Fig. 18.107- Screen page 8.1
To define the number of the conveyor to be disabled (1 or 2).
Fig. 18.108- Screen page 8.2
<F1>: saves the acquired data and returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.64
- Screen page 6.1
<F6>: returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.95 - Screen page 7.3
<F1>: disables the conveyor indicated and executes a save and a C4G
restart
<F6>: returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.63 - Screen page 6.0
TO_SET Program
18-77
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
Fig. 18.109- Screen page 8.3
Fig. 18.110- Screen page 8.4
Press a key to return to the screen page of Fig. 18.63 - Screen page 6.0
<F1>: disables the conveyor indicated and returns to the screen page of
Fig. 18.63 - Screen page 6.0
<F6>: returns to the screen page of Fig. 18.63 - Screen page 6.0
TO_SET Program
18-78
HS-0-C4E-USO_44.fm
01/1107
COMAU Robotics services
Repair: repairs.robotics@comau.com
Training: training.robotics@comau.com
Spare parts: spares.robotics@comau.com
Technical service: service.robotics@comau.com
comau.com/robotics

You might also like